Gate Question Bank PDF
Gate Question Bank PDF
Gate Question Bank PDF
for
Electrical Engineering
By
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Contents
Subject Name Topic Name Page No.
#1. Mathematics 1-148
1 Linear Algebra 1 – 28
2 Probability & Distribution 29 – 57
3 Numerical Methods 58 – 73
4 Calculus 74 – 112
5 Differential Equations 113 – 131
6 Complex Variables 132 – 143
7 Laplace Transform 144 – 148
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page I
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page II
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Linear Algebra
ME – 2005 5. Match the items in columns I and II.
1. Which one of the following is an Column I Column II
P. Singular 1. Determinant is not
Eigenvector of the matrix[ ]? matrix defined
Q. Non-square 2. Determinant is
matrix always one
R. Real 3. Determinant is
(A) [ ] (C) [ ] symmetric zero
matrix
S. Orthogonal 4. Eigen values are
matrix always real
(B) [ ] (D) [ ] 5. Eigen values are
not defined
(A) P - 3 Q - 1 R - 4 S - 2
(B) P - 2 Q - 3 R - 4 S - 1
2. A is a 3 4 real matrix and Ax=B is an (C) P - 3 Q - 2 R - 5 S - 4
inconsistent system of equations. The (D) P - 3 Q - 4 R - 2 S - 1
highest possible rank of A is
(A) 1 (C) 3 ME – 2007
(B) 2 (D) 4 6. The number of linearly independent
Eigenvectors of 0 1 is
ME – 2006
3. Multiplication of matrices E and F is G. (A) 0 (C) 2
Matrices E and G are (B) 1 (D) Infinite
os sin 7. If a square matrix A is real and symmetric,
E [ sin os ] and
then the Eigenvalues
(A) are always real
G [ ]. What is the matrix F? (B) are always real and positive
(C) are always real and non-negative
os sin (D) occur in complex conjugate pairs
(A) [ sin os ]
ME – 2008
sin os
(B) [ os sin ] 8. The Eigenvectors of the matrix 0 1 are
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 2
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 3
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
i i
8. The inverse of the m trix 0 1 is 14. The inverse of the matrix 0 1
i i
(A) 0 1 (C) 0 1 is
( ) i i
(B) 0 1 (D) 0 1 0 1
i i
i i
( ) 0 1
CE – 2008 i i
9. The product of matrices ( ) is ( ) i i
0 1
i i
(A) (C)
i i
(B) (D) PQ ( ) 0 1
i i
10. The Eigenvalue of the matrix
CE – 2012
[P] = 0 1 are
15. The Eigenvalues of matrix 0 1 are
(A) and 8 (C) n
(A) 2.42 and 6.86
(B) and 5 (D) n
(B) 3.48 and 13.53
11. The following simultaneous equation (C) 4.70 and 6.86
x+y+z=3 (D) 6.86 and 9.50
x + 2y + 3z = 4
x + 4y + kz = 6 CE – 2013
will NOT have a unique solution for k 16. There is no value of x that can
equal to simultaneously satisfy both the given
(A) 0 (C) 6 equations. Therefore, find the ‘le st
(B) 5 (D) 7 squares error’ solution to the two
equations, i.e., find the value of x that
CE – 2009 minimizes the sum of squares of the
12. A square matrix B is skew-symmetric if errors in the two equations.
(A) (C) 2x = 3 and 4x = 1
(B) (D)
17. What is the minimum number of
CE – 2011 multiplications involved in computing the
13. [A] is square matrix which is neither matrix product PQR? Matrix P has 4 rows
symmetric nor skew-symmetric and , - and 2 columns, matrix Q has 2 rows and
is its transpose. The sum and difference of 4 columns, and matrix R has 4 rows and 1
these matrices are defined as column. __________
[S] = [A] + , - and [D] = [A] , - ,
CE – 2014
respectively. Which of the following
statements is TRUE? 18. Given the matrices J = [ ] n
(A) Both [S] and [D] are symmetric
(B) Both [S] and [D] are skew-symmetric
(C) [S] is skew-symmetric and [D] is K [ ], the product K JK is
symmetric
(D) [S] is symmetric and [D] is skew
19. The sum of Eigenvalues of the matrix, [M]
symmetric
is, where [M] = [ ]
[ ] is ________________ CS – 2007
5. Consider the set of (column) vectors
defined by X={xR3 x1+x2+x3=0, where
CS – 2005
XT =[x1, x2, x3]T }. Which of the following is
1. Consider the following system of
TRUE?
equations in three real
(A) {[1, 1, 0]T, [1, 0, 1]T} is a basis for
variables x x n x
the subspace X.
x x x
(B) {[1, 1, 0]T, [1, 0, 1]T} is a linearly
x x x
independent set, but it does not span
x x x
X and therefore, is not a basis of X.
This system of equation has
(C) X is not the subspace for R3
(A) no solution
(D) None of the above
(B) a unique solution
(C) more than one but a finite number of
CS – 2008
solutions
6. The following system of
(D) an infinite number of solutions
x x x
x x x
2. What are the Eigenvalues of the following
x x x
2 2 matrix?
Has unique solution. The only possible
0 1 value (s) for is/ are
(A) n (C) n (A) 0
(B) n (D) n (B) either 0 or 1
(C) one of 0,1, 1
CS – 2006 (D) any real number except 5
3. F is an n x n real matrix. b is an n real
vector. Suppose there are two nx1
7. How many of the following matrices have
vectors, u and v such that u v , and
an Eigenvalue 1?
Fu=b, Fv=b. Which one of the following
statement is false? 0 1 0 1 0 1 n 0 1
(A) Determinant of F is zero (A) One (C) three
(B) There are infinite number of (B) two (D) four
solutions to Fx=b
CS – 2010
(C) There is an x 0 such that Fx=0
8. Consider the following matrix
(D) F must have two identical rows
A=[ ]
x y
If the Eigen values of A are 4 and 8, then
(A) x = 4, y = 10 (C) x = 3, y = 9
(B) x = 5, y = 8 (D) x = 4, y = 10
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 5
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
⁄
⁄ 6. The rank of the matrix [ ]
(B) [ ]
⁄
⁄ (A) 0 (C) 2
(B) 1 (D) 3
(C) [ ]
ECE – 2007
7. It is given that X1 , X2 …… M are M non-
⁄
zero, orthogonal vectors. The dimension
⁄
(D) [ ] of the vector space spanned by the 2M
⁄
⁄ vector X1 , X2 … XM , X1 , X2 … XM is
(A) 2M
⁄ (B) M+1
2. Let, A=0 1 and = 0 1.
(C) M
Then (a + b)=
(D) dependent on the choice of X1 , X2 …
(A) ⁄ (C) ⁄
(B) ⁄ (D) ⁄ XM.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 7
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 8
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE – 2005
5. The following vector is linearly
1. If R = [ ] , then top row of is dependent upon the solution to the
previous problem
(A) , - (C) , -
(B) , - (D) , - (A) [ ] (C) [ ]
EE – 2014 IN – 2006
21. Given a system of equations: Statement for Linked Answer Questions 3
x y z and 4
x y z A system of linear simultaneous
Which of the following is true regarding equations is given as Ax=B where
its solutions?
(A) The system has a unique solution for [ ] n [ ]
any given and
(B) The system will have infinitely many 3. The rank of matrix A is
solutions for any given and (A) 1 (C) 3
(C) Whether or not a solution exists (B) 2 (D) 4
depends on the given and
(D) The system would have no solution 4. Which of the following statements is true?
for any values of and (A) x is a null vector
(B) x is unique
22. Which one of the following statements is (C) x does not exist
true for all real symmetric matrices? (D) x has infinitely many values
(A) All the eigenvalues are real.
(B) All the eigenvalues are positive. 5. For a given matrix A, it is observed
(C) All the eigenvalues are distinct. that
(D) Sum of all the eigenvalues is zero.
0 1 0 1 n 0 1 0 1
Then matrix A is
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 11
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN – 2014
16. For the matrix A satisfying the equation
given below, the eigenvalues are
, -[ ] [ ]
ME
1. [Ans. A] and G = [ ]
Now E × F = G
[ ] os sin
∴ ,E- [ sin os ]
h r teristi equ tions is | I|
( )( )( )
4. [Ans. A]
∴ Real eigenvalues are 5, 5 other two are
For S matrix, if Eigenvalues are
complex
… … … … … then for matrix,
Eigenvector corresponding to
the Eigenvalues will be , , ………
is ( I)
For S matrix, if Eigenvalues are 1 and 5
(or) →( )
then for matrix, the Eigenvalues are 1
Verify the options which satisfies relation
and 25.
(1)
Option (A) satisfies.
5. [Ans. A]
2. [Ans. B]
6. [Ans. B]
Given n in onsistent
0 1 Eigenv lues re 2, 2
No ( I) ( I) . /
( ⁄ ) No. of L.I Eigenvectors
( ) n ( ⁄ ) (no of v ri les) ( I)
( ( ) minimum of m n)
For inconsistence
( ) ( ⁄ ) 7. [Ans. A]
∴ he highest possi le r nk of is ( I) .
olving for , Let the symmetric and real
3. [Ans. C] matrix be A = 0 1
os sin
Given , E = [ sin os ] Now | |
Which gives ( )
⟹
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 13
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
⟹
x
Hence real Eigen value. [ ][ ] 0 1
x
8. [Ans. B]
Equating the elements x ⁄
Let 0 1 eigenv lues re n
Eigen vector corresponding to 12. [Ans. A]
is ( I) 0 1 → Eigenv lues re
x
. / .y/ . / Eigenve tor is x x verify the options
By simplifying
K 13. [Ans. C]
. / . / y t king K
Eigen vector corresponding to =2 [ ] [ ]
is ( I)
x
. / .y/ . / → [ ]
K
By simplifying ( ) 4 5 by
K ⁄ → [ ]
taking K
( ) infinite m ny solutions
⁄
14. [Ans. B]
⁄
Eigenvalues of a real symmetric matrix
9. [Ans. C] are always real
Sum of the diagonal elements = Sum of 15. [Ans. B]
the Eigenvalues
⟹ 1 + 0 + p = 3+S 0 1 eigenv lues v lue
⟹ S= p 2 Eigen vector will be . /
10. [Ans. B] Norm lize ve tor
( ⁄ ) [ ] √( ) ( )
[ ] [√( ) ( ) ]
⁄
→ * √ +
[ ] ⁄
→
√
→ [ ] 16. [Ans. C]
The given system is
If system will h ve solution x y z
x y z
11. [Ans. A] x y z
iven M M → MM I Use Gauss elimination method as follows
Augmented matrix is
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 14
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
, | - [ | ] So, | |
→ [ | ] | |
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 15
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
[ | ]→ [ | ] 8. [Ans. A]
Inverse of 0 1 is
→ [ | ] 0 1 0 1
( )
( ⁄ ) ∴0 1 0 1
( ) ( )
( ) ( ⁄ ) 0 1
∴ olution is non – existent for above
system.
9. [Ans. B]
( ) P=( )P
5. [Ans. B]
( )( )
∑ = Trace (A)
=( ) (I) =
+ + = Trace (A)
= 2 + ( 1) + 0 = 1
10. [Ans. B]
Now = 3
∴3+ + =1 A=0 1
Characteristic equation of A is
Only choice (B) satisfies this condition.
| |=0
6. [Ans. B] (4 )( 5 ) 2 × 5 =0
∑ = Trace (A) + 30 = 0
+ + =1+5+1=7 6, 5
Now = 2, = 6
∴ 2+6+ =7 11. [Ans. D]
=3 The augmented matrix for given system is
x
7. [Ans. A] [ | ] 6y7 [ ]
k z
The augmented matrix for given system is
Using Gauss elimination we reduce this to
an upper triangular matrix to find its rank
[ | ]
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 16
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
15. [Ans. B] [ ]
0 1
Sum of the Eigenvalues = 17 Interchanging Column 1& Column 2 and
Product of the Eigenvalues = taking transpose
From options, 3.48 + 13.53 = 17
(3.48)(13.53) = 47 [ ]
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 17
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
* ( ) ( )+ ( )( )
= ( )
= 1, 6
21. [Ans. 2] ∴ The Eigenvalues of A are 1 and 6
[ ]
3. [Ans. D]
→ Given that Fu =b and Fv =b
If F is non singular, then it has a unique
[ inverse.
( ) ( ) ( )
Now, u = b and v= b
] Since is unique, u = v but it is given
( ) ( ) th t u v his is contradiction. So F
must be singular. This means that
[ ] (A) Determinant of F is zero is true. Also
(B) There are infinite number of
( ) no. of non zero rows = 2
solution to Fx= b is true since |F| = 0
CS (C) here is n su h the is
1. [Ans. B] also true, since X has infinite number
The augmented matrix for the given of solutions., including the X = 0
solution
system is [ | ] (D) F must have 2 identical rows is false,
since a determinant may become
Using elementary transformation on above zero, even if two identical columns
matrix we get, are present. It is not necessary that 2
identical rows must be present for
[ | ]
|F| to become zero.
4. [Ans. C]
→ [ ⁄ | ] It is given that Eigenvalues of A is
⁄ ⁄ 5, 2, 1, 4
I
→ Let P = 0 1
[ | ] I
Eigenvalues of P : | I|
Rank ([A B]) = 3 I
| |
I
Rank ([A]) = 3
( ) I
Since
I
Rank ([A B]) = Rank ([A]) = number of I
variables, the system has unique solution. Eigenvalue of P is
( 5 +1 ), ( 2+ 1), (1+ 1), (4+1 ),
2. [Ans. B] ( 5 1 ), ( 2 1 ),(1 1), (4 1)
0 1 = 4, 1, 2, 5, 6, 3,0,3
The characteristic equation of this matrix
5. [Ans. B]
is given by |x
X= {x x x +
| I|
= ,x x x - then,
| |
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 18
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
=0 = 0, 0 ( )( )
( )( )
Eigenvalues of 0 1
| |= 0 √
( ) =0 Eigenvalues of A are √ n √
( ) respectively
= i or 1 So Eigenvalues of
= 1 –i or 1 + i (√ ) n ( √ )
Eigenvalues of 0 1 n
n
| | =0
√ n √
( )( ) =0
( ) =0
= –1, 1
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 19
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
3. [Ans. C] 8. [Ans. B]
0 1 Approach 1:
Given 4x + 2y =7
(A I)=0 and 2x + y =6
( 4 ) (3 ) 2 4=0
4 2 x 7
2 + 20=0 = 5, 4 2 1y 6
x1
Putting = 5, 0 1 =0 0 0 x 5
x2 2 1y 6
x + 2x = 0 x = 2x
On comparing LHS and RHS
x x
1= 2 0= 5, which is irrelevant and so no
2 1 solution.
Hence, 0 1 is Eigenvector. Approach 2:
4x + 2y =7
4. [Ans. C] 7
or 2x y=
0 1 We know th t it is Eigenvalue 2
Then Eigenvector is x x 2x+y=6
Verify the options (C) Since both the linear equation represent
parallel set of straight lines, therefore no
5. [Ans. A] solution exists.
Approach 3:
or m trix 0 1 Rank (A)=1; rank (C)=2,
We know |I A|=0 As Rank (A) rank (C) therefore no
| | solution exists.
| | =0
[ ]
( )(( ) )=0
( )
, j j
12. [Ans. B]
Given equations are x y z et of , - et of [ ]
x y z and x y z
If and ,
then x y z have Infinite solution
16. [Ans. D]
If and , then
Matrix multiplication is not commutative
x y z ( ) no solution
in general.
x y z
If n
17. [Ans. *] Range 0.99 to 1.01
x y z will have solution
Let ‘ ’ e Eigenv lue of ‘ ’ hen ‘ ’ will
x y z
e Eigenv lue of ‘ ’
and will also give solution
A. =I=
13. [Ans. B] Using Cauchey Hamilton Theorem,
0 1
Characteristic Equations is
18. [Ans. *] Range 0.99 to 1.01
By Cayley Hamilton theorem I J I J
I I
∴
( I) | |
I
[ ]
14. [Ans. A]
I I [ ] → [ ]
( ) ( | ) no of v r les
Infinitely many solutions
Then AB = [4]; BA [ ]
21. [Ans. B]
Here m = 1, n = 4
And et(I ) et(I ) onsi er 0 1
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 22
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
∴ (not positive)
2. [Ans. D]
( ) is not true
Since matrix is triangular, the Eigenvalues
(A), (C), (D) are true using properties of
are the diagonal elements themselves
Eigenvalues
namely = 3, 2 & 1.
Corresponding to Eigenvalue = 2, let
22. [Ans. *] Range 48.9 to 49.1
us find the Eigenvector
Real symmetric matrices are diagnosable
Let the matrix be [A - ] x̂ = 0
x x
0 1 s tr e is [ ][x ] [ ]
x
So determinant is product of diagonal x
entries Putting in above equation we get,
x
So | | x x
[ ][x ] [ ]
∴ M ximum v lue of etermin nt x
x x Which gives the equations,
∴| | 5x x x =0 . . . . . (i)
x =0 . . . . . (ii)
EE 3x = 0 . . . . . (iii)
1. [Ans. B] Since eqa (ii) and (iii) are same we have
5x x x =0 . . . . . (i)
R= [ ]
x =0 . . . . . (ii)
j( ) , of tor( )- Putting x = k, we get
x = 0, x = k and 5x k =0
| | | |
x = k
| |=| | ∴ Eigenvectorss are of the form
x k
= 1(2 + 3) – 0(4 + 2) – 1 (6 – 2) = 1
x
[ ] * k +
Since we need only the top row of , we x
need to find only first column of (R)
which after transpose will become first i.e. x x x = k : k : 0
row adj(A). = :1:0
cof. (1, 1) = + | |=2+3=5 =2:5:0
x
cof. (2, 1) = | |= 3 x
∴ [ ]=[ ] is an Eigenvector of matrix p.
x
cof. (2, 1) = + | |= +1
3. [Ans. A]
∴ cof. (A) = [ ] Rank [P|Q] = Rank [P] is necessary for
existence of at least one solution to
Adj (A) =, of ( )-
x q.
=[ ]
4. [Ans. A]
We need to find orthogonal vectors, verify ( )
the options. i i
Option (A) is orthogonal vectors
8. [Ans. B]
( )( ) xy xy xx x n xy yx
xx xy x xy
Option (B), (C), (D) are not orthogonal | yx y y | |y x y |
x y (x y)
5. [Ans. B]
The vector ( ) is linearly = Positive when x and y are linearly
dependent upon the solution obtained in independent.
Q. No. 4 namely , - and , - 9. [Ans. A]
We can easily verify the linearly
A=0 1
dependence as
|A – | = 0
| |
| | =0
A will satisfy this equation according to
6. [Ans. B] Cayley Hamilton theorem
hen n n m trix xx i.e. I=0
x x x x x x Multiplying by on oth si es we get
x x x x x x
* + I=0
x x x x x x I =0
Take x common from 1st row,
x common from 2nd row …… 10. [Ans. A]
x common from nth row. To calculate
It h s r nk ‘ ’ Start from I = 0 which has
derived above
7. [Ans. D] I
⃗
k
L(x) = | | ( I)( I)
x x x I
= (x ) ( ) ⃗(
k x ) ( I) I
x I
= x ⃗ =[
x k ]
x ( I)( I)
x
I
L(x) = M [x ]
x ( I) I
Comparing both , we get, I
M=[ ] ( I)
Hence Eigenvalue of M : | M | ( I)
I
| |
( ) ( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 24
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
11. [Ans. A] x
If rank of (5 6 ) matrix is 4,then surely x
* + *x + * +
it must have exactly 4 linearly x
independent rows as well as 4 linearly
independent columns.
Argument matrix C =* +
12. [Ans. D]
If characteristic equation is
→ , * +
=0
Then by Cayley – Hamilton theorem,
I=0 nk ( ) nk( )
= Number of variables = 4
Multiplying by on both sides, Since, Rank (A) = Rank(C) < Number of
variables
= I = ( I)
Hence, system of equations are consistent
and there is multiple non-trivial solution
13. [Ans. D]
exists.
Choice (A) = A is correct
Since =A[( ) -A
17. [Ans. B]
= A[( ) -
Characteristic equation | I|
Put =P
Then A [ ] = A. = A | |
Choice (C) = is also correct since
=( ) (1 ) ( )( )
= I
Eigenve tors orrespon ing to is
14. [Ans. B] ( I)
Let orthogonal matrix be x
os in [ ] [x ] [ ]
P=0 1 x
in os
By Property of orthogonal matrix A 2x x x x
I At x x
x os x in x x x x
So, x⃗ = [ ]
x in x os At x ,x
|| x⃗ || =
Eigenvectors = c[ ]{Here c is a constant}
√(x os x in ) (x in x os )
|| x⃗ || = √x x 18. [Ans. D]
, - ,L-, - ⟹ Options D is correct
|| x⃗ || = || x̅|| for any vector x̅
19. [Ans. D]
15. [Ans. C] x x … (i)
Trace = Sum of Principle diagonal } (i) n (ii) re s me
x x … (ii)
elements. ∴x x
So it has multiple solutions.
16. [Ans. D]
On writing the equation in the form of
AX =B
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 25
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
2. [Ans. B]
AX=0 and (A) = 2
Solving
n=3
0 1 0 1 No. of linearly independent solutions
= n r
21. [Ans. B] = 3
Since there are 2 equations and 3 variables =1
(unknowns), there will be infinitely many
solutions. If if then 3. [Ans. C]
x y z x y z x z y There are 3 non-zero rows and hence
For any x and z, there will be a value of y. rank (A) = 3
∴ Infinitely many solutions
4. [Ans. C]
22. [Ans. A] Rank (A) = 3 (This is Co-efficient matrix)
For all real symmetric matrices, the Rank (A:b) =4(This is Augmented matrix)
Eigenvalues are real (property), they may s r nk( ) r nk ( ) olution oes
be either ve or ve and also may be same. not exist.
The sum of Eigenvalues necessarily not be
zero.
5. [Ans. C]
We know Hen e from the given
23. [Ans. C]
p q problem, Eigenvalue & Eigenvector is
0 1 known.
r s
( pplying → p q 1 1
→r s element ry tr nsform tions) X1 , X2 2 , 1 1, 2 2
p q pr qs 1
[ ] We also know that , where
pr qs r s
∴ hey h ve s me r nk N 1 1
P X1 X2
1 2
IN
1 0 1 0
1. [Ans. B] & D=
0 2 0 2
Given: 0 1
Hence
Characteristic equation is,
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 26
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
0 1 0 1 [ ]
0 10 1 0 1
→ [ ]
Now | I |
| |
→ [ ]
( )( )=0
∴ ( )
Approach 2: By rank – nullity theorem
Eigenvalues of ( I) is = 1, 1/2 Rank [A]+ nullity [A]= no. of columns[A]
Eigenvalues of (X+5I) is = 3, 2 Nullity [A]= 3
Eigenvalues of ( I) (X+5I) is = , ∴ Nullity , -
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 27
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
j x
[ ] 0x 1 0 1
j
x
x j
j
j x
[ ] 0x 1 0 1
j
x j
x
16. [Ans. C]
A[ ]=[ ]
→| | | | | |
→| |
( | |
| |)
=Product of eigenvalues
Verify options
Options (C) correct answer
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 28
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ME - 2005 ME - 2008
1. A single die is thrown twice. What is the 6. A coin is tossed 4 times. What is the
probability that the sum is neither 8 nor probability of getting heads exactly 3
9? times?
(A) ⁄ (C) ⁄ (A) ⁄ (C) ⁄
(B) ⁄ (D) ⁄ (B) ⁄ (D) ⁄
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 30
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 31
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 32
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
CS - 2006 CS - 2008
3. For each element in a set of size 2n, an 7. Let X be a random variable following
unbiased coin is tossed. The 2n coin normal distribution with mean +1 and
tosses are independent. An element is variance 4. Let Y be another normal
chosen if the corresponding coin toss variable with mean of 1 and variance
were head. The probability that exactly n unknown If (X ) (Y≥ ) the
elements are chosen is standard deviation of Y is
(A) ( n ⁄ ) (C) ( ⁄ n ) (A) 3 (C) √
(B) ( n ⁄ ) (D) ⁄ (B) 2 (D) 1
(A) pq+(1 – p)(1 – q) 15. If two fair coins flipped and at least one of
(B) (1 – q)p the outcomes is known to be a head, what
(C) (1 – p)q is the probability that both outcomes are
(D) pq heads?
(A) 1/3 (C) 1/4
11. What is the probability that a divisor of (B) 1/2 (D) 2/3
is a multiple of ?
(A) 1/625 (C) 12/625 CS - 2012
(B) 4/625 (D) 16/625 16. Suppose a fair six – sided die is rolled
once. If the value on the die is 1,2, or 3 the
12. If the difference between the expectation
die is rolled a second time. What is the
of the square if a random variable ( ,x -)
probability that the some total of value
and the square if the exopectation of the
that turn up is at least 6?
random variable ( ,x-) is denoted by R,
(A) 10/21 (C) 2/3
then (B) 5/12 (D) 1/6
(A) R = 0 (C) R≥
(B) R< 0 (D) R > 0 17. Consider a random variable X that takes
CS - 2011 values +1 and 1 with probability 0.5
13. A deck of 5 cards (each carrying a distinct each. The values of the cumulative
number from 1 to 5) is shuffled distribution function F(x) at x = and
thoroughly. Two cards are then removed +1 are
one at a time from the deck. What is the (A) 0 and 0.5 (C) 0.5 and 1
probability that the two cards are (B) 0 and 1 (D) 0.25 and 0.75
selected with the number on the first card
CS - 2013
being one higher than the number on the
18. Suppose p is the number of cars per
second card?
minute passing through a certain road
(A) ⁄ (C) ⁄
junction between 5 PM and 6 PM, and p
(B) ⁄ (D) ⁄
has a Poisson distribution with mean 3.
14. Consider a finite sequence of random What is the probability of observing
values X = [x1, x2 … xn].Let be the fewer than 3 cars during any given
me n nd σx be the standard deviation of minute in this interval?
X. Let another finite sequence Y of equal (A) ⁄ e (C) ⁄ e
length be derived from this as yi, a*xi+b, (B) ⁄ e (D) ⁄ e
where a and b are positive constants. Let
μy be the me n nd σy be the standard CS - 2014
deviation of this sequence. Which one of 19. Suppose you break a stick of unit length
the following statements is INCORRECT? at a point chosen uniformly at random.
(A) Index position of mode of X in X is Then the expected length of the shorter
the same as the index position of stick is ________ .
mode of Y in Y.
(B) Index position of median of X in X is 20. Four fair six – sided dice are rolled. The
the same as the index position of probability that the sum of the results
median of Y in Y. being 22 is x/1296. The value of x is
(C) μy μx + b ____________
(D) σy σx + b
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 34
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
( ) ( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 35
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 36
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(A) Both the student and the teacher are (C) ( (x) (x)) x
right (D) ( (x) (x)) x ≥
(B) Both the student and the teacher are
wrong ECE - 2014
(C) The student is wrong but the teacher 17. In a housing society, half of the families
is right have a single child per family, while the
(D) The student is right but the teacher is remaining half have two children per
wrong family. The probability that a child picked
at random, has a sibling is _____
ECE - 2010
12. A fair coin is tossed independently four 18. Let X X nd X , be independent and
times. The prob bility of the event “the identically distributed random variables
number of times heads show up is more with the uniform distribution on [0, 1].
th n the number of times t ils show up” is The probability P{X is the largest} is _____
(A) ⁄ (C) ⁄
(B) ⁄ (D) ⁄
19. Let X be a random variable which is
uniformly chosen from the set of positive
ECE - 2011
odd numbers less than 100. The
13. A fair dice is tossed two times. The
expectation, E[X], is __________.
probability that the second toss results in
a value that is higher than the first toss is
20. An unbiased coin is tossed an infinite
(A) 2/36 (C) 5/12
number of times. The probability that the
(B) 2/6 (D) 1/2
fourth head appears at the tenth toss is
(A) 0.067 (C) 0.082
ECE\EE\IN - 2012
(B) 0.073 (D) 0.091
14. A fair coin is tossed till a head appears for
the first time probability that the number 21. A fair coin is tossed repeatedly till both
of required tosses is odd , is head and tail appear at least once. The
(A) 1/3 (C) 2/3 average number of tosses required is
(B) 1/2 (D) 3/4 _______.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 37
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE - 2005 EE - 2008
1. If P and Q are two random events, then 5. X is a uniformly distributed random
the following is TRUE variable that takes values between 0 and
(A) Independence of P and Q implies that 1. The value of E{X } will be
probability (P Q) = 0 (A) 0 (C) 1/4
(B) Probability (P ∪ Q)≥ Probability (P) (B) 1/8 (D) 1/2
+Probability (Q)
EE - 2009
(C) If P and Q are mutually exclusive,
6. Assume for simplicity that N people, all
then they must be independent
born in April (a month of 30 days), are
(D) Probability (P Q) Probability (P)
collected in a room. Consider the event of
2. A fair coin is tossed three times in atleast two people in the room being born
succession. If the first toss produces a on the same date of the month, even if in
head, then the probability of getting different years, e.g. 1980 and 1985. What
exactly two heads in three tosses is is the smallest N so that the probability of
(A) ⁄ (C) ⁄ this event exceeds 0.5?
(B) ⁄ (D) ⁄ (A) 20 (C) 15
(B) 7 (D) 16
EE - 2006
3. Two f ir dice re rolled nd the sum “ r ” EE - 2010
of the numbers turned up is considered 7. A box contains 4 white balls and 3 red
(A) Pr (r > 6) = balls. In succession, two balls are
randomly selected and removed from the
(B) Pr (r/3 is an integer) = box. Given that the first removed ball is
(C) Pr (r = 8|r/4 is an integer) = white, the probability that the second
removed ball is red is
(D) Pr (r = 6|r/5 is an integer) =
(A) 1/3 (C) 1/2
(B) 3/7 (D) 4/7
EE - 2007
4. A loaded dice has following probability ECE\EE\IN - 2012
distribution of occurrences 8. Two independent random variables X and
Dice Value Probability Y are uniformly distributed in the interval
1 ⁄ , -. The probability that max , - is
2 ⁄ less than 1/2 is
3 ⁄ (A) 3/4 (C) 1/4
(B) 9/16 (D) 2/3
4 ⁄
5 ⁄ EE - 2013
6 ⁄ 9. A continuous random variable x has a
If three identical dice as the above are probability density function
thrown, the probability of occurrence of f(x) e x . Then *x + is
values, 1, 5 and 6 on the three dice is (A) 0.368 (C) 0.632
(A) same as that of occurrence of 3, 4, 5 (B) 0.5 (D) 1.0
(B) same as that of occurrence of 1, 2, 5
(C) 1/128
(D) 5/8
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 38
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE - 2014 IN - 2005
10. A fair coin is tossed n times. The 1. The probability that there are 53 Sundays
probability that the difference between in a randomly chosen leap year is
the number of heads and tails is (n – 3) is (A) ⁄ (C) ⁄
(A) (C) (B) ⁄ (D) ⁄
(B) (D)
2. A mass of 10 kg is measured with an
11. Consider a dice with the property that the instrument and the readings are normally
probability of a face with n dots showing distributed with respect to the mean of
up is proportional to n. The probability of 10 kg. Given that
the face with three dots showing up is ∫ exp . / d =0.6
√
_______________ and that 60per cent of the readings are
found to be within 0.05 kg from the mean,
12. Let x be a random variable with
the standard deviation of the data is
probability density function
(A) 0.02 (C) 0.06
for |x| (B) 0.04 (D) 0.08
f(x) { for |x|
otherwise 3. The measurements of a source voltage are
The probability P(0.5 < x < 5) is_________ 5.9V, 5.7V and 6.1V. The sample standard
deviation of the readings is
13. Lifetime of an electric bulb is a random (A) 0.013 (C) 0.115
variable with density f(x) kx , where x (B) 0.04 (D) 0.2
is measured in years. If the minimum and
maximum lifetimes of bulb are 1 and 2 IN - 2006
years respectively, then the value of k 4. You have gone to a cyber-cafe with a
is__________ friend. You found that the cyber-café has
only three terminals. All terminals are
14. The mean thickness and variance of unoccupied. You and your friend have to
silicon steel laminations are 0.2 mm and make a random choice of selecting a
0.02 respectively. The varnish insulation terminal. What is the probability that
is applied on both the sides of the both of you will NOT select the same
laminations. The mean thickness of one terminal?
side insulation and its variance are (A) ⁄ (C) ⁄
0.1 mm and 0.01 respectively. If the (B) ⁄ (D) 1
transformer core is made using 100 such
5. Probability density function p(x) of a
varnish coated laminations, the mean
random variable x is as shown below. The
thickness and variance of the core
value of is
respectively are
p(x)
(A) 30 mm and 0.22
(B) 30 mm and 2.44
(C) 40 mm and 2.44 α
(D) 40 mm and 0.24
0 α α b α c
(A) c (C)
( )
(B) c (D)
( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 39
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
6. Two dices are rolled simultaneously. The measurements, it can be expected that the
probability that the sum of digits on the number of measurement more than 10.15
top surface of the two dices is even is mm will be
(A) 0.5 (C) 0.167 (A) 230 (C) 15
(B) 0.25 (D) 0.125 (B) 115 (D) 2
IN - 2007 IN - 2011
7. Assume that the duration in minutes of a 12. The box 1 contains chips numbered 3, 6,
telephone conversation follows the 9, 12 and 15. The box 2 contains chips
exponential distribution f(x) = e ,x≥ numbered 6, 11, 16, 21 and 26. Two chips,
one from each box, are drawn at random.
The probability that the conversation will
The numbers written on these chips are
exceed five minutes is
multiplied. The probability for the
(A) e (C) product to be an even number is
(B) e
(D) e (A) ⁄ (C) ⁄
(B) ⁄ (D) ⁄
IN - 2008
8. Consider a Gaussian distributed random IN - 2013
variable with zero mean and standard 13. A continuous random variable X has
deviation . The value of its cummulative probability density f(x) = .
distribution function at the origin will be Then P(X > 1) is
(A) 0 (C) 1 (A) 0.368 (C) 0.632
(B) 0.5 (D) σ (B) 0.5 (D) 1.0
IN - 2010
11. The diameters of 10000 ball bearings
were measured. The mean diameter and Assuming independence of failures of the
standard deviation were found to be machines, the probability that a given job
10 mm and 0.05mm respectively. is successfully processed (up to third
Assuming Gaussian distribution of decimal place)is ______________
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 40
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ME 4. [Ans. D]
1. [Ans. D] ( oth defective)
( oth defective)
The number of ways coming 8 and 9 are S mple sp ce
(2,6),(3,5),(4,4),(5,3),(6,2),(3,6),(4,5),
(5,4),(6,3)
Total ways =9
So Probability of coming 8 and 9 are 5. [Ans. D]
X and Y are independent
∴ ( ) ( ) ( ) re true
So probability of not coming these Only (D) is odd one
6. [Ans. A]
Number of favourable cases are given by
2. [Ans. B]
HHHT
Probability of defective item = HHTH
Probability of not defective item = 1 0.1 HTHH
= 0.9 THHH
So, Probability that exactly 2 of the Total number of cases
chosen items are defective = 2C1 2C1 2C1 2C1 =16
= ( ) ( ) ∴ Probability =
3. [Ans. B] 7. [Ans. A]
Mean (t)̅ = ∫ t f(t) dt A uniform distribution and density
function
∫ t( t)dt ∫ t( t)dt
0,x a
x x a
6
t t
7 6
t t
7 f(x) f x dx , axb
0 b a
0, xb
[ ] [ ]
Density function
1 a,x b
f(x) b a
Variance = ∫ t f(t)dt 0 a x,x b
=∫ t ( t)dt ∫ t ( t)dt b
ab
=∫ (t t )dt ∫ t ( t)dt
Mean E(x)= x(F(x))
x a 2
Variance = F(x)2 f(x)
2
=0 1 0 1
2
b
b
x F(x) xF(x)
= 2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 41
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
b 2 3
x3 xL 1 7
(3 3 1)
3(b a) a 2 b a 2 8
b3 a3 (b2 a2 )2
3(b a) 4 b a 2 9. [Ans. C]
Probability of drawing 2 washers, first
(b a)(b2 ab a2 ) (b a)2(b a)2 followed by 3 nuts, and subsequently the
3(b a) 4 b a
2
4 bolts
4b2 4ab 4a2 3a2 3b2 6ab
12
b2 a2 2ab
10. [Ans. D]
12
Required probability = . / . /
(b a)2
12
Standard deviation = √v ri nce
(b a)2 11. [Ans. D]
12 Given 4R and 6B
(b a) , -
12
Given: b=1, a=0
10 1
Standard deviation =
12 12
8. [Ans. D]
Let probability of getting atleast one head 12. [Ans. C]
= P(H) then
P (at least one head) = 1 P(no head)
P(H)=1 P(all tails)
But in all cases, 23=8
1 7 X=0
X=1
P (H) = 1
8 8 Below X (X ) is
Alternately (X ) has to be less than 0.5 but
Probability of getting at least one head greater than zero
( ) ( )
13. [Ans. D]
1 7 A event that he knows the correct
1
8 8 answer
Alternately B event that student answered
From Binomial theorem correctly the question P(B) = ?
Probability of getting at least one head ( ) ( )
pq
( ) ( ) ( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 42
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
( ) ( ) ( ⁄ )
( ) ⁄
( ⁄ )
( ) ⁄ 18. [Ans. A]
14. [Ans. D]
x 1 2 3
P(x) 0.3 0.6 0.1
(x) x (x)
So from figure
(x)
Mean value = 1
x (x) V ri nce : μ me n x defective pieces
(x μ)
σ V(x) (x ) , (x)- σ
n(n )
x (x) ( x (x)) ( ) ( ) ( )
( ) ( ) ( )
σ √
( )
15. [Ans. A]
19. [Ans. *](Range 49 to 51)
∫ e dz
17. [Ans. *] Range 0.64 to 0.66 σ√
Let number of men = 100 ∴ of s ving ccount holder
Number of women = 100
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 43
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
e 5 Calculators
(x )
1 Defective 4 Non-defective
CE p( defective in c lcul tors)
1. [Ans D]
A, B, C are true
(D) is not true. Since in a negatively
skewed distribution
4. [Ans. C]
mode > median > mean
σ
μ
2. [Ans. D]
Let the mean and standard deviation of
5. [Ans. B]
the students of batch C be μ and σ
Given f(x) = x for x
respectively and the mean and standard
= 0 else where
deviation of entire class of first year
students be μ and σ respectively
Now given, μ ( x ) ∫ f(x)dx ∫ x dx
σ
and μ
σ =0 1
In order to normalise batch C to entire
The probability expressed in percentage
class, the normalize score must be
equated P=
since Z = = 2.469% = 2.47%
Z = =
6. [Ans. A]
Now Z = = Given
Equation these two and solving, we get P(private car) = 0.45
= P(bus 1 public transport) = 0.55
Since a person has a choice between
x = 8.969 ≃ 9.0
private car and public transport
P(public transport) = 1 – P(private car)
3. [Ans. B]
= 1 – 0.45 =0.55
Since population is finite, hypergeometric
P(bus) = P(bus public transport)
distribution is applicable
(bus public tr nsport)
(public tr nsport)
= 0.55 × 0.55
= 0.3025 ≃ 0.30
Now P(metro)
= 1 [P(private car) + P(bus)]
= 1 (0.45 + 0.30) = 0.25
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 44
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
[ ]
-0.44
The shades area in above figure is given
by F(0) –F ( 0.44)
= ( )( )
( ) ( )
= 0.5 – 0.3345 13. [Ans. 0.4]
= 1.1655 ≃ 16.55%
Closest answer is 16.7% ( ) ∫ f( )d ∫ d
8. [Ans. C]
( )| ( )
P(2 heads) =
9. [Ans. C]
P(one ball is Red & another is blue) 14. [Ans. *] Range 0.26 to 0.27
= P(first is Red and second is Blue) Avg= 5
= Let x denote penalty
(x ) (x ) (x )
(x ) (x )
10. [Ans. A]
Given μ = 1000, σ = 200 e
ew (x n)
x
We know that Z
e e e e
p(x )
When X= 1200, Z
Req. Prob = P (X ) e [ ]
(Z )
( Z )
Less than 50%
15. [Ans. B]
S * T+
11. [Ans. D]
n( )
(X ) (X ) (X ) ( )
n(S)
( ) ( )
16. [Ans. *] Range 0.25 to 0.28
e ( t)
(n t)
n
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 45
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 46
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
6. [Ans. D] 8. [Ans. C]
umber of permut tions with ‘ ’ in the Let C denote computes science study and
first position =19! M denotes maths study.
Number of permutations with ‘ ’ in the P(C on Monday and C on Wednesday)
second position = 10 18! = P(C on Monday, M on Tuesday and C on
(Fill the first space with any of the 10 odd Wednesday)
numbers and the 18 spaces after the 2 + P(C on Monday, C on Tuesday and C on
with 18 of the remaining numbers in 18! Wednesday)
ways) =1 0.6 0.4+ 1 0.4 0.4
umber of permut tions with ‘ ’ in rd = 0.24 + 0.16 = 0.40
position =10 9 17!
9. [Ans. B]
(Fill the first 2 place with 2 of the 10 odd
It is given that
numbers and then the remaining 17
P (odd) = 0.9 P (even)
places with remaining 17 numbers)
Now since 𝜮P(x) = 1
nd so on until ‘ ’ is in th place. After
∴ P (odd) + P (even) = 1
that it is not possible to satisfy the given
0.9 P (even) + P (even) = 1
condition, since there are only 10 odd
numbers v il ble to fill before the ‘ ’ P(even) = = 0.5263
So the desired number of permutations Now, it is given that P(any even face) is same
which satisfies the given condition is i.e. P(2) = P(4) = P(6)
Now since,
… P(even) = P(2) or P(4) or P(6)
Now the probability of this happening is = P(2) + P(4) + P(6)
given by = ∴ P(2) = P(4) = P(6) = P(even)
( … )
= (0.5263)
Which are clearly not choices (A), (B) or (C) = 0.1754
It is given that
7. [Ans. A]
P(even | face > 3) = 0.75
Given μ = 1, σ = 4 σ =2 ( )
and μ = 1, σ is unknown = 0.75
( )
Given, P(X ) = P (Y ≥ 2 ) ( )
= 0.75
( )
Converting into standard normal variates, ( ) ( )
P(f ce ) = =0.468
.z / = P (z ≥ )
( ) 10. [Ans. A]
.z / = P (z ≥ )
The tree diagram of probabilities is
shown below
(z ) = P (z ≥ ) _____(i)
q decl red f ulty
Now since we know that in standard f ulty
p
normal distribution
q decl red not f ulty
P (z ) = P (z ≥ 1) _____(ii) decl red f ulty
not q
Comparing (i) and (ii) we can say that p
f ulty
=1 σ =3
q decl red not f ulty
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 47
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
11. [Ans. A]
( )
If b c …
Then, no. of divisors of ( ∪ ) ( t le st one he d)
(x )(y )(z )… ( TT )
iven
∴ o of ivisors of
So required prob bility
( )( )
( )( )
16. [Ans. B]
No. of divisors of which are multiples Required Probability
of = P (getting 6 in the first time)
o of divisors of + P (getting 1 in the first time and getting
( )( ) 5 or 6 in the second time)
+ P (getting 2 in the first time and getting
4 or 5 or 6 in the second time)
+ P (getting 3 in the first time and getting
∴ equired rob bility
3 or 4 or 5 or 6 in the second time)
( ) ( ) ( )
12. [Ans. C]
V(x) (x ) , (x)-
17. [Ans. C]
Where V(x) is the variance of x,
The p.d.f of the random variable is
Since variance is σ and hence never
x +1
negative, ≥
P(x) 0.5 0.5
The cumulative distribution function F(x)
13. [Ans. A]
is the probability upto x as given below
The five cards are * +
x +1
Sample space ordered pairs F(x) 0.5 1.0
P (1 card = 2 card + 1)
st nd
So correct option is (C)
*( )( )( )( )+
18. [Ans. C]
e
(k)
k
14. [Ans. D] P is no. of cars per minute travelling.
𝛔y = a 𝛔x is the correct expression
Since variance of constant is zero. For no cars. (i.e. k = 0)
For no cars. P(0) e
15. [Ans. A] So P can be either 0,1,2. (i.e. k = 0,1,2)
Let A be the event of head in one coin. B For k = 1, p(1)=e
be the event of head in second coin.
For k = 2 , P(2)=
The required probability is
* ) ( ∪ )+ Hence
( )| ∪ ) ( ) ( ) ( )
( ∪ )
( ) e e e
( ∪ )
( ) (both coin he ds) 4 5
e
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 48
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( )
( ⁄ )
e ( ) ( )
( )
e e ∴ equired prob bility is
( ) ( ∪ ∪ )
19. [Ans. *] Range 0.24 to 0.27
The smaller sticks, therefore, will range in
24. [Ans. 0.25]
length from almost 0 meters upto a
( ∪ ) P(S) = 1
maximum of 0.5 meters, with each length
( ) ( ) ( )
equally possible.
utu lly exclusive ( )
Thus, the average length will be about
( ) ( )
0.25 meters, or about a quarter of the
et ( ) x; ( ) x
stick.
P(A) P(B) = x( x)
Maximum value of y = x ( x)
20. [Ans. 10]
dy
22 occurs in following ways ( x) x
dx
6 6 6 4 w ys
= 2x = 1
6 6 5 5 w ys
x
equired prob bility (max)
x ximum v lue of y ( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 49
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
P x.dx 1
We know that, P
B PB
∴ ( ) ( ) ( )
Ke .dx 1
ax
= 0.6 0.2
or ∫ e dx ∫ e dx = 0.12
x x,for x 0
7. [Ans. A]
x for x 0 x
K K CDF: F x PDF dx
1
a a x
For x<0, F x x 1 dx
1
i
Then probability
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 51
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
20. [Ans. C]
EE 6
1. [Ans. D]
(A) is false since of P & Q are 7
independent
8
pr(P Q) = pr(P) pr(Q)
which need not be zero.
9
(B) is false since
pr(P ∪ Q) 10
= pr(P) + pr(Q) – pr(P Q)
(C) is false since independence and 11
mutually exclusion are unrelated
properties. 12
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 53
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
4. [Ans. C]
Dice value Probability
1
8. [Ans. B]
2 and is the entrie
rectangle
3
The region in which maximum of {x, y} is
4 less than ⁄ is shown below as shaded
region inside this rectangle
5
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 54
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
( x ) ∫ f(x)dx
∫ dx ∫ dx ∫ dx
x| x|
( ) ( )
13. [Ans. *] Range 0.4 to 0.5
∴ ∫ kx dx
x
k | k ∴k
(x ) ∫ e dx , e - IN
,e e - e 1. [Ans. D]
Since leap chosen will be random, so, we
assume it being the case of uniform
10. [Ans. B] probability distribution function.
Let number of heads = x, Number of days in a leap year=366 days
∴ Number of tails n x =52 weeks and 2 days are extra. Out of
∴ ifference x (n x)or (n x) x
7, (SUN MON) (or) (SAT SUN) are
x n or n x
favorable.
If x n n x n
So, Probability of this event=
x n
If n x n x or x 2. [Ans. C]
As x and n are integers, this is not Since the reading taken by the instrument
possible is normally distributed, hence
( )
∴ Probability 0 P(x x ) ∫ e .dx
√
Where, μ e n of the distribution
11. [Ans. *] Range 0.13 to 0.15 σ St nd rd devi tion of the
Let proportionality constant = k distribution.
∴ ( dot) k ( dots) k
Now ∫ exp( )dx
( dots) k √
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 55
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
3. [Ans. D] 8. [Ans. B]
Mean= =5.9 V. By definition of Gaussian distribution,
total area under the curve =1. Hence half
( ̅) ( ̅) ( ̅)
S √ of the area =0.5
V
(closest answer is 0.2) 9. [Ans. A]
P(x)= =
4. [Ans. C] Mean = μ ∫ x (x)dx = ∫ x dx = 6
( ) ( )
Var(x)= ∫ (x μ) (x)dx
1 2
=∫ (x ) dx =
3 3
c
Area under triangle = 1
2 11. [Ans. C]
α σ mm
μ mm
6. [Ans. A] Then probability
Probability that the sum of digits of two X μ
(X ) ( )
σ
dices is even is same either both dices
where x mm
shows even numbers or odd numbers on
the top of the surface ( ) ( )
∴ ( ) ( ) ( )
Where e
√
( ) Probability of occurring even
number of both the dices e
√
( ) Probability of occurring odd
number of both the dices So, number of measurement more than
( ) 10.15mm
P Total number of measurement
nd ( )
≃
∴ ( )
12. [Ans. D]
7. [Ans. A] For the product to be even, the numbers
from both the boxes should not turn out
∫ f(x) dx=P
to be odd simultaneously.
or ∫ e .dx =P
∴ ( ) ( )( )
or e |
or P = .
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 56
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
13. [Ans. A]
∫ f(x)dx ∫ e dx
e | e
14. [Ans. 2]
For valid pdf ∫ pdf dx ;
∫ dx ;k
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 57
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Numerical Methods
ME – 2005 ME – 2010
1. Starting from x = 1, one step of Newton – 6. Torque exerted on a flywheel over a cycle
Raphson method in solving the equation is listed in the table. Flywheel energy (in
x³ +3x 7=0 gives the next value (x₁) as J per unit cycle) using impson’s rule is
(A) x₁=0.5 (C) x₁ = .5 Angle (degree) Torque (N-m)
(B) x₁= . 0 (D) x₁=2 0 0
60 1066
2. With a 1 unit change in b, what is the
change in x in the solution of the system 120 323
of equation = 2 .0 0. = 180 0
(A) Zero (C) 50 units 240 323
(B) 2 units (D) 100 units 300 55
360 0
ME – 2006 (A) 542 (C) 1444
3. Match the items in columns I and II. (B) 992.7 (D) 1986
Column I Column II
(P) Gauss-Seidel (1) Interpolation ME – 2011
method 7. The integral ∫ dx, when evaluated by
(Q) Forward (2) Non-linear using impson’s / rule on two equal
Newton-Gauss differential subintervals each of length 1, equals
method equations (A) 1.000 (C) 1.111
(R) Runge-Kutta (3) Numerical (B) 1.098 (D) 1.120
method integration
(S) Trapezoidal (4) Linear algebraic ME – 2013
Rule equation 8. Match the correct pairs.
(A) 2 Numerical Order of Fitting
(B) 2 Integration Scheme Polynomial
(C) 2 . impson’s / 1. First
(D) 2 Rule
Q. Trapezoidal Rule 2. Second
4. Equation of the line normal to function . impson’s / 3. Third
f(x) = (x ) at (0 5) is Rule
(A) y = x 5 (C) y = x 5 (A) P – 2 , Q – 1, R – 3
(B) y = x 5 (D) y = x 5 (B) P – 3, Q – 2 , R – 1
(C) P – 1, Q – 2 , R – 3
ME – 2007 (D) P – 3, Q – 1 , R – 2
5. A calculator has accuracy up to 8 digits
2
ME – 2014
after decimal place. The value of sinxdx
0
9. Using the trapezoidal rule, and dividing
the interval of integration into three equal
when evaluated using this calculator by
sub intervals, the definite integral
trapezoidal method with 8 equal
intervals, to 5 significant digits is ∫ |x|dx is ____________
(A) 0.00000 (C) 0.00500
(B) 1.0000 (D) 0.00025
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 58
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
CE – 2010 CE – 2013
8. The table below given values of a function 12. Find the magnitude of the error (correct
F(x) obtained for values of x at intervals to two decimal places) in the estimation
of 0.25. of following integral using impson’s ⁄
x 0 0.25 0.5 0.75 1.0 Rule. Take the step length as 1.___________
F(x) 1 0.9412 0.8 0.64 0.50
∫ (x 0) dx
The value of the integral of the function
between the limits 0 to using impson’s
rule is CS – 2007
(A) 0.7854 (C) 3.1416 1. Consider the series =
(B) 2.3562 (D) 7.5000
= 0.5 obtained from the Newton-
CE 2011 Raphson method. The series converges to
9. The square root of a number N is to be (A) 1.5 (C) 1.6
obtained by applying the Newton (B) √2 (D) 1.4
Raphson iterations to the equation
CS – 2008
x = 0. If i denotes the iteration
2. The minimum number of equal length
index, the correct iteration scheme will be
subintervals needed to approximate
(A) x = (x ) 2
1
xe dx
x
to an accuracy of at least 106
(B) x = (x ) 1 3
using the trapezoidal rule is
(C) x = (x )
(A) 1000e (C) 100e
(D) x = (x ) (B) 1000 (D) 100
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 60
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 61
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 62
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 63
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN– 2011
7. The extremum (minimum or maximum)
point of a function f(x) is to be
( )
determined by solving = 0 using the
Newton-Raphson method.
Let f(x) = x x and x = 1 be the initial
guess of x. The value of x after two
iterations (x ) is
(A) 0.0141 (C) 1.4167
(B) 1.4142 (D) 1.5000
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 64
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ME y = sin ( ) =
1. [Ans. C] 2
( )
By N-R method , =x – x = y = sin ( ) = 0.70 0
( )
f(x) = x x 7 y = sin( ) = 0
f( ) = 5
y = sin ( ) = 0.70 0
( )
x =x ( )
y = sin ( )=
f (x) = x
f ( )= , 7
y = sin ( ) = 0.70 0
( )
=1 = (0.5) = .5
y = sin ( )=0
2. [Ans. C] Trapezoidal rule
Given x y = 2 (i) ∫ f(x)dx = [(y y ) 2(y y
.0 x 0.0 y = b (ii)
y )]
Multiply 0.99 is equation (i) and subtract
∫ sinx dx = [(0 0) 2(0.70 0
from equation (ii); we get
( .0 0. )x = b (2 0. ) 0.70 0 0.70 0 0.70 0 0=0
0.02x = b .
0.02Δx = Δb 6. [Ans. B]
ower = ω = Area under the curve.
Δx = = 50 units h
0.02 = [(y y ) (y y y )
3. [Ans. D] 2(y y )]
= [(0 0) ( 0 0 55)
4. [Ans. B]
/ 2( 2 2 )]
Given f(x) = (x )
= 2.7 /unit cycle.
2
f (x) = (x )
Slope of tangent at point (0, 5) 7. [Ans. C]
2 x 1 2 3
m = (0 ) / = 1
y=
Slope of normal = 3 x 2
h
(∵ roduct of slopes = 1) ∫ dx = (y y y )
x
Slope of normal at point (0, 5)
y 5 = (x 0) = ( )
2
y= x 5
= .
5. [Ans. A]
8. [Ans. D]
b a 2 0
h= = = By the definition only
n
y = sin(0) = 0
y = sin ( ) = 0.70 0
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 65
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
∫ dx = [y y 2(y )] f (x ) =
x 2
For N-R method
= [ 0. 2 0.5] x =x
( )
2 ( )
= . ( )
x =x
12. [Ans. *] Range 0.53 to 0.56
Let f(x) = 5x 2 cos x Simplifying which we get
f (x) = 5 2 sin x x = 2x ax
f(0) = f( ) = 2.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 66
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
2. [Ans. B] f(x )
x =x
For a = 7 iteration equation f (x )
Becomes x = 2x 7x (x x )
=x
with x = 0.2 ( x )
x = 2x 7x = 2× 0.2 – 7(0.2) = 0.12 x x x x
and x = 2x 7x = 2× 0.12 7(0. 2) =
( x )
= 0.1392 2x
x =
x
3. [Ans. A]
f(x) = 1, 4, 15 at x = 0, 1 and 2
5. [Ans. A]
respectively
Given
∫ f(x)dx = (f 2f f ) x – 10 x + 31x 30 = 0
(3 points Trapezoidal Rule) One root = 5
Here h = 1 Let the roots be α β and γ of equation
∫ f(x)dx = (1 + 2(4) + 15) = 12 ax + bx + cx + d = 0
Approximate value by rapezoidal ule αβγ=
= 12 and α β βγ γα =
Since f(x) is second degree polynomial, let ( )
α βγ = 5 βγ = = 30
f(x) = a0 + a x + a x
f(0) = 1 βγ = (i)
a 0 0= Also
a = αβ βγ γα = 5β βγ 5γ = =
f(1) = 4 5 (β γ) βγ =
a a a = ince βγ = from (i)
1+ a a = 5 (β γ) =
a a = β γ=5
f(2) = 15 βγ =
a 2a a = 5 olving for β and γ
2a a = 5 β (5 β) =
2a a = β 5β =0
Solving (i) and (ii) a = and a = β = 2 and γ =
f(x) = 1 – x + 4 x Alternative method
Now exact value ∫ f(x)dx 5 1 0 31 0
0 5 25 30
=∫ ( x x )dx
1 5 6 0
= *x + = (x 5)(x 5x )=0
Error = exact – Approximate value (x 5)(x 2)(x )=0
x=2 5
= 2=
4. [Ans. A ] 6. [Ans. D]
Y = a + bx
Given f(x) = x x =0
Given
f (x) = x
n= ∑x = ∑y = 2 ∑x = 14
Newton – Raphson formula is
and ∑xy =
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 67
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
= 0.25( 0. 2 2 = [( 0 2 ) 2(2 ) ( )]
0. 0. 0.5) = 2 5.
= 0.7 5 The value of integral
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 68
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
x = = 1000 e
∫ (x 0) dx = * 0x+ ( )/
5
3. [Ans. C]
= 0 =2 .
5 x = (x )
Magnitude of error
= 2 5. 2 . = 0.5 At convergence
x =x =α
CS α= (α )
1. [Ans. A] 2α=α+
Given x = + , x = 0.5
2α =
when the series converges x =x =α
2α = α + R
α= +
α =R
α= α=√
8α = 4α +9 So this iteration will compute the square
root of R
α =
α = = 1.5 4. [Ans. D]
y=x
2. [Ans. A] dy
= 2x
Here, the function being integrated is dx
f(x)= x
f(x) = xe
.
f (x) = xe + e = e (x + 1) x = .5
.
f’ (x) = xe + e + e = e (x + 2) = . 07
Since, both are increasing
functions of x, maximum value of f ( ) in 5. [Ans. B]
interval 1 2, occurs at = 2 so f( ) = 5
max |f ( )| =e (2 2) = e f( ) = 5 72 = 57 7 0
Truncation Error for trapezoidal rule f( ) 0 f( ) 0
= TE (bound) x =( )=5 f(x ) 0
2
= max |f ( )|
oot lies between and
Where is number of subintervals
x =( )=2 f(x ) 0
= 2
After ' ' interations we get the root
= max |f ( )|
6. [Ans. D]
= (b – a) max |f ( )| 1 2
h
= (2 – 1) [e (2 + 2)] ∫ f(x)dx = [f(0) f( ) 2(∑f )]
2
= e . 0 2(0.0 0.
= [ ]
Now putting = 0 0. . . 7.2 )
( )
.
= [ 5 . ]
=
= 9.045
h=
Now, No. of intervals, =
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 69
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
7. [Ans. – ] 8 4
x1 2
Given (x) + f(x) + t cos x = 0 12 3
and f(x) = x sin x
f (x) = x cos x + sin x 3. [Ans. C]
f (x) = x ( sin x) + cos x + cos x Given : f(x)= x e
= 2 cos x – x sin x By Newton Raphson method,
= 2 cos x – f (x) f(x ) x e
x =x =x
2 cos x – f (x) + f(x) +t cos x = 0 f (x ) e
2 cos x = tcos x t = 2 e xn
1 x n
1 exn
8. [Ans. A]
f(x) = 0.75x 2x 2x 4. [Ans. C]
f (x) = 2.25x x 2 f(x )
x =2 f = 2 f = x =x
f (x )
f f(2) = (2 ) = √2 and
x =x =0 √2
f √
f = f = 2 f (2) = =
√ √
f x =2
(√ )
= .
x =x =2 √
f √
f = 2 f =
f 5. [Ans. D]
x =x =0 f(x) = a x a x a x a x a
f
Also, root does not lies between 0 and 1 If the above equation have complex roots,
So, the method diverges if x = 2 then they must be in complex conjugate
nly ( )is true. pair, because it’s given all co-efficients are
positive ( they are real )
9. [Ans. C] So if complex roots are even no. (in pair)
For value of K if trapezoidal rule is used then real roots will also be even.
then the value is either greater than ption ( )is wrong
actual value of definite integral and if From the equation
impson’s rule is used then value is exact roduct of roots = ( 0)
Hence both statements are TRUE As no. of roots = 4,
Product of roots < 1
ECE
either one root 0
1. [Ans. C]
(or)
By definition (& the application) of
Product of three roots < 0
various methods
ption ( )is rong.
2. [Ans. B] Now, take option (A),
y(t) =x3 x2 + 4x 4=0 Let us take it is correct .
x0 = 2 Roots are in complex conjugate pairs
f x0 =
Next approximation x1 x0
f ' x0
Product of roots
0
x03 x02 4x0 4 | | | | 0 which is not possible
x1 x0
3x02 2x0 4 ption (A) is wrong
orrect answer is option ( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 70
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
8. [Ans. D] 3. [Ans. C]
=e u(t)
∑ = . .. = e
n 2 x
x x
as e = . . . x in
2
EE t
1. [Ans. D] x = ∫ e u(t) dt = ∫ f(t) dt
Here, = At t = 0.01, x = Area of trapezoidal
.
x = [f(0) f(0.0 )] = [ e .
]
f(x y) =
= 0.0099
Euler’s method equation is
x = x h. f(x y )
4. [Ans. A]
x ( )
x = x h( ) x =x
( )
h h
x =( )x = x
h = *x +
or stability | |
h 5. [Ans. B]
u(x x ) = 0x sin x 0. = 0
since h = Δ here v(x x ) = 0x 0x cosx 0. = 0
Δ
The Jacobian matrix is
u u
Δ 2
x x
o maximum permissible value of Δ is 2 .
v v
[ x x ]
2. [Ans. A]
Here f(x) = e 0x cos x 0sinx
=[ ]
0x sinx 20x 0cosx
f (x) = e
The Newton Raphson iterative equation is The matrix at x = 0 x = is
( )
x =x 0 0
( ) =* +
0 0
f(x ) = e
f’(x ) = e 6. [Ans. D]
x =x x x x =0
–( ) (x )(x )=0
i.e. x =
x =0 x =0
( )
= x= x= j
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 71
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
x =5
Δ 2
/
x =5 = 1.70
6. [Ans. A]
2. [Ans. A] dv
Assume x = √ =v t
dt
f(x) = x =0 t v dv
=v t
f(x ) 2 dt
x =x = [x ] 0 0 0 0+0 0. = 0
f (x ) 2 x
0.1 0 0+0.1 0. = 0.0
3. [Ans. C]
Given p(x) = x + x + 2 7. [Ans. C]
There is no sign change, hence at most 0 f(x) = x x
positive root ( rom escarte’s rule of f (x) = x = g(x)
signs) x = initial guess
p( x) = x x+2 g (x) = x
g (x )
There is one sign change, hence at most 1 x =x
negative root ( rom escarte’s rule of g (x )
signs)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 72
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
( )
= = .5
g(x )
x =x
g (x )
0.75
= .5
= . 7
8. [Ans. D]
dy
= 2xy x = 0 y = h = 0.2
dx
y =y h. f(x y )
= (0.2)f(0 ) =
and y = y [f(x y ) f(x y )]
= (0. )[f(0 ) f(0.2 )]
= 0.
is the value of y after first step, using
Euler’s predictor – corrector method
9. [Ans. B]
For convergence
x = x =x x= (2x )
x
x = x= √
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 73
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Calculus
ME – 2005 ME – 2006
1. The line integral ∫ ⃗ ⃗⃗⃗⃗ of the vector 2x2 7x 3
7. If f( x ) = , then limf(x) will
function ⃗ ( ) 2xyz ̂+ x²z + ̂ k²y ̂ from 5x2 12x 9 x 3
leads to
ME – 2007
I =∫ ∫ ( ) What is q?
( )
(A) 4y (C) X 10.
(B) 16y² (D) 8 (A) 0 (C)
(B) ⁄ (D) 1
5. ∫ ( ) is equal to
(A) ∫ 11. The area of a triangle formed by the tips
(B) 2∫ of vectors a , b and c is
(C) 2∫ ( ) (A) ( )( )
(D) Zero (B) |( ) ( )|
B
x+2y=2
1
P x X
A
0 2
(A) ⁄ (C) ⁄ (A) (C)
(B) ⁄ (D) 1 (B) (D) 1
ME – 2010 ME – 2012
26. Velocity vector of a flow field is given as 33. Consider the function ( ) in the
⃗ ̂ .̂ The vorticity vector at interval . At the point x = 0,
(1, 1, 1) is f(x) is
(A) 4 ̂ ̂ (C) ̂ ̂ (A) Continuous and differentiable.
(B) 4 ̂ ̂ (D) ̂ ̂ (B) Non – continuous and differentiable.
(C) Continuous and non – differentiable.
27. The function (D) Neither continuous nor
(A) o o ∀ R differentiable.
∀ R
(B) o o ∀ R 34. . / is
∀ R
(A) 1/4 (C) 1
except at x = 3/2
(B) 1/2 (D) 2
(C) o o ∀ R
∀ R
35. At x = 0, the function f(x) = has
except at x = 2/3
(A) A maximum value
(D) o o ∀ R except at x = 3
(B) A minimum value
∀ R
(C) A singularity
28. The value of the integral ∫ is (D) A point of inflection
(A) –π (C) π
36. For the spherical surface
(B) –π (D) π
the unit outward
29. The parabolic arc √ is normal vector at the point
revolved around the x-axis. The volume of . /
√ √
the solid of revolution is (A) ̂ ̂
(A) π (C) π √ √
42. . ( )
/ is equal to CE – 2005
(A) 0 (C) 1 1. Value of the integral ∮ ( ).
(B) 0.5 (D) 2 Where, c is the square cut from the first
quadrant by the lines x = 1 and y = 1 will
43. Curl of vector ( G ’ h o o h h
⃗ ̂ ̂ ̂ line integral into double integral)
(A) ( )̂ ̂ ̂ (A) ⁄ (C) ⁄
(B) ( )̂ ̂ ̂ (B) 1 (D) ⁄
(C) ̂ ̂ ̂
(D) ̂ ̂ ̂ 2. A rail engine accelerates from its
stationary position for 8 seconds and
44. The best approximation of the minimum travels a distance of 280 m. According to
value attained by (100x) for ≥ the Mean Value theorem, the
is _______ speedometer at a certain time during
acceleration must read exactly.
(A) 0 kmph (C) 75 kmph
(B) 8 kmph (D) 126 kmph
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 77
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
CE – 2008 (B) 2∫ √
8. The equation + = 0 can be
(C) ∫ √
transformed to + = 0 by substituting
(D) ∫ √
(A) (C) √
(B)
(D) √ . /
14. The is
(A) 2/3 (C) 3/2
9. The inner (dot) product of two vectors ⃗ (B) 1 (D)
and ⃗ is zero. The angle (degrees)
between in two vectors is 15. Given a function
(A) 0 (C) 90 ( )
(B) 30 (D) 120 The optimal value of f(x, y)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 78
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
CE – 2011 CE – 2014
√
16. ∫ ? 22. . / o
√ √
(A) 0 (C) a (A) (C) 1
(B) a/2 (D) 2a (B) (D)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 79
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
CS – 2005 CS – 2010
1
1. Let G(x) g(i)xi where |x|<1. 7. What is the value of . / ?
(1 x) i0
2
(A) 0 (C)
What is g(i)?
(B) (D) 1
(A) i (C) 2i
(B) i+1 (D) 2i
CS – 2011
8. Given i = √ , what will be the
CS – 2007
evaluation of the definite integral
2. Consider the following two statements
about the function f(x) =|x|: ∫
P: f(x) is continuous for all real values of x (A) 0 (C) –i
Q: f(x) is differentiable for all real values (B) 2 (D) i
of x
Which of the following is true? CS – 2012
(A) P is true Q is false 9. Consider the function f(x)= sin(x) in the
(B) P is false Q is true interval x ,π⁄ π⁄ -. The number and
(C) Both P and Q are true location(s) of the local minima of this
(D) Both P and Q are false function are
(A) One , at π⁄
CS – 2008 (B) One , at π⁄
x sinx (C) Two , at π⁄ and π
3. Lim equals
x x cosx (D) Two , at π⁄ and π
(A) 1 (C)
CS – 2013
(B) 1 (D)
10. Which one the following function is
continuous at x =3?
4. Let
P=∑ ∑
(A) ( ) {
where k is a positive integer. Then
(A) (C)
(B) ( ) 2
(B) (D)
(C) ( ) 2
5. A point on a curve is said to be extreme if
it is a local minimum or a local maximum. (D) ( )
The number of distinct extrema for the
CS – 2014
curve 3x 16x 24x 37 is
4 3 2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 80
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
The integral sin d is given by
3
3.
15. The value of the integral given below is 0
1 4
∫ o (A) (C)
2 3
(A) π (C) – π 2 8
(B ) (D)
(B) π (D) π 3 3
(B) P P
2
(D) P 2P
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 81
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1
h ∫ ( ) along
1
X the semicircle with the line segment PQ as
1 2 3
its diameter
(A) 1.0 (C) 4.0
(A) Is
(B) 2.5 (D) 5.0
(B) Is 0
(C) Is 1
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 82
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(A) 1
x 2 ..... volume V. If is the position vector of a
3! point inside S, with ̂ the unit normal of S,
1
x
2
.....
the value of the integral ∯ ̂⃗ is
(B) (A) 3V (C) 10V
3!
(B) 5V (D) 15V
1
x
2
.....
(C)
3! ECE\IN – 2012
x 2
23. The direction of vector A is radially
(D) 1 ..... outward from the origin, with
3!
where and K is
19. If a vector field ⃗ is related to another constant. The value of n for which
. A = 0 is
vector field ⃗ through ⃗ = ⃗ , which
(A) 2 (C) 1
of the following is true? Note: C and
(B) 2 (D) 0
refer to any closed contour and any
surface whose boundary is C.
ECE\EE – 2012
(A) ∮ ⃗ ⃗ = ∬ ⃗ ⃗
24. The maximum value of
(B) ∮ ⃗ ⃗ = ∬⃗ ⃗ ( ) in the interval
⃗ ⃗ = [1,6] is
(C) ∮ ∬⃗ ⃗
(A) 21 (C) 41
(D) ∮ ⃗ ⃗ = ∬⃗ ⃗ (B) 25 (D) 46
(A) 0 (C) 1
(B) ⁄√ (D) 2√
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 83
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
27. Consider a vector field ⃗ ( ) The closed 34. The magnitude of the gradient for the
loop line integral ∮ ⃗ can be expressed function ( ) at the
as point (1,1,1) is_______.
(A) ∯( ⃗ ) over the closed
35. The directional derivative of
surface boundary by the loop
( ) ( ) ( )in the direction
(B) ∰( ⃗ )dv over the closed volume √
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 84
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE – 2007 EE – 2010
6. The integral ∫ ( ) o 11. At t = 0, the function ( ) has
equals (A) a minimum
(A) o (C) (1/2) o (B) a discontinuity
(B) 0 (D) (1/2) (C) a point of inflection
(D) a maximum
EE – 2008
7. Consider function f(x)= ( ) where 12. Divergence of the three-dimensional
x is a real number. Then the function has radial vector field is
(A) only one minimum (A) 3 (C) ̂ ̂ ̂
(B) only two minima (B) 1/r (D) ̂( ̂ ̂)
(C) three minima
(D) three maxima 13. The value of the quantity P, where
∫ , is equal to
EE – 2009
(A) 0 (C) e
8. f(x, y) is a continuous function defined
(B) 1 (D) 1/e
over (x, y) [0, 1] [0, 1]. Given the two
constraints, x > and y > , the
EE – 2011
volume under f(x, y) is
14. The two vectors [1, 1, 1] and [1, a, ],
√
(A) ∫ ∫ ( ) √
where a = . /, are
(B) ∫ ∫ ( ) (A) orthonormal
(C) ∫ ∫ ( ) (B) orthogonal
(C) parallel
√ √
(D) ∫ ∫ ( ) (D) collinear
9. A cubic polynomial with real coefficients 15. The function f(x) = 2x – has
(A) can possibly have no extrema and no (A) a maxima at x = 1 and a minima at
zero crossings x=5
(B) may have up to three extrema and (B) a maxima at x = 1 and a minima at
upto 2 zero crossings x= 5
(C) cannot have more than two extrema (C) only a maxima at x = 1
and more than three zero crossings (D) only a minima at x = 1
(D) will always have an equal number of
extrema and zero crossings EE – 2013
16. Given a vector field
10. F(x, y) = ( )̂ ( )̂ ’ , the line integral
line integral over the straight line from ∫ evaluated along a segment on the x-
( ) = (0, 2) to ( ) = (2, 0) axis from x = 1 to x = 2 is
evaluates to (A) 2.33 (C) 2.33
(A) –8 (C) 8 (B) 0 (D) 7
(B) 4 (D) 0
17. The curl of the gradient of the scalar field
defined by
(A)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 85
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(B)
√ (D)
21. To evaluate the double integral √
( ⁄ )
∫ .∫ . / / dy, we make the
2. Given a real-valued continuous function
substitution u = ( ) and . The f(t) defined over [0,1], ∫ ( ) is
integral will reduce to (A) (C) f(1)
( ) ∫ (∫ ) (B) 0 (D) f(0)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 86
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
6. The plot of a function f(x) is shown in the (B) once differentiable but not twice
following figure. A possible expression for (C) twice differentiable but not thrice
the function f(x) is (D) thrice differentiable
f(x)
11. For real x, the maximum value of is.
1 (A) 1 (C) √
(B) e 1 (D)
x IN – 2008
0 12. Consider the function y = x2 6x + 9. The
(A) ( ) (C) ( ) maximum value of y obtained when x
(B) . / (D) . / varies over the interval 2 to 5 is
(A) 1 (C) 4
IN – 2006 (B) 3 (D) 9
7. The function ( ) is
approximated as where is in 13. The expression for x > 0 is equal to
radian. The maximum value of for (A) – (C)
which the error due to the approximation (B) x (D)
is within
(A) 0.1 rad (C) 0.3 rad 14. Given y = + 2x + 10, the value of |
(B) 0.2 rad (D) 0.4 rad
is equal to
(A) 0 (C) 12
8. The solution of the integral equation
(B) 4 (D) 13
()
() ( )∫ ( ) ( ) 15.
(A) Indeterminate (C) 1
(A) ( () ( )) (B) 0 (D)
(B) ( () ( )) IN – 2009
( () ( )) 16. A sphere of unit radius is centered at the
(C)
( () ( )) origin. The unit normal at a point (x, y, z)
( () ( )) on the surface of the sphere is
(D) ( ( ) ( ))
(A) (x, y, z) (C) . /
√ √ √
(B) . /
IN – 2007
√ √ √ (D) . /
√ √ √
9. The value of the integral
∫ ∫ dx dy is. IN – 2010
(C) Π 17. The electric charge density in the region
(A) √π⁄
(D) π⁄ R: is given as
(B) √π
σ( ) , where x and y are in
meters. The total charge (in coulomb)
10. Consider the function f(x) = , where x
contained in the region R is
is real. Then the function f(x) at x = 0 is
(A) π (C) π⁄
(A) continuous but not differentiable
(B) π (D) 0
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 87
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN – 2013
21. For a vector E, which one the following
statement is NOT TRUE?
(A) E E o o
(B) If E E is called conservative
(C) If E E is called irrotational
(D) E E -rotational
IN – 2014
22. A vector is defined as
̂ ̂ ̂
Where ̂ ̂ ̂ are unit vectors in
Cartesian ( ) coordinate system.
The surface integral ∯ f.ds over the
closed surface S of a cube with vertices
having the following coordinates:
(0,0,0),(1,0,0),(1,1,0),(0,1,0),(0,0,1),
(1,0,1),(1,1,1),(0,1,1) is________
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 88
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ME = 0 o 1
1. [Ans. A]
√ √
Since, potential function of ⃗ is x²yz = 0 1
( ) ( ) ( )
9. [Ans. B]
2. [Ans. D]
o h 10. [Ans. B]
π h π o ( ) ( )
For V to be max
This is of the form . /
Hence, h Applying L hospital rule
( )
. /
3. [Ans. A]
=
( ) | | | | =
=
11. [Ans. B]
Let the vectors be
4. [Ans. A]
After changing order ∫ ∫ ( )
12. [Ans. B]
Applying ’ Hospital rule, we get
Given: √ √ √
I=
( ) √
I=
( )
8. [Ans. A]
For
∫ 0 1 [ ]
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 89
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
16. [Ans. B]
h o o o Φ 20. [Ans. D]
⃗⃗ div {( )̂ ( )̂ ( )̂}
along a vector ⃗ ( Φ)
( ) ( ) ( )
Hence directional derivative is
( ̂ ̂) =3
(grad (x2+2y2+z)).
√
̂ ̂)
(2x ̂ ̂ ̂ ). ( 21. [Ans. C]
=
Hence at (1,1,2),
⇒
Directional derivative =
⇒ ( )
17. [Ans. A]
I = ∬ .dx dy
⇒ ( )
The limit of y is form 0 to and limit
of x from 0 to 2 ( )( )
I =∫ ∫ ∫ . /
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 90
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
24. [Ans. B]
x4
4x Y
16
or x4 64x B
or x(x 64) 0
3
or x3 64 A
X
or x 4 x = cos
y 4 y=sin
Required area = ∫ .√ / Path is x2 y2 1
2 x3
4
R e
2 x3 2
3 120 (x y)2 1 2sin cos
2 2
4 64 cos2
(4)3 2 (1 sin2)d
3 12 0 2 0
32 16 16 1 1
= 1
3 3 3 2 2 2 2
Alternately Alternately
For point where both parabolas cut each Given: x2 y2 1
other
Put x=cos , and y=sin
y2 4x, x2 4y
x 4 4x
2
x y 2 cos2 sin2 2sincos
= 1 sin2
or x2 8 x
or x4 64x
∫ ( )
or x3 64
x 4,0 ,(4,0) cos2 1 1
2
Required area 2 0 2 2 2
4 4
x2
4x dx 1
0 0 4 2
4
2 x3 16
2 x3 2 25. [Ans. C]
3 120 3
F 3xzi 2xyj yz2k
⃗ ⃗
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 91
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
( ) ( ) ( ) √
3z 2x 2yz
π ∫ π* +
At point (1, 1, 1), divergence =3+2 2=3
π
π( )
26. [Ans. D]
⃗
o ⃗ ⃗ 30. [Ans. D]
̂ ̂ ̂ If f(x) even function
∫ ( ) ∫ ( )
|| ||
31. [Ans. D]
̂ ( )̂ Standard limit formulae
o ( ) ̂ ̂
32. [Ans. B]
27. [Ans. C]
⇒ 33. [Ans. C]
The function is continuous in [ 1, 1]
It is also differentiable in [ 1, 1] except at
x = 0.
Since Left derivative = 1 and
Right derivative = 1 at x = 0
1 1 2
34. [Ans. B]
o
y is continuous for all x R, and
differentiable for all x R, except at , Using this standard limit, here a = 1 then
since at o o ’ h = ( ) /2 =1/2
value towards the left and right side of
35. [Ans. D]
( )
( )
28. [Ans. D] ( )
( )
∫ , - π
f(x) has a point of inflection at x =0.
∫ π ( )
Volume from x = 1 to x = 2, ̂ ̂ ̂
̂ ̂ ̂
∫π
( )
√ √
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 92
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
̂ 38. [Ans. A]
̂ ̂
√ √ By Gauss Divergence theorem,
√ ̂ √ ̂ ̂
√ √ ∬( ̅ ̅) ∭( )
The unit outward normal vector at point
P is (Surface Integral is transformed to
volume Integral)
( )
( ) ( ) ( )
(√ ̂ √ )̂
̂ ̂
√ √
∭( ) ∭
37. [Ans. A]
The area enclosed is shown below as
shaded π
π
( ) ∬( ̅ ̂) ∭( )
( π)
( ) π
The coordinates of point P and Q is
obtained by solving 39. [Ans. C]
y = x and y = simultaneously,
i.e. x = ∫(√ ) ( )
⇒ ( )
⇒ Using Integration by parts
Now, x = 0 ⇒ which is point Q(0,0) ∫ ∫
and x = 1 ⇒ which is point
P(1,1) Here,
So required area is f=ln(x) and dg=√
and g=
∫ ∫ o
∫(√ ) ( )
* + * +
[ ] ∫ ( )
[ ] [ ]
( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 93
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
40. [Ans. A] π
0 o 1
So the minimum value is
[Differentiating both . /
=
o o o w ’
Hospital method]
. / 45. [Ans. D]
o o o o ( ) o
o o
( ) ( )
otherwise it is said to be discontinuous.
41. [Ans. B] So the most appropriate option is D.
G o
46. [Ans. C]
̂ ̂ ̂ ( )
| |
Div
Vectors are linearly dependent
42. [Ans. B]
( )
) (
( ) 47. [Ans. B]
, ho - Let
o ( )( )
( )
( ) ( )
o ( )( ) ∫
( ) o ( )
43. [Ans. A] ∫
̂ ̂ ̂ o
( ) () o o
⃗
[ ]
48. [Ans. B]
̂[ ( ) ( )]
∫ ∫ ∫ |
̂[ ( ) ( )]
∫ , -
̂[ ( ) ( )]
,̂ - ,̂ - ̂, - ∫ ( ) |
( )̂ ( )̂ ( )̂
[ ]
44. [Ans. *] Range 1.00 to 0.94
h o , - , -
π
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 94
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Here I = ∮ ( )
, ∫ ∫ -
∮ (( ) ( ) )
= xy =∫ ∫ ( o )
= y and = 2y o
∫( )
’ h o w
I= ∫ ∫ , ( )-
π
. / | |
=∫ ∫
=∫ ∫ π π π √
. / ( )
2. [Ans. D] π π √
* ( )+
Since the position of rail engine S(t) is
continuous and differentiable function π π √
* +
according to Lagrange’s mean value
theorem more π √
( ) ( ) ( )
(t) = v(t) =
( )
= m/sec
= × kmph 4. [Ans. C]
= 126 kmph f = 2 +3 ( )⃗
Where v(t) is the velocity of the rail
engine.
= 4xi + 6yj + 2zk
3. [Ans. D] At P (2, 1, 3)
h ’ o h
r=2acos Directional derivation ̂
(i) r = a represents a circle with centre ( )
( )
( ) ‘ ’ √ ( )
(ii) r = 2acos represents a circle ( ) ( ) ( )
symmetric about OX with centre at
√
( ) ‘ ’
The circles are shown in figure below. At
√
h o o o ‘ ’
P 5. [Ans. A]
y Q
Potential function,
π 3
x
O A
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 95
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
8. [Ans. D]
Put √
Integrating ∫ ∫
=√
wh o
=√ …… ( )
⇒
Now given equation is
……….. (ii)
6. [Ans. B] h h h
Let I(α) ∫ dx …( ) ( ) ( )
=∫ ( ) . / = ( √ ) [ from eqn(i)]
= ∫
h
Then Integrating by parts we get, √ ( )
= 0 ( α o )1
h h
= . / √ ( ( ) )
=
h
dI = √ ( √ )
Integrating, I = α
( ) o () ( ) h
+C=0
C=
π Now substitute in eqn (ii) we get
(α) α
h h
π
( )
I(0) = h h
⇒
But from equation (i), I(0) = ∫ dx
h h
⇒
∫ dx =
Which is the desired form
7. [Ans. D]
√ is the correct transformation.
̅=5 +2 + 3y ⃗
(⃗ ) 9. [Ans. C]
̅ ̅=0
= 5y + 4y + 6yz
̅ ̅ o
At(1, 1, 1)
If ̅ ̅ = 0
div ( ) = 5.1 + 4.1 + 6.1.1
= 15 o
Since P and Q are non-zero vectors
o
0
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 96
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
10. [Ans. A] √
Since the limit is a function of x. We first √
√ √
integrate w.r.t. y and then w.r.t. x √
∫ ∫( )
13. [Ans. D]
Length of curve f(x) between x = a and
x = b is given by
∫ ∫( )
∫√ ( )
∫ * +
Here, 4h … … ( )
= 8h
∫ ( )
Since
and y = h at x =
∫ ( )
(As can be seen from equation (i), by
substituting x = 0 and x = L/2)
* ( ) ( )+
(Length of cable)
* + =∫ √ . /
h
ho ∫ √
11. [Ans. B]
f = + 3 +2 14. [Ans. A]
f = grad f = i +j +k
= i(2x) + j(6y) + k(4z)
The gradient at P(1, 2, 1) is
= i(2×1) + j(6×2) + k(4 ( ))
= 2i + 12j – 4k 15. [Ans. A]
( )
12. [Ans. B]
( )
⃗
⃗ ̂
⃗ Putting,
⃗
√
o ̂ Given,
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 97
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Since, π
⇒λ
Since, ⇒λ
We have either a maxima or minima at
. / 18. [Ans. A]
( )
19. [Ans. A]
Area = |̅ ̅ |
̅̅̅̅ ̅̅̅̅
R ( ) ( )
2I = |
∫ o o
I = a/2
⇒ o
17. [Ans. C]
For a function f(x) to be continuous, ⇒ ∫ ( )
at x=a
( ) ( ) ∫ ( )
If f(x) is continuous at x=
π λ o * +
. /
[ ]
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 98
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
( ) ( ) ( )
[ ] | |
π π
∫ o
∫ o ( o )
( )
∫ o o
o ( )
∫ o
( )
[ ] ⇒
Magnitude of acceleration
22. [Ans. C] =√ ( )
( ) 25. [Ans. B]
We have
⇒ ( )
∫ ( )
⇒
, ow - ∫ ( ) ∫ ( )
=1+0=1
Hence correct option is (C)
∫ ( )
23. [Ans. A]
(4, 3)
a
(2, 2)
c
b x ( )μ
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 99
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
26. [Ans. A]
=
α = =1
Use L – hospital Rule
4. [Ans. A]
α
P=∑ … ( –1)
o
= log x ‘ ’ w h a =1, l=2k 1
P= ( ) ( )
CS =
1. [Ans. B] Q=∑ … k
1
n 1 r
Cr xr ‘ ’ w h k
1 x r0
n
( ) ( )
1
Putting n=2, 21 r
Cr xr
1 x 2 r0
r1 Cr xr r1 C1xr ⇒
r 0 r 0
r 1 xr i 1 xi 5. [Ans. D]
r 0 i 0 y = 3 – 16 – 24 + 37
(since r is a dummy variable, r can be = 12 48 – 48 x = 0
replaced by i)
x (12 – 48x 48 ) = 0
x = 0 or 12 – 48x – 48 = 0
∑ ()
4x – 4 = 0
g(i) =i+1 √ √ √
x= = =
=2 √
2. [Ans. A]
f(x)= |x| = 36 96x 48
Continuity: In other words, Now at x = 0
f(x) = x o ≥ = 48 0
x for x< 0
Since, = =0 , At 2 ± √ also 0 (using
f (x) is continuous for all real values of x calculator)
Differentiability: There are 3 extrema in this function
( ) ( )
( ) 6. [Ans. D]
( )
Since ∫ ( ) =∫ ( )
R h
I =∫
So |x| is continuous but not differentiable
( )
at x=0 =∫
( )
Since tan (A B) =
3. [Ans. A]
⁄
= ⁄
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 100
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
[ ]
∫
[ ]
9. [Ans. B]
0 1
∫ f(x) = sin x
0 1 ⇒ ( ) o
( ) ⇒ o
( ) ( ) π π π π
∫ [ ]
( ) ( )
( )
∫ ∫ At . / gives maximum
value
=, ( )- At . / gives minimum
= ln ( sec ) – ln (sec 0) value
= ln (√ ) ( )
= ln ( )–0= 10. [Ans. A]
For x = , f(x) =
7. [Ans. B] For x = , f(x) = 3 – 1 = 2
For x = 3, f(x) = 2
( ) *( ) + ( ) ( ) = f(3)
* ( ) + 11. [Ans. C]
By Mean value theorem
. /
( ) [ ]
12. [Ans. A]
Define g(x) = f(x) – f(x + 1) in [0, 1]. g(0)
is negative and g(1) is positive. By
8. [Ans. D] intermediate value theorem there is
€( ) h h g(y) = 0
o That is f(y) = f(y + 1)
∫
o Thus Answer is (A)
∫ 13. [Ans. 2]
* w +
* w +
∫ For min maximum non – common
elements must be there
⇒ * +
* + must be common to any 2 elements
of V1
[ ] ( )minimum value = 2
, -( o π π )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 101
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
14. [Ans. 4]
∫ | ∫∫
∫ π
o ( )
oπ π o (π)
π o π π
Hence option (A) is correct
∫ ∫( )
ECE
1. [Ans. C]
∫ ∫ (∫ )
dy
o ∫ o 0 for x< 0
dx
o dy
0 for x> 0
Substituting the limits dx
π o (π) o ( )
π 2. [Ans. A]
ex
∫ Given, f x
1 ex
f ' x
1 e .e e
x x 2x
ex
0
1 e x 2
∫ | ∫∫ 2
1 ex
= x cos 3. [Ans. C]
= π o ( π) π o π ∫
= π
LHS = I + II = π π π⇒
∫( o )
∫
| |
∫ ( ) ( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 102
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
8. [Ans. A]
Given, f x x2 x 2
df x
0
dx
4. [Ans. A] 2x 1=0
o ’ h o 1
x
∬( ) ∮ 2
d2f x
= 2 ve
5. [Ans. D] dx2
From vector triple product So it shows only minima for interval
( ) ( ) ( ) [ 4, 4], it contains a maximum value that
Here, will be at x= 4 or x=4
⇒ ( ) ( ) ( ) f( 4)=18 and f(+4)=10
( ) ( )
9. [Ans. D]
6. [Ans. A] y f x ; x 0,
( )
For strictly bounded, 0 limy
x x0 f' x0 x x0 f'' x0
2 x0
f x0 ...... or 0 lim y
1 2 x
x 22 2
So, y e x is strictly bounded
e (x 2)(e
2 2
)
2
e ......
2
e2 3 x
x 22 ...... 10. [Ans. A]
2 sin /2 1 sin /2
lim lim
0 0 2
/2
(Neglecting higher power of x)
1 sin /2 1
= lim
7. [Ans. C] 2 0 /2 2
ex e x
coth (x)= =
ex ex
11. [Ans. B]
x x2 x3 Two points on line are ( 1, 0) and (0, 1)
e 1 ..........
x
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 103
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
4
I 4x3 10 2x dx 4x3 160x4 dx
0 0
1
4x4 160 5
= x 33
5 0
(1, 0)
4
∫( ) 16. [Ans. A]
f(x)= +
(x)= =0 x=0
∫ ∫ (x)= + >0 x R.
Hence minimum at x=0
f(0)=1+1=2
[ | | ] Alternatively:
For any even function the maxima &
minima can be found by
13. [Ans. B] A.M. >= GM
Let f(x) ex sinx => exp(x) + exp( x) ≥ 2
o ’ Hence minimum value = 2
f x f a x a f'a
x a
2
f x f x f'
x
2
f''
2!
f '' P
Coefficient of (x )2 is
2
f'' ex sinx |at x e
Coefficient of (x )2=0.5 exp () ∫( )
14. [Ans. A]
∫ ∫
o [ | | ]
Thus, ( )w h o ow
( )w h ow
o ( )w h ow
o ( )w h ow
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 104
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
20. [Ans. C] ( )∭
̂ ̂ ( and is the position vector)
⃗⃗⃗ ̂ ̂
⃗⃗⃗ ⃗⃗⃗ 23. [Ans. A]
Y
̂ ̂
S R
3 ̅ ( )]
⇒ [
1 Q
P ⇒ [ ( )]
X ⇒ ( )
√ √
⇒ ( ) ⇒
∮ ⃗ ⃗⃗⃗
⇒
∫ ⃗ ⃗⃗⃗ ∫ ⃗ ⃗⃗⃗ ∫ ⃗ ⃗⃗⃗ ∫ ⃗ ⃗⃗⃗
√
24. [Ans. C]
√
∫ ⃗ ⃗⃗⃗ ∫ * + [ ] ( ) , -
√ √ ( ) ( )
= [ along PQ y =1 dy =0] ( ) ⇒
are the stationary points
∫ ⃗ ⃗⃗⃗ ∫ .√ / , - ( )
( ) ( )
∫ ⃗ ⃗⃗⃗
√
∫√ . / and f(2) = 25 and f(4)=21
√ √
M o ( ) , -
[ ] f(6)=41
∫ ⃗ ⃗⃗⃗ ∫ .√ / ( )
25. [Ans. B]
∮ ⃗ ⃗⃗⃗
⇒
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 105
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
o 30. [Ans. C]
E o
( )
π
⇒
31. [Ans. *] Range to 0.01
E o o ( ) ( )
26. [Ans. D] ( )
̅ ̂ ̂ ̂ ⇒
⇒
( )
= ( )
=1+1+1 ( )
=3 o h
∫ * +
∫
Given o …
( )( o )
29. [Ans. A]
o o
( )
̇( ) ⇒ ( ) o ⇒
⇒ ( ) o
Since ( ) is negative, maximum value of ⇒
o
f(x) will be where ( )
0( )
1
⇒ ⇒
o oh
⇒ ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ( )( ))
( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 106
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE ∫ ( ) ∫ ( π )
1. [Ans. C] On simplification we get option (D)
Grad u = ̂ ⁄
7. [Ans. B]
At (1, 3) Grad u = √ ,( ⁄ ) - f(x) = ( )
(x) = 2( )
=√ =4x( ) =0
x = 0, x = 2 and x = 2 are the stationary
2. [Ans. A] points.
f(x) = (x) = 4[x(2x) +( ) ]
(x) = ( ) = 4[2 -
= ( ) = 4 [3 -
Putting ( (x) = 0 = 12
( )=0 (0) = < 0, maxima at x = 0
( )=0 (2) =(12)
x = 0 or x = 2 are the stationary points. = 32 > 0, minima at x =
Now, ( 2) =12( )
(x) = ( ) ( )( ) = 32 > 0; minima at x =
= ( ( )) There is only one maxima and only two
= ( ) minima for this function.
At x = 0, (0) = ( )=2
Since (x) = 2 is > 0 at x = 0 we have a
minima.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 107
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
8. [Ans. A] = , -
=, ( )-
= ( ) ( ) =1
1
14. [Ans. B]
0 Dot product of two vectors
=1+a+ =0
So orthogonal
√
15. [Ans. C]
∫ ∫ ( ) f(x) =
( )
( )
9. [Ans. C] So the equation f(x) having only maxima
( ) at x = 1
( )
( ) 16. [Ans. B]
( )
( ) ̇̂
̂
̂ ̂ ̂
10. [Ans. D]
̅=( ̂ ̂ ̂
)̂ ( )̂
( ) = (0, 2) ∫ ∫
( ) = (2, 0)
Along x axis ,y=0,z=0
Equation of starting line = The integral reduces to zero.
⇒ y = 2 – x , dy = – dx
̅ ̅ =( ) ( ) 17. [Ans. D]
Putting y = 2 – x and dy = – dx
∫̅ ̅ ∫ ∫ ( ) C o o ‘ ’
( )
11. [Ans. B] .( )̂ ( )̂
( )̂ /
( )
̂ ̂ ̂
But at is undefined
Discontinuous || ||
( ) ( ) ( )
12. [Ans. A] ̂ ( ) ̂ ( ) ̂ ( )
̂ ̂ ̂
=0
Div ( ) ⃗
̂
=. ̂ ̂ /( ̂ ̂ ̂) 18. [Ans. A]
= 1+1+1= 3 ( ) ( ) ( )
o ( ) ( )
13. [Ans. B] ⇒
M
P=∫
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 108
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
19. [Ans. B] π
0 . /1
∫⃗
∫ [ ]
⇒ o o π 23. [Ans. A]
( ⃗) ⃗ ⃗
∫ ( )( )( )
( ) ( )
⃗
o
∫ ( ) [ ]
π 24. [Ans. B]
( )
20. [Ans. C] ( ) ⇒
⇒
( ) ( )
⇒( )( )
( ) ⇒
( )
( ) w , -
For number of values of ( )
⁄ ( )
o ( ) ( )
( )
( ) ( )
( ) ( )
M ( )
21. [Ans. B] IN
G 1. [Ans. A]
o h o
⇒
o o
( )
⇒ o
Unit vector along y = x is
G ∫ (∫ ) π
̂ o
∫ (∫ ) ̂
√ √
o ̂
22. [Ans. 2] . /. /
( ) √ √
π π π √ √
∫ ∫ o . / . /
√
√
2. [Ans. D]
Using L Hospital Rule., numerator
()
becomes = = ( )
From the graph, distance at
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 109
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
3. [Ans. B] When
Given integral is, I=∫ ( ) ( )
Let f(x) = so curve of 1/ will be And when
f(x)
( ) ( )
The possible expression for f(x) is
1 . /
7. [Ans. B]
-1 0 1 x
Error,
This curve will be discontinuous at x=0
o ’ w o For error to be minimum
( o ) ( )
4. [Ans. A]
Let R ̂ z (t) ̂
̅ (t) =x (t) ̂+y (t) + ⇒ o
̅( ) =K (constant)
|R ⇒
i.e., (t) + (t) + (t) = constant.
⇒
On analyzing the given (A) option, we find √
̅( )
̅(t)
that R will give constant magnitude,
so first differentiation of the integration will √
be zero.
5. [Ans. C] 1
Given : G
f= + …… + o
where, (i=0 to n) are constant.
= +(n 1) ……
+ ⇒
√
and =0+ + ……
(n 1) +n ⇒
√
+
⇒ ( )
= , + + -
= nf ⇒
⇒
6. [Ans. B]
8. [Ans. B]
( ) ( )
When () ∫ ( ) …( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 110
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
() 14. [Ans. B]
, ()
Given y = x2 + 2x + 10
= 2x + 2
∫ ( ) -
|
1 +1 X
1
, - o
9. [Ans. D]
Area = ( )
Total charge = σ
10. [Ans. A]
This is a standard question of =
differentiability & continuity = coulomb.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 111
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
21. [Ans. D]
.E=0 is not irrational (it is solenoidal)
22. [Ans. 1]
From Gauss divergence theorem, we have
∫ ̅ ̅ ∫ ̅ ∫ ̅
∫. /dxdydz
∫ ∫ ∫ ( )
̅ ̂ ̂ ̂
[ ]
⇒
23. [Ans. C]
24. [Ans. D]
/
π
π
o .
( π )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 112
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Differential Equations
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 113
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ME – 2011 x x
,y- * + ,y-
12. Consider the differential equation t
x x
y x. The general solution with ,y- * + ,y-
t
constant c is
(A) y t n t n 17. If y = f(x) is the solution of with
(B) y t n ( ) the boundary conditions y t
(C) y t n ( ) x at x __________
(D) y t n( )
18. The general solution of the differential
equation os x y with c as a
ME – 2012
constant, is
13. Consider the differential equation
(A) y s n x y x
x x y with the boundary
(B) t n ( ) y
conditions of y(0) =0 and y(1) = 1. The
complete solution of the differential (C) os ( ) x
equation is (D) t n ( ) x
(A) x (C) s n( )
(B) s n ( ) 19. Consider two solution x(t) = x t and
(D) s n( )
x t x t of the differential equation
x t
ME – 2013 x t t su t t
14. The partial differential equation t
x t
u is a x |
t
(A) linear equation of order 2 x t
(B) non – linear equation of order 1 x |
t
(C) linear equation of order 1
x t x t
(D) non – linear equation of order 2 The wronskian W(t) =| | t
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 115
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
13. The solution to the ordinary differential 2. The following differential equation has
3
equation + 6y = 0 is d2y dy
3 4 y2 2 x
(A) y= + dt2 dt
(B) y= + (A) degree=2, order=1
(C) y= + (B) degree=1, order=2
(D) y= + (C) degree=4, order=3
(D) degree=2, order=3
14. The partial differential equation that can
be formed from z = ax + by + ab has the ECE – 2006
form (w t p n q ) d2y
3. For the differential equation 2
k2y 0
(A) z = px + qy dx
(B) z = px + pq the boundary conditions are
(C) z = px + qy + pq (i) y=0 for x=0 and
(D) z = qx + pq (ii) y=0 for x=a
The form of non-zero solutions of y
CE – 2011 (where m varies over all integers) are
15. The solution of the differential equation m x
y ∑ sn
+ = x, with the condition that y = 1 at
m x
x = 1, is y ∑ os
(A) y = + (C) y = +
y ∑ x
(B) y = + (D) y = +
y ∑
CE – 2012
16. The solution of the ordinary differential
equation y=0 for the boundary ECE – 2007
condition, y=5 at x = 1 is 4. The solution of the differential equation
(A) y (C) y d2y
k2 y y 2 under the boundary
(B) y (D) y dx2
conditions
CE – 2014 (i) y=y1 at x=0 and
17. The integrating for the differential (ii) y=y2 at x=, where k, y1 and y2 are
equation s constants, is
(A) y y y xp( x⁄ ) y
(A) (C)
(B) y y y xp x⁄ y
(B) (D)
(C) y y y s n x⁄ y
(D) y y y xp x⁄ y
ECE – 2005
1. A solution of the following differential
ECE – 2008
equation is given by
5. Which of the following is a solution to the
d2y dy
5 6y 0 differential equation x t x t
dx2 dx
(A) t
(A) y e e (C) y e e
2x 3x 2x 3x (C) x t t
(B) x t
(D) x t t
(B) y e e (D) y e e
2x 3x 2x 3x
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 116
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 117
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(B) y x (D) y x
EE – 2014
5. The solution for the differential equation
17. If a and b are constants, the most general x
solution of the differential equation x w t n t l on t ons x
t
x x x
x s n | s
t t t
(A) (C) bt (A) t t
(B) bt (D) (B) s n t os t
(C) s n t os t
18. With initial values y(0) = y (0) = 1, the
solution of the differential equation (D) os t t
y tx s
6. Consider the differential equation
x x y
EE – 2005
1. The solution of the first order differential Which of the following is a solution to this
qu t on x’ t 3x(t), x (0) = x is differential equation for x > 0?
(A) x (t) = x (C) x (t) = x (A) (C) x
(B) x (t) = x (D) x (t) = x (B) x (D) ln x
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 118
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 119
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN– 2014
11. The figure shows the plot of y as a
function of x
x
y
x
y
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 120
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ME 4. [Ans. B]
1. [Ans. D] The given differential equation may be
lnx written as
x y xy
x y y y
lnx ux l ry qu t on s
y y
x x
lnx
omp r ng w g t
x x
∫ ∫
ow x Substituting D=2, we get
y(I.F.) = ∫ x
( )
x y ∫ x x
3. [Ans. C] 6. [Ans. A]
Given equation is Order: The order of a differential equation
y y is the order of the highest derivative
p q appears in the equation
x x
p q y Degree: The degree of a differential
ut p n q equation is the degree of the highest
y order differential coefficient or derivative,
when the differential coefficients are free
from radicals and fraction.
The general solution of differential
y x qu t on o or r ‘n’ must nvolv ‘n’
arbitrary constant.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 121
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
7. [Ans. C] y
( )y x …
y x x
v n y Standard form
x
y y
x y …
y x
Where P and Q function of x only and
nt gr t ng x
y solution is given by
y ∫ x
x
nx y ∫
Where, integrating factor (I.F)
r n x
x
y
x ∫
x
x
x olut on y x ∫x x x
x and x x
yx
8. [Ans. A] Given condition
y y y
y
A.E is, D2+2D+1 =0
2=0
m ns t x y
m 1
The C.F. is (C1+C2x)e-x
P.I. = 0
ow y ₁
n y ₂ ₂
x
r or yx
y x
y
x
9. [Ans. D]
ẍ x 11. [Ans. B]
Auxiliary equation is
is third order ( ) and it
m2 + 3 = 0
i.e. m = ±√ is linear, since the product is not
x os√ t sn√ t allowed in linear differential equation
ẋ √ os√ t s n√ t
At t = 0 12. [Ans. D]
1=A y
y x
0=B x
y
x = os √ t ∫ ∫ x
y
x os √ t
x
t n y
10. [Ans. A]
x
Given differential equation is y t n. /
y
x y x
x
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 122
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
n 19. [Ans. A]
u x Since the determinant of wronskian
matrix is constant values for, therefore it
is same for both t=0 and t=
Solving we get u = U( ) x t x t
t x t x t
t t
16. [Ans. A]
x
x y
t
y 20. [Ans. B]
x y y
t ∫ ∫ x x ln y x ln
So by observation it is understood that, y
y
x x ln ( ) x y
,y- * + ,y-
t
v ny
n y
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 123
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
CE y
tx s
1. [Ans. A] x
Given + p(t) y = q(t) y ; n > 0
Given, v = y
v y
n y
t t
y v n
t n y t
Substitution in the differential equation y ( os x sn x)
we get
+ p(t)y = q(t) y 3. [Ans. A]
Multiplying by (1 n) y we get …
v t
p t n y q t n Where, V = r
t
Now since y = v we get r
v r
n pv n q r
t t t
Where p is p (t) and q is q(t) Substituting in (i) we get
4 r = r )
2. [Ans. A]
r
y y
y t
x x dr = kdt
y
Integration we get
y
( ) r = kt + C
x
This is a linear differential equation At t = 0, r = 1
1= k×0+C
± C=1
y r = kt + 1
Now at t = 3 months r = 0.5 cm
( )
0.5 = k × 3 + 1
os x sn x
os x
sn x
os x r t
sn x utt ng r n solv ng g v s
t n
y os x sn x t
n y t = 6 months
os sn
4. [Ans. A]
sn x os x Given
y
os x sn x x xy – x x y
x
sn x
y
os x x xy x
x
Dividing by x
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 124
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
6. [Ans. B] = 25 + 35 × ( ) (s n )
Degree of a differential equation is the = 31.
power of its highest order derivative after ≈ C
the differential equation is made free of
radicals and fractions if any, in derivative
power.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 125
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 126
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
m x
y ∑ sn
x
ot solut on s y
x
4. [Ans. D]
16. [Ans. D] k2D2y= y y2
y 2 1 y2
x
y D k2 y k2
y
1
y m1 =
y k
C.F. = C1e C2 e
x/k x/k
3. [Ans. A] 6. [Ans. B]
Given, Differential equation, The order of a differential equation is the
d2y order of the highest derivative involving
k2y 0
dx2 in equation, so answer is 2.
Auxilary equation is The degree of a differential equation is
y the degree of the highest derivative
± involving in equation, so answer is 1.
Let y os x sn x
At x=0, y = 0 A=0 7. [Ans. A]
y sn x P. ∫ ∫
At x=a, y=0 B sin ka=0
log y log x log
B0 otherwise y=0 always
y xw s qu t on o str g t l n
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 127
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Q. ∫ ∫ 11. [Ans. C]
S. ∫y y ∫x x
xt
x y … Equ t on o r l
12. [Ans. D]
8. [Ans. B]
Approach 1:
y x
y x x y t y t
x y t t
t t
x y Converting to s-domain
x y y old y +0.1 ( ) new s y s sy y sy s y
x y s
x y y
s s y s s
0 0 0+0 0+0.1×0=0 s
=0 y s
s s
0. 0 0.1+0 0+0.1×0.1=0.01 n nv rs pl tr ns orm
1 =0.1 y t t u t
0. 0.0 0.2+0.01 0.01+0.21×0.1 y t
t
2 =0.21
1 =0.031 t
The value of y at x= 0.3 is 0.031. y t
|
t
9. [Ans. D]
n x Approach 2:
y t y t
Auxiliary equation m m ± y t t
t t
olut on n x Applying Laplace Transform on both
Since, n sides
y
Since, n (hence s y s sy |
t
must be zero)
(sy s y ) y s
Therefore
s y s s sy s y s
The solution is, n x s s
y s
s s s s
10. [Ans. C]
y t t t
Given y and y x t
t t
ln y x y
y t t
When
y t
y y t
t
y t
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 128
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
y t z
| x ln xy xy x x ln xy x
t y xy
z
ox xy ln xy xy
13. [Ans. D] x
z
Let the differential equation be y xy ln xy xy
y
y t
y t x t z z
t ox y
Apply Laplace transform on both sides x y
y t
2 y t 3 {x t } 17. [Ans. B]
t
x x
sy s y y s x s x
t t
s y s x s y
Pre auxiliary equation is
x s y
y s m m
s s
Pre roots of AE are m .
Taking inverse Laplace on both sides
Repeated roots are present.
x s
{y s } 2 3 y { } So, most general solution in
s s
n t bt
y t x t y
So if we want y t as a solution both 18. [Ans. *] Range 0.53 to 0.55
x(t) and y(0) has to be multiplied by . E m m m
Hence change x(t) by x t and y(0) by olut ons s y bx …
y y bx
b …
14. [Ans. A] s ng y
y y y n gv s
y
x x n b
The auxiliary equation is
y x
m m
tx y
± then either
m or m EE
i.e., roots of the equation are equal to 1. [Ans. A]
or v n x’ t x (t)
i.e. x
15. [Ans. A]
t
xy is a first order linear
x
equation non omog n ous ∫ ∫ t
x
xy 0 is a first order linear lnx = t
equation (homogeneous) x
r non l n r qu t ons Putting
x
16. [Ans. C] Now putting initial condition x(0) = x
z xy ln xy x
z x
y ln xy xy y y ln xy y
x xy Solution is x = x
i.e. x(t) = x
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 129
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
2. [Ans. B] 6. [Ans. C]
x x x y xy y
x
t t y y
y
Auxiliary equation m m x x
m m m w subst tut y
(m+4)(m+2)=0 x
m= 2, 4 t nx x x( )
x(t) = x x
n y s ts s
x
x(0) = 1 1= … (1)
IN
|
1. [Ans. C]
… y
On solving (1) & (2), we get and m m
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 130
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
6. [Ans. A] Hyperbolic if
Given = 1 + y2 El ps
Compare the given differential equation
Integrating ∫ =∫ x
with standard from A = 1, B = 0, C = 0
Or t n y = x + c
Or y = t n x Parabolic
y= ẏ s nx os x
ẏ
y
y
So, y os x s n x
y or m x m
y s nx os x
s nx os x
8. [Ans. C]
x
y os x s n x
y or x m xm
The solution for the differential equation
y m x os sn
is
y x √
√ √ √
Now, y and y , placing these
values
11. [Ans. D]
We get, and
By back tracking, from option (D)
y
y
|x| x or x
x
= x or x
9. [Ans. A] Integrating
Given partial differential equation is y
∫ ∫ x x or x
x
x t
∫ x x or x
x t x
We know that y or
(x y ) x
or x
is said to be
Parabolic if
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 131
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Complex Variables
ME – 2007 ME – 2014
1. If x y and (x, y) are functions with 6. The argument of the complex number
continuous second derivatives, then
where i = √ , is
x y + i (x, y) π
π
can be expressed as an analytic function π 2
of x + i (i = √ ), when 2 π
(A)
7. The integral ∮ y x x y is evaluate
(B)
along the circle x + y traversed in
(C) + + counter clock wise direction. The integral
is equal to
(D) + π
(A) 0 –
π 2
– π
ME – 2008 4 4
2. The integral ∮ z z evaluated around
the unit circle on the complex plane for 8. An analytic function of a complex variable
z is z x + i y is expressed as
(A) 2πi (C) 2πi z u x y +iv x y
(B) 4πi (D) 0 where i √ f u(x,y)= 2xy, then
v(x,y) must be
ME – 2009 (A) x + y + onst nt
3. An analytic function of a complex variable (B) x y + onst nt
z = x + iy is expressed as (C) x + y + onst nt
f(z) = u(x, y) +iv(x, y) where i = 1 . (D) x y + onst nt
If u = xy, the expression of v should be
(A)
x y 2 k (C)
y 2
x2 k 9. An analytic function of a complex variable
z = x + i y is expressed as
2 2 f(z) = u(x, y) + i v(x, y),
(B)
x2
y 2
k (D)
x y 2 k where i = √ . If u (x, y) = x – y , then
2 2 expression for v(x, y) in terms of x, y and
a general constant c would be
ME – 2010 (A) xy + (C) 2xy +
4. The modulus of the complex number
(B) + (D) +
( ) is
(A) 5 (C) 1/√
10. If z is a complex variable, the value of
(B) √ (D) 1/5
∫ is
ME – 2011 (A) i
5. The product of two complex numbers (B) 0.511+1.57i
1 + i and 2 – 5i is (C) i
(A) 7 – 3i (C) 3 – 4i (D) 0.511+1.57i
(B) 3 – 4i (D) 7 + 3i
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 132
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
CE – 2005 CE – 2011
1. Which one of the following is NOT true for 6. For an analytic function,
complex number and ? f(x + iy) = u(x, y)+iv(x, y), u is given by
̅̅̅̅
(A) =| u = 3x 3y . The expression for v
|
considering K to be a constant is
(B) | + |≤| |+| |
(A) 3y 3x + k (C) 6x 6y+k
(C) | |≤| | | |
(B) 6y – 6x + k (D) 6xy +k
(D) | + | +| |
2| | + 2| |
CE – 2014
2. Consider likely applicable of u hy’s 7. z can be expressed as
integral theorem to evaluate the following (A) i (C) i
integral counter clockwise around the (B) + i (D) + i
unit circle c.
ECE – 2006
∮s z z 1. The value of the contour integral
∮| |
z in positive sense is
z being a complex variable. The value of I
(A) (C)
will be
(A) I = 0: singularities set = ϕ (B) (D)
(B) I = 0: singularities set
2. For the function of a complex variable
=, πn 2 -
W = In Z (where, W = u + jv and
(C) I π/2: singul riti s s t Z = x + jy), the u = constant lines get
{ nπ n 2 } mapped in Z-plane as
(D) None of the above (A) set of radial straight line
(B) set of concentric circles
CE – 2006 (C) set of confocal hyperbolas
3. Using Cauchy’s is integral theorem, the (D) set of confocal ellipses
value of the integral (integration being
taken in counter clockwise direction) ECE – 2007
∮ dz is 3. If the semi-circular contour D of radius 2
(A) 4πi (C) πi is as shown in the figure, then the value of
ECE – 2011
8. The value of the integral ∮ z
where is the circle |z| is given by lm nit ir l lm nit ir l
ECE\EE\IN – 2012 y
9. If x = √ then the value of x is y
⁄ (C) x
(A)
(B) ⁄ (D) 1 lmlm nit ir l lm nit ir l
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 134
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE – 2013 IN – 2005
3. ∮ z evaluated anticlockwise around 1. Consider the circle | | 2 in the
complex plane (x, y) with z = x + iy. The
the circle |z i| 2 where i √ , is
minimum distant form the origin to the
(A) 4π (C) 2 + π
circle is
(B) (D) 2 +2i
(A) √2 2 (C) √ 4
(B) √ 4 (D) √2
4. Square roots of – i, where i = √ , are
(A) i, i
2. Let ̅, where z is a complex number
(B) os ( ) + i sin ( ) not equal to zero. The z is a solution of
os ( ) + i sin ( ) (A) z (C) z
(B) z (D) z
(C) os ( ) + i sin ( )
os ( ) + i sin ( ) IN – 2006
3. The value of the integral of the complex
(D) os ( ) + i sin ( )
function
os ( ) + i sin ( ) 3s 4
f(s)
(s 1)(s 2)
EE – 2014 Along the path s 3is
5. Let S be the set of points in the complex (A) 2j (C) 6j
plane corresponding to the unit circle. (B) 4j (D) 8j
(That is, {z: |z| } . Consider the
function f(z)=zz* where z* denotes the IN – 2007
complex conjugate of z. The f(z) maps S to
4. For the function of a complex variable
which one of the following in the complex
plane z, the point z=0 is
(A) unit circle (A) a pole of order 3
(B) horizontal axis line segment from (B) a pole of order 2
origin to (1, 0) (C) a pole of order 1
(C) the point (1, 0) (D) not a singularity
(D) the entire horizontal axis
5. Let j = √ .Then one value of is
6. All the values of the multi-valued complex (A) √j (C)
function , where i √ are (B) 1
(D)
(A) purely imaginary.
(B) real and non-negative. IN – 2008
(C) on the unit circle. 6. A complex variable x+j has its
(D) equal in real and imaginary parts. real part x varying in the range
to + . Which one of the following is
7. Integration of the complex function the locus (shown in thick lines) of 1/Z in
z , in the counter clockwise the complex plane?
direction, around |z 1| = 1, is
(A) πi (C) πi
(B) (D) 2πi
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 135
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN – 2010
m gin ry
m gin ry
10. The contour C in the adjoining figure is
xis
xis
described by x + y . The value of
∮ z is.
l xis l xis
j (Note: √ )
j y
pl n
m gin ry
m gin ry
xis
xis
x
l xis l xis
j (A) 2πj (C) 4πj
j
(B) 2πj (D) 4πj
IN – 2009 IN – 2011
7. The value of ∮ where the contour 11. The contour integral ∮ / with C as
of integration is a simple closed curve the counter-clockwise unit circle in the z-
around the origin, is plane is equal to
(A) 0 (C) (A) 0 (C) 2π√
(D) (B) 2π (D)
(B) 2πj
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 136
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ME 4. [Ans. B]
1. [Ans. B] + 4i + 2i
By definition C-R equation holds 2i + 2i
+ i + 4i
+ 2i
2. [Ans. A] +4
f(z)= has simple pole at z = 0 Modulus = √
Residue of f(z) at z = 0
5. [Ans. A]
lim z z lim os z
+i 2 i
∫ z z 2πi (residue at z = 0)
2 i + 2i i i
2πi 2πi
6. [Ans. C]
3. [Ans. C]
+i +i + 2i + i
Given u=xy
For analytic function i i +i i
2i
u v i + i
2
x y
+i
u v rg ( ) t n ( )
and i
y x π⁄
2
By Milne Thomson method
Let w = u + iv 7. [Ans. C]
dw u v
i ∫y x x y
dz x x
u u y = r sin x r os
i
x y y r os x r sin
dw ∮ r sin r os
or y ix
dz
Replacing x by z and y by 0, we get π
∮ r r 2π
dw 2
0 iz
dz
Where, z = x + iy 8. [Ans. C]
u v
dw = izdz
x y
z2
Integrating, w i C v
2 2y
y
Where C is a constant,
2y
z + x v
v m0 i + 1 2
2 y + x v
(x2 y2 2ixy) u v
mi
2 y x
2x x
y 2 x2
or v 2x
2 + x
2
x x
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 137
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
v y x 2. [Ans. B]
y x + onst nt
∫s z z z ∫
os z
9. [Ans. C] The poles are at z = n + /2 π
iv n u x y = π/2 π/2 + π/2
v v None of these poles lie inside the unit
v x+ y
x y circle |z| =1
v u v u Hence, sum of residues at poles = 0
y x x y Singularities set = ϕ and
u u 2πi [sum o r si u s o t z t th
v x+ y
y x poles]
2y x + 2x y 2 πi
rm ont ing y t rms only llow
v 2 xy + 3. [Ans. A]
u hy’s int gr l th or m is
10. [Ans. B] f(a) = ∮ z
z
∫ ln z| ln i ln i.e. ∮ z 2πi
z
ln + ln i ln Now, ∮ z= ∮
( )
ln ln + ln i
z os + i sin pplying u hy’s int gr l th or m, using
z i i sin π/2 z z
z / i
+ i / .2πi ( )/
ln i ln z ln
π
( i i ) i
2 .2πi 0( ) 1/
CE i
.2πi 0( ) 1/
1. [Ans. C]
(A) is true since 2π
̅̅̅̅ ̅̅̅̅
i 4πi
= =|
̅̅̅̅ | 2π
(B) is true by triangle inequality of 4πi
complex number
(C) is not true since | |≥| | | | 4. [Ans. D]
(D) is true since z z z
z
| + |2 = ( + ) ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
+ z + z z i z+i
= ( + ) (z̅ + z̅ ) The singularities are at z = i and –i
= z̅ + z̅ + z̅ + z̅ i
And | |2 = ( + ) ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅ 5. [Ans. C]
= ( + ) (z̅ z̅ ) os 2πz
r ∫
= z̅ + z̅ z̅ + z̅ ii 2z z
Adding (i) and (ii) we get * +
| + |2 + | |2 = 2 z̅ + 2 z̅ ∫
2 *z +
= 2| | + 2| |
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 138
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
u = 3x2 – 3y2
For f to be analysis, we have Cauchy- Pole (0, 2) lies inside the circle |z j|=2
Riemann conditions, y u hy’s nt gr l ormul
u v ∮ z
i z +4
x y
|z j| 2
u v
ii 2j
y x I
From (i) we have 2j 2j 2
u v
x
x y
2. [Ans. B]
∫ v ∫ x y iv n log
1 y
v
x
+ x 2
u iv loge x iy log x2 y2 i tan1
x
2
Since, u is constant, therefore
i.e. v = 3x2 + f(x) iii
1
Now applying equation (iii) we get
2
log x2 y2 c
u v
y x x +y Which is represented set
of concentric circles.
y [ x+
x
3. [Ans. A]
x + y
x ∮ s 2πj sum o r si u
y x Singular points are s =
x
By integrating, Only s= +1 lies inside the given contour
f(x) = 6yx – 3x2 + K lims 1 f s
Residues at s= +1 = S1
Substitute in equation (iii)
1 1
lims 1
v= 3x2 + 6yx – 3x2 + K S1 S 1 2
2
v yx + K
n ∮ s 2πj ( ) πj
s 2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 139
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
4. [Ans. A] + z+
(z )
Residue of z=2 is z z
d
lim
z2 dz
z 2 f z
2
+
+
d 1 2 1 F(z 2πj + )
lim lim
z 2 z 2 32
z2 dz 2
z 2 3
7. [Ans. C]
5. [Ans. D] X(z) =
sin z Poles are Z= 0, Z =1, Z=2
Residue at Z=0 is lim
2i
Residue at Z =1 is lim
2 i
Residue z =2 is lim
2 i
( ) 2 i 8. [Ans. A]
ut m z+4
m 2 im ∮ z
z + 4z +
2 i √ 2 i 4
m z + 4z + z+2 +
2
z 2 j will be outside the unit circle
2 i √ 2 i + i√
o th t int gr tion v lu is ‘z ro’
2 2
i √ i 9. [Ans. A]
m i √ i i i√ i √ x
iz log i √ i ty x log y x log x
iz log i + log( √ )
π ⟹ log y i log i i log
iz log + i ( 2nπ) π π
2 log y i i
2 2
+log √
π ⟹y
iz i ( 2nπ) + log √
2
π 10. [Ans. C]
z ( 2nπ) ilog( √ )
2 ∫ z z *∫ z ∫ z+
( 2
infinite number of complex solutions
∫ z
sin z has infinite no. of complex 2πj z+
solutions where f (z) =1
6. [Ans. D]
f(z) = + z 11. [Ans. C]
+ z + + z s z 2j
z ∮ z
z z
lim z + 2j 4+ j
+ z+
∮( ) 2πj[ 4 + j 4π + 2j
z
F z 2 π j r si u o
Residue at z = 0 ( 2- order )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 140
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
12. [Ans. B]
Suppose that z u x y + iv x y is √ +
analytic then, u and v satisfy the Cauchy o / is outside the unit circle is IV
Riemann equation quadrant
u v u v
n
x y y x 3. [Ans. A]
r u xy os x z 4
u v ∮
z +4
sin x
x y |z i| 2
u v z +4
os x
y x z 4
v sin x z 2i
For z 2i
EE Residue at z +2i
1. [Ans. B] 4 4
+2i
Pole (z=i) lies inside the circle. |z-i/2|=1. z + 2i +4i
Hence t z 2i li insi
tz 2i li outsi
∮ z ∮ z
z + z+i z i z 4
o∮ 2πi sum o r si u
∮ z 2 πi i , wh r z - z +4
2πi 2i
2 πi π 4π
2i
2. [Ans. D] 4. [Ans. B]
Let + i Let + i √ i
Since Z is shown inside the unit circle in I Squaring both sides we get
quadrant, a and B are both +ve and +2 i i
Equating real and imaginary parts
√ +
ow 2
+ i
i wh n 2
i 2
+ + +
Since i
√2
√ + i i
wh n
√2 √2
+ i i i
+i +i ( ) +
o in qu r nt √2 √2 √2 √2
i i
wh n
√2 √2
| | √( ) +( ) i i i
+ + +i + i( ) +
√2 √2 √2 √2
i
√ +( )
+ √ + √2 √2
π π
in √ + os ( ) + i sin ( )
4 4
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 141
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
or x y
π π r uis o th ir l
os ( ) + i sin ( )
4 4 x + y 4
x 2
5. [Ans. C]
x √2
z zz |z|
n s {z: |z| }
z √2 x √2 2
All point of s will be mapped on the
2. [Ans. C]
point (1, 0)
z z̅
6. [Ans. B] Multiply both the side by z, we get
z z̅ z
z
z |z|
log z i log
z r l n Non-negative |z| |z| wh r is ngl o z
since |z| is a real quantity so in order to
7. [Ans. C] satisfy above equation has to be real
∫ x x 2πi r s (f(a)) where a is a quantity = 1 and
singularity in contour c , (where n = +2 )
r |z | n o |z |
pol s o z z king π/2
⁄
nly z li s insi |z | z |z|
z z |z|
s( ) lim z
z z+ z
z
lim
z+ 2 3. [Ans. C]
quir int gr tion 2πi πi
2
IN X X
-3
1. [Ans. A] -2 -1 3
| + i | 2 Cx y y
(Cx ( Cx
Radius of the circle is 2 and centre is at
y(n) n n
+ i )y(n))
y(n)
3s 4 1 2
C3 =
F(s) C3 .
CC3
(sC 1)(s 2) s 1 s 2
2
y(n) 3 3
y(n) dz y(n)
+ i By Formula,
y y z a 2j
xy ( (
Since, both the poles are enclosed by
n n
contour,
) )
therefore
Value of integral=2πj + 2 2πj πj
For distance to be min. The point P will be
on the line passes through origin and 4. [Ans. B]
centre of the circle. Expand by Laurent series
Slope of line OP = Slope of line OC
𝑥
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 142
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
j
| lim { }
x + x +
j
ption s tis y th ov on itions
7. [Ans. A]
u hy’s int gr l ormul is
∫
Here a = 0, then f(0) = sin 0 = 0
8. [Ans. D]
z x + iy
p | |= | |
= | |= | |=
9. [Ans. B]
Given x3 = j = e+jπ/2
⁄
x
π π √
x os + j sin +j
2 2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 143
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Laplace Transform
ME – 2007
1. If F (s) is the Laplace transform of
function f (t), then Laplace transform of
t
f (t) dt is
0
CE – 2009
ME – 2009
1. Laplace transfrm of the function
1
2. The inverse Laplace transform of f(x) = cosh(ax) is
s s
2
(A) (C)
is (B) (D)
(A) (C) 1 –
(B) (D) ECE - 2005
1. In what range should Re(s) remain so
ME – 2010 that the Laplace transform of the function
3. The Laplace transform of a function is exists.
. The function is (A) (C)
(A) (C) (B) (D)
(B) (D)
ECE – 2006
2. A solution for the differential equation
ME – 2012
4. The inverse Laplace transform of the x’(t)+2x(t)= (t) with initial condition
x( )=0 is
function F(s) is given by
(A) (C)
(A) (C) (B) (D)
(B) (D)
ECE – 2008
ME – 2013 3. Consider the matrix P = * + . The
5. The function satisfies the differential
value of eP is
equation and the auxiliary
(A) * +
conditions, . The
Laplace transform of is given by (B) [ ]
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 144
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE – 2013
9. A system is described by the differential
equation =x(t). Let x(t)
be a rectangular pulse given by
,
5. Given
[ ] 10. The maximum value of the solution y(t) of
the differential equation y(t) + ̈
then the value of K is with initial condition ̇ and
(A) 1 (C) 3 ≥
(B) 2 (D) 4 (A) 1 (C)
(B) 2 (D) √
ECE– 2011
6. If [ ] then the initial ECE – 2014
11. The unilateral Laplace transform of
and final values of f(t) are respectively
(A) 0, 2 (C) 0, 2/7 . Which one of the following
(B) 2, 0 (D) 2/7, 0 is the unilateral Laplace transform of
?
ECE/EE/IN – 2012
7. The unilateral Laplace transform of f(t) is
. The unilateral Laplace transform
of t f(t) is
(A) – (C) EE – 2005
12. For the equation
(B) (D)
(t) + 3 (t) + 2x(t) = 5, the solution
x(t) approaches which of the following
8. Consider the differential equation values as t ?
(A) 0 (C) 5
(B) (D) 10
| |
EE – 2014
The numerical value of | is 13. Let be the Laplace
(A) (C) transform of signal x(t). Then, is
(B) (D) (A) 0 (C) 5
(B) 3 (D) 21
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 145
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
[ ]
3. [Ans. A]
[ ] 6. [Ans. D]
[ ]
4. [Ans. D] [ ]
{ }
2. [Ans. A]
{ } ̇ (t) + 2x (t) = (t)
Taking Laplace transform of both sides ,
we get
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 146
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
eP
2 1 1 1
s 1 s 2
s 1 s 2
=
2 2 2
1
s 1 s 2 s 2 s 1
=[ ] ⁄
=2
4. [Ans. C]
Since f(t) is an even function, its
trigonometric Fourier series contains
only cosine terms
∫ ∫ 7. [Ans. D]
*∫ ∫ +
t
[ ( )]
8. [Ans. D]
[ ]
Therefore, the trigonometric Fourier
series for the waveform f(t) contains only Taking Laplace transform on both the
sides. We have,
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 147
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
11. [Ans. D]
[ ]
[ ] ( )
[ ]
| [ ]
12. [Ans. B]
=5
9. [Ans. B] By taking Laplace transform
Writing in terms of Laplace transform (
⁄
X(s) =
( )
13. [Ans. B]
( ) [ ]
( ) ( )
( )
10. [Ans. D]
14. [Ans. 0.5]
∫ ∫ |
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 148
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1Ω
1Ω
ECE - 2007
1Ω 1Ω
2. For the circuit shown in the figure, the
Thevenin voltage and resistance looking 10V
into X –Y are 1
1Ω
2
1Ω 1Ω
i
2i 1Ω 2 2Ω
(A) 0 W (C) 10 W
(B) 5 W (D) 100 W
4Ω 4Ω
V
V 100V R 5V 2V 1
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 149
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
~ 14 0 V
6Ω
R
5V V 2 V
6Ω 6Ω (A) 5 V (C) 3 V
(B) 2 V (D) 6 V
ECE/EE/IN - 2013
(A) 1.4 0 A (C) 2.8 0 A 12. Consider a delta connection of resistors
(B) 2.0 0 A (D) 3.2 0 A and its equivalent star connection as
shown. If all elements of the delta
8. In the circuit shown below, the Norton connection are scaled by a factor k, k>0,
equivalent current in amperes with the elements of the corresponding star
respect to the terminals P and Q is equivalent will be scaled by a factor of
j30Ω P
Ra
16 0 25Ω j50Ω Rb Rc
15Ω Q
RC RB
(A) 6.4 – j4.8 (C) 10 + j0
RA
(B) 6.56 – j7.87 (D) 16 + j0
15. Consider the configuration shown in the 19. In the circuit shown in the figure, the
figure which is a portion of a larger value of node voltage V is
electrical network 10 0
i
i V V
4Ω
4 0 j3Ω 6Ω j6Ω
R R
i
R
i
i i
(A) 22 + j 2 V (C) 22 – j 2 V
For R 1Ω and currents i =2 i 1 (B) 2 + j 22 V (D) 2 – j 22 V
i 4 which one of the following is
TRUE? 20. The circuit shown in the figure, the
(A) i 5 angular frequency (in rad/s) at which
(B) i 4 the Norton equivalent impedance as seen
(C) Data is sufficient to conclude that the from terminals b-b′ is purely resistive
supposed currents are impossible is_____________.
(D) Data is insufficient to identify the 1Ω 1F
b
currents i i and i
10 cos t
16. A Y-network has resistances of 10Ω each (volts) ~ 0.5
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 151
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
22. The magnitude of current (in mA) (A) Very low (C) 3L
through the resistor R in the figure (B) L/3 (D) Very high
shown is__________
R EE - 2007
2. A 3V dc supply with an internal resistance
1kΩ
of 2Ω supplies a passive non-linear
R
10 m
R
2m resistance characterized by the relation
2kΩ 4kΩ
VNL = . The power dissipated in the
non-linear resistance is
R 3kΩ
(A) 1.0 W (C) 2.5 W
(B) 1.5 W (D) 3.0 W
23. The equivalent resistance in the infinite
EE - 2008
ladder network shown in the figure, is R .
2R R R R 3. In the circuit shown in the figure, the
value of the current i will be given by
R 1Ω 3Ω
R R R R a b
1Ω + V 1Ω
EE - 2006 b
1. The three limbed non ideal core shown in
(A) – 3 V (C) 3 V
the figure has three winding with nominal
(B) 0 V (D) 5 V
inductances L each when measured
individually with a signal phase AC
EE - 2009
source. The inductance of the winding as
Statements for Linked Answer Questions 5
connected will be
& 6:
R 3VAB
2kΩ
+ A
+
5V 2kΩ 1kΩ
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 152
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE - 2011
V 4V Is = 5A 2Ω
12. In the circuit given below, the value of R
required for the transfer of maximum
power to the load having a resistance of
(A) (5A; Put Vs=20V) 3Ω is
(B) (2A; Put Vs =8V) R
(C) (5A; Put Is = 10A)
(D) (7A; Put Is= 12A)
6Ω
9. The current through the 2 kΩ resistance 10 V 3Ω oad
in the circuit shown is
C
1kΩ 1kΩ (A) Zero (C) 3Ω
2kΩ (B) 6Ω (D) Inifnity
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 153
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Circuit Circuit
300V R
(A) 0.8 Ω (C) 2 Ω
(B) 1.4 Ω (D) 2.8 Ω
1:1.25
The voltmeter, across the load, reads 200
Y V. The value of is__________
2.5Ω
100V 80V 5Ω
5Ω 5Ω
15V 2
5V
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 154
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
21. The power delivered by the current 3. Which one of the following equations is
source, in the figure, is_____________ valid for the circuit shown below?
1V I1 1Ω 1Ω I3
I2 1Ω 1Ω I6
1Ω 1Ω
1V 2 1Ω +
5V 1Ω
I5 1Ω
1Ω I4
22. An incandescent lamp is marked 40 W, I7
240V. If resistance at room temperature
(A) 0
(26°C) is 120 Ω, and temperature
(B) 0
coefficient of resistance is 4.5 10 /°C,
(C) 0
then its ‘ON’ state filament temperature in
(D) 0
°C is approximately___________
4. The current I supplied by the dc voltage
IN - 2006
source in the circuit shown below is
1. The root – mean – square value of a I
voltage waveform consisting of a
superimposition of 2V dc and a 4V peak –
to – peak square wave is 1V
1Ω 1A
(A) 2 V (C) √8 V
(B) √6 V (D) √12 V
10Ω
(A) 0W (C) 2.5W
(B) 1.0W (D) 3.0W
10 m
i(t)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 155
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN - 2009 IN - 2014
6. The source network S is connected to the 9. The circuit shown in the figure contains a
load network L as shown by dashed lines. dependent current source between A and
2Ω RL terminals. The Thevenin’s equivalent
resistance in kΩ between the terminals C
and D is ___________.
+ +
10 V
5kΩ 5kΩ C
3V
10 V
Source Network S Load Network L 10 V
The power transferred from S to L would V
be maximum when RL is
(A) 0Ω (C) 0.8 Ω
(B) 0.6 Ω (D) 2Ω
IN - 2010
7. A 100 Ω , 1W resistor and a 800 Ω , 2W
resistor are connected in series. The
maximum dc voltage that can be applied
continuously to the series circuit without
exceeding the power limit of any of the
resistors is
(A) 90V (C) 45 V
(B) 50 V (D) 40V
IN - 2011
8. The current I shown in the circuit given
below is equal to
10Ω
10 V 10Ω 10 10Ω
(A) 3 A (C) 6 A
(B) 3.67 A (D) 9 A
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 156
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE 4. [Ans. A]
1. [Ans. A] I 20 V
12 A
(s) = (S) R
(12 – I)A
(s) (R R ( (s)) +
60V
m( (s)) R 0 12 A
For V
5. [Ans. A]
Apply nodal analysis, 3
V V 2i
2 V 0 V i 1Ω
2 1
V V 1Ω 1Ω
2 2V 2i 0 2
2 2 ( 3)
V V 4V 3
10V
Similarly, 2 ( 2) 1
V
V 4V R 2Ω 1Ω 2
( 2) 1Ω
3. [Ans. C]
Fig .1
For maximum power transfer, R R
V 4Ω The current through all the branches are
marked as shown in Fig. 1.
4Ω 4Ω Apply KVL to outer loop
2( 3) 2( 2) 10
V 4 10 10
100V
0
Power supplied by 10 V 10 0 0
V 100V
100 (100 V ) 6. [Ans. C]
8 4
10 10
Also V 50V
10
12.5 12.5 25 R 15
V
R ⁄ 4Ω R 4Ω
Fig. 2
For Maximum power transfer to RL
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 157
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
R R 8. [Ans. A]
R Thevenin’s resistance seen across The Norton equivalent current is
the terminals of R into the rest of the 25
16 0
network. The relevant circuit is shown in (40 30)
Fig.2, where the independent current 3
8 tan ( ) 8 36.86
source is open circuited and the voltage 4
sources are short circuited. (6.4 j4.8)
R 10 (10 10)
R R 15Ω 9. [Ans. B]
The load consists of a resistance and a
7. [Ans. B] capacitance of this, only R is passive and
To find the current I in the given circuit in consumes power
Fig. (1), the delta network with 6Ω each is So P = R
converted to a star as shown in Fig. (2) =( ) 4 50
√
14 0 V ~ 6Ω 10. [Ans. A]
6Ω i
Fig. 2
Then the given circuit reduces to Fig. (3),
V 10kΩ V 100Ω V
(4) and (5) 99i
Where (2 j4)||(2 j4) 5Ω and
14 0
2 0
7
After connecting a voltage source of V
j4Ω j4Ω V V
(10k)( i ) 100( 99i i )
14 0 10000i 100( 100 i )
2Ω 2Ω
2Ω
100 10000i
20000i 100
Fig. 3 100
i ( ) [ ]
20000 200
V 100 99i i
5Ω 100 [ 100 ( )]
14 0 7Ω 200
14 0
50
2Ω V 50
R 50Ω
Fig. 4
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 158
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 159
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
17. [Ans. D]
Norton’s theorem: Here for a complex
network, after isolating the element, we 10 0 V
V1 V2
short circuit the two ends and find the
current . is the current of the 4Ω
independent current source with the 4 0 3jΩ 6Ω 6jΩ
equivalent resistance in parallel
R
Applying KCL to the super node we have
V V V
4 0 0 .
3j 6 6j
18. [Ans. *] Range 0.49 to 0.51 From super node we get
Apply superposition theorem V V 10 0 .
For voltage Solving and for V we get
5Ω 5Ω V 2 22j V
Voltage 0.5
5 source
0.25 mp
20 shorted
For current
5Ω 5Ω In doiman
1
(1||0.5j )
j
1 10Ω 0.5j j
1 0.5j
0.5j (1 0.5j ) j
1 5 1 0.25
0.25 mp 0.5j (1 0.5j ) j(1 0.25 )
20
(1 0.25 )
(0.25 0.25) Equating the imaginary part to zero, we
0.50 mp get
0.5 1 0.25 0
19. [Ans. D] 0.25 1
Using super node concept, we can treat 2rad/sec
nodes 1 and 2 to gather as a super node
as shown in the figure by the dotted lines
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 160
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
24. [Ans. C ]
5Ω 3Ω
i i R
7.5Ω
EE
22. [Ans. *] Range 2.79 to 2.81
1. [Ans. A]
By source transformation theorem
The inductance of all three coils are ‘ ’
2k 1k 4k
and they are connected to same line
carrying the same current and set up the
flux in the same direction
20V 8V
2 2
3k
by KV 20 10k 8 0
28
2.8 m
10k
23. [Ans. *] Range 2.60 to 2.64 All these fluxes linked with each other
We know that in a infinite ladder network and they will balance each other. So net
if all resistance are comprises of same flux will reduce drastically. Thus net L
value R then the equivalent resistance is will be very low
( √ )
. Then the above given network
2. [Ans. A]
can be redrawn as R series with R
equivalent as follows 2Ω
R 3V
+
V
I
R (1 √5)R
R
2
3 2 1
Power delivered by source = 3×1=3W.
R R 1.618R 2.618R
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 161
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
3. [Ans. B] 1kΩ
5 1
V 2.5V
2
Also, 4 V 4i 4(V V) 4i . (1) To calculate thevenin’s voltage terminals
A-B are kept open.
Also, V 4V V V
Applying source transformation into
V
V 1.25 V correct source
2 C C
4(2.5 1.25) 4i (From (1))
i 1.25
2kΩ 2kΩ 1kΩ
4. [Ans. A]
V 2i 5 2 5 3V
Applying source transformation current
source is transformed into voltage source.
5. [Ans. B]
1kΩ C 3V
Thevenin’s resistance is calculated using
the circuit shown in fig. (1) and (2),
where independent voltage source is 5 V
V 1kΩ
short circuited 2
3V I
2kΩ
A
Applying KVL, {I is assumed to be in mA}
2kΩ 1kΩ V
5
1k 3V 1k 0
2
B
5
Fig. 1 2k 3V 0 (1)
2
Fig. 1 V
(2)
3 V 1k
I
Put the value of in quation (1)
A
10 )
V 10 5
2V 3V 0
1kΩ 1kΩ 2
V
V 0.5V
V
B
Fig. 2 7. [Ans. D]
(
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 162
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
8. [Ans. B] R R
The relevant circuit is shown in fig. 6R
3
As the voltage across 2Ω 4V 6 R
4 R 6Ω
2
2
In order to double the current through 2Ω 13. [Ans. A]
resistance, V is to be doubled (Put 2Ω R
V 8V) ]
Note that the 5 A source has no effect on j1Ω
the answer. However it gives 3A current ~ 10V
~ 3V
Fig. 2Ω
9. [Ans. A]
10V
~ 2Ω 5V
11. [Ans. B]
V i 100 and V i .1(by ohm’s law)
2i 100 i 50 pply KV in loop
5 2.5R 3 0
12. [Ans. B] 2
[R 0.8Ω]
To calculated voltage source is short 2.5
circuited
R 14. [Ans. B]
W
1:1.25
6 100 V 125 V Y
R V
X Z
V 100 V
turns ratio V
6R 125
R 6||R
6 R V 0.8 V 100V
According to maximum power transfer when V 100V
theorem
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 163
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
200 (10)√ R
V
100V Power dissipated (2) (1) R 10
0.8
4 10R 1000
2′ 996
R
Thevenin’s circuit seen by 2 2′ will be 10
400 R
as follow
400 99.6
V 100V
17.33Ω
nd R 0.2||0.8 negligible
V 100V
19. [Ans. C]
V V turns ratio
100V 1 C
1.25
80V 120
120
15. [Ans. 330]
Power absorbed by battery 100V = 100 120
10 1000
Power supplied by battery
80V 80 8 640 V lags voltage A by 90
Current through 15V battery V √3 10 90
10 8 Angle 90 with respect to A
2 Hence
Power supplied by battery V √3 10 ( 90 15)
15V 15 2 30 10√3 75
Total power absorbed
1000 640 30 20. [Ans. 2]
330 att 2.5V
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 164
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
2.5 1 2. [Ans. D]
0.5
(2.5 2.5) 2 The given circuit in Fig. 1 is simplified as
Total i 0.5 0.5 1 (NOTE: Option shown in Fig. 2 and Fig.3
not matching with IIT website) 3 2
I
6
21. [Ans. 3] V1=3 1 V1 1 V1 1
1V V
1Ω I4
22. [Ans. *] Range 2470 to 2471 P I7 S
40 At node, P
R . (1)
(240)
R At nodeQ ,
40
. . (2)
R R (1 T)
At nodeR ,
R is resistance of room temperature
. (3)
(240)
120(1 4.5 10 T) At nodeS ,
40
11 4.5 10 T . (4)
11 1000 From (3) and (4)
T T 0
4.5
11 1000
T 26 2470.44 4. [Ans. A]
4.5
I P
IN
I1
1. [Ans. C]
+ 1V
For d.c voltage of 2 V, M.S.V = 4 1Ω 1A
For square wave voltage with peak – to –
peak value of 4 V or amplitude = 2V,
M.S.V = 4 + 4 = 8
R. . S. V √8 V The circuit is shown in Fig.
Voltage across 1 =1V
1 = 1A
Apply KCL at node, P
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 165
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
I+1= I1, 2Ω RL
or I+1=1 ,
I
0
+ +
10 V 3V +
5. [Ans. B]
The circuit is shown in Fig. 1
7. [Ans. C]
Fig. 2 Resistor 1 : 100 Ω 1
10 j 10 Resistor 2 : 800 Ω, 2 W
⃗⃗⃗⃗ Maximum current that resistor can
V 10√2
withstand
10√2(10 j 10)
200 e 1 1
√
For maximum power transfer to load, 100 10
10 j 10 R 10Ω Similarly,
⃗⃗⃗⃗
V
⃗⃗⃗ 10 e 2 1
20 √
i (t) 10 sin( 45 ) 800 20
10 If these two resistors are connected in
10 (rms)
√2 series.
Power transferred to load,
100Ω 800Ω
100
P (rms) R 10 500
2 I
6. [Ans. C]
V
The circuit is shown in Fig.
Then maximum value of
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 166
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
8. [Ans. A]
The given circuit is Fig. 1 10 V V
10 V
Convert the (10 V, 10 Ω) voltage source
across A, B to the left into a current
source, (1 A, 10 Ω). The resultant circuit is
shown in Fig. 2
10Ω For R calculation Independent
voltage source should be short circuited
So
10 V 10Ω 10 10Ω 5k
C
Fig. 1 5K 10 V
1V( ssume)
so V 1
Fig. 2 So *R +
The circuit is further simplified as shown Apply KCL at Node A
in Fig. 3 and 4 10 V
1 V V
10
5k 5K
1 5Ω 10 10Ω 1 V .5 V
2V 1.5 V 0.75V
Fig. 3
1 V 1 0.75
So
5k 5k
0.25
9 5Ω 10Ω 5k
5 10
0.05m
Fig. 4 1
5 [R 20kΩ]
0.05m
9 3
15
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 167
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE - 2006 Q P Q2 P2
+
1. In the figure shown, assume that all the S S2
capacitors are initially uncharged. 0
If Vi(t) =10u(t) Volts, then V0(t) is given (t)
by F
1K
+ +
Vi(t)
4 F
4K 1µF Vo(t) Assume that the capacitor has zero initial
charge. Given that u(t) is a unit step
function, the voltage (t) across the
capacitor is given by
(A) 8e Volts
(A) ∑ ( ) tu(t nT)
(B) 8( e ) Volts
(B) u(t) + 2 ∑ ( ) u(t nT)
(C) 8 u(t) Volts
(C) tu(t) + 2 ∑ ( ) (t nT)
(D) 8 Volts
u(t nT)
ECE - 2007 (D) ∑ 0 e ( )
+0 e ( )
]
2. In the circuit shown, Vc is 0 volts at t = 0 Common Data for Questions 4 and 5:
sec. For t>0, the capacitor current iC (t), The following series RLC circuit with zero
where t is in seconds, is given by initial condition is excited by a unit
20k i impulse function δ(t)
1H Ω
+
20k VC +
± 4 F
10V - δ(t) 1F
VC(t)
(A) 0.50 exp ( 25t)mA 4. For t > 0, the output voltage (t) is
√
(B) 0.25 exp ( 25t)mA (A) (e e )
√
(C) 0.50 exp ( 12.5 t)mA
(D) 0.25 exp ( 6.25 t)mA (B) te
√
√
(C) e cos ( t)
ECE - 2008 √
⁄ √
3. The circuit shown in the figure is used to (D) e sin ( t)
√
charge the capacitor C alternately from
two current sources as indicated. The 5. For t > 0, the voltage across the resistor
switches S1 and S2 are mechanically is
coupled and connected as follows √
(A) (e e )
For 2nT ≤ t< (2n+ )T, √
(n = 0, , 2…) S to P and S2 to P2 √ √
(B) e *cos ( ) sin ( )+
√
For (2n+ )T ≤ t< (2n+2)T, √
(n = 0, , 2…) S to Q and S2 to Q2 (C) e sin ( )
√
√
(D) e cos ( )
√
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 168
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
( ) ECE - 2011
(A) 0 (C) 10. In the circuit shown below, the initial
(B) (D) charge on the capacitor is 2.5 mC, with
the voltage polarity as indicated. The
ECE - 2009
switch is closed at time t = 0. The current
7. The time domain behavior of an RL circuit
i(t) at a time t after the switch is closed is
is represented by
⁄ i(t)
L + Ri = ( + e sint) u(t)
For an initial current of i(0) = , the
0
steady state value of the current is given
00
by
0 F
(A) i(t) → +
(B) i(t) →
(C) i(t) → (1+B) (A) i(t) = exp( 2 0 t)
(B) i(t) = exp( 2 0 t)
(D) i(t) → (1+B)
(C) i(t) = 0 exp( 2 0 t)
8. The switch in the circuit shown was on (D) i(t) = exp( 2 0 t)
position ‘a’ for a long time and is moved
to position ‘b’ at time t = 0. The current ECE/EE/IN - 2012
i(t) for t > 0 is given by 11. In the following figure, C1 and C2 are ideal
capacitors. has been charged to 12 V
0 kΩ a b
before the ideal switch S is closed at t = 0.
i(t)
The current i(t) for all t is.
0.2 F S t=0
100 V + kΩ
0.5 F 0.3 F
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 169
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE - 2013 R
Common Data for Questions 12 and 13:
Consider the following figure k R
+
2k F
5 Is
1
10V 2
Vs
⁄
2
( ) (t) = ( e ), = msec
2A
⁄
2
12. The current Is in Amps in the voltage ( ) (t) = ( e ), = msec
2
source, and voltage Vs is Volts across the
( ) (t) = ( ⁄
current source respectively , are e ), = msec
(A) , 20 (C) , 20 ⁄
( ) (t) = ( e ), = msec
(B) , 0 (D) , 20 2
13. The current in the 1 resistor in Amps is 17. A series RC circuit is connected to a DC
(A) 2 (C) 10 voltage source at time t = 0. The relation
(B) 3.33 (D) 12 between the source voltage , the
resistance R, the capacitance C, and the
ECE - 2014 current i(t) is given below:
14. In the figure shown, the ideal switch has
= R i(t) + ∫ i(u)du
been open for a long time. If it is closed at
t = 0, then the magnitude of the current Which one of the following represents the
(in m ) through the 4 k resistor at current i(t)?
t = 0 is _______. ( )
k 4k k
()
0 +
0 F mH
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 170
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
( )
R R
i(t) L1
+
V
I R
EE - 2006 R2 0Ω
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 171
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(A) ⁄ s (C) 4 s
(B) ⁄4 s (D) 9s
(A) = 1.4 Vx – 3.75I1 + V
EE - 2009
(B) = +1.4 Vx – 3.75I1 V
8. In the figure shown, all elements used are
(C) = 1.4 Vx + 3.75I1 + V ideal. For time t<0, S remained closed
(D) = 1.4 Vx + 3.75I1 V and S open. At t = 0, S is opened and S
is closed. If the voltage Vc2 across the
capacitor at t = 0 is zero, the
EE - 2008
voltage across the capacitor
Statement for Linked Answer Questions 5
combination at t=0+ will be
and 6
S1 S2
The current i(t) sketched in the figure
flows through an initially uncharged
0.3 nF capacitor. 3V C1 1F C2 2F
6
i(t) mA5
4 (A) 1V (C) 1.5 V
3 (B) 2 V (D) 3 V
2
1
EE - 2010
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
t ( s) Linked Answer Questions 9 and 10
9
The L-C circuit shown in the figure has an
5. The charge stored in the capacitor at
inductance L = 1mH and a capacitance
t = 5 µs, will be
C = 10µF.
(A) 8nC (C) 13nC
L
(B) 10nC (D) 16nC
i
6. The capacitor charged upto 5 ms, as per C 100 V
t=0
the current profile given in the figure, is 100+V
connected across an inductor of 0.6 mH.
Then the value of voltage across the
9. The initial current through the inductor is
capacitor after 1s will approximately be
zero, while the initial capacitor voltage is
(A) 18.8 V (C) 23.5 V
100 V. The switch is closed at t = 0. The
(B) 23.5 V (D) 30.6 V
current i through the circuit is:
(A) 5 cos( 0 t) A
7. The time constant for the given circuit
(B) 5 sin( 0 t) A
will be
(C) 10cos( 0 t) A
(D) 10 sin( 0 t) A
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 172
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
I
L
~ oad
t=0 C 100V
R = 0 (A) (t) = ( e ⁄
)
~ = √2 4
(B) (t) = ( e ⁄
)+
= √2 4
⁄
(C) (t) = ( + )( e )
12. The power dissipated in the resistor R is (D) (t) = ( )( e ⁄
)+
(A) 0.5 W (C) √2
(B) 1 W (D) 2
17. The voltage across the capacitor, as
shown in the figure, is expressed as
13. The current in the figure above is (t) = )
sin( t
(A) 2 (C) +
√ + sin ( t )
(B) (D) +j2A The values of and respectively, are
√
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 173
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
F + 0
2
1 3. At time t=0 , current I is
t
0 (A) ( ⁄ ) (C) ⁄
1µF (B) 0A (D)
+ + 4. At time t =0 , is is
Vi(t) M Vo(t) (A) 5A / s (C) 0A / s
(B) ( 0⁄ ) S (D) 5A / s
IN - 2007
2. In the circuit shown in the figure, the +
k
20 F
input signal is ( ) = + cos
+ +
(A) 0V (C) 2V
(t) R (t) (B) 1V (D) 3V
IN - 2011
Fig.
6. In the circuit shown below, the switch,
initially at position 1 for a long time, is
The steady – state output is expressed as
changed to position 2 at t = 0.
(t) = P + Q cos( t ). If R = 2,
the values of P and Q are
(A) P = 0 and Q = 6/√
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 174
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Sense harge
Sense
IN - 2014 control
ischarge
8. The circuit shown in figure was at steady
If T = kT then
state for t < 0 with the switch at position
(A) R = kR ( ) (C) R = kR
‘ ’ The switch is thrown to position ‘ ’ at
time = 0, . The voltage V (volts) across (B) R = kR ln ( ) (D) R = R lnk
the 0 resistor at time
t = 0 is _________________
2 12. capacitor ‘ ’ is to be connected across
the terminals ‘ ’ and ‘ ’ as shown in the
figure so that the power factor of the
+
parallel combination becomes unity. The
0 t=0
H
value of the capacitance required in F
is___________.
6
4
9. The average real power in watts delivered
to a load impedance = (4 j2) by an 60
0 Hz
ideal current source ~ 0 Hz
i (t) = 4 sin ( t + 20 ) is ______________ 0 Hz
j
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 175
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE Vc(t)
1. [Ans. D]
The transform circuit is shown below 1
(s)
2
t
+ + T T
-1
(s) (s) (s)
In mathematical form,
(t) = tu(t) 2(t T)u(t 2T) +
( ) ( ) 2(t 2T)u(t 2T)……………
For the given circuit = ( )
( ) ( )
= 4 F 20 k 20 = 40 ms
Using direct formula 6. [Ans. B]
(t) = ( ) ( ) (0)]e In the circuit shown,
R
(t) = 0 (0 0 )e =0 = R = (R + R )
(R + R )
(t) = 0 e m
T = ⁄R = ⁄(R + R )
3. [Ans. C] R
di ⁄(R + R ) R
The waveform of voltage Vc(t) is shown | = = =
below. dt T ⁄(R + R )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 176
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
7. [Ans. A] 0Ω
Take L.T of given differential equation
with i(0)= and use the L.T pairs: S i (0 )
1.5 A 0Ω i(0 )
sin(t) u(t) →
s + 0Ω 4
e sin(t) u(t) → ,
(s + ) + (0 ) =
()
L + Ri = ( + e sin t) u(t) t t = , the status of the circuit is shown
Take Laplace on both side in Fig. 3
0.5 A 0Ω
[s (s) ] + R (s) = +
R s
(s + ) + 0.5 A 0.5 A i ( ) 0
S
r ( s + R) (s) = + + + 1.5 A 0Ω
L
( ) i( )
0Ω
(s) = [ + + ]
( ) ( )
i( ) = 0
According to final value theorem,
The given circuit is a first order circuit
Steady state value of
with time constant, =
i(t) = i(t) = t s (s)] = R= 0+( 0 0) = 0 + =
→ → R
= mH = 0 H
8. [Ans. B] = = = 0 sec, = 0 sec
hen S is in position ‘a’, (0 ) = 00
General formula:
fter S is moved to b, (for t 0)
= 00 =0 R= i(t) = + (F )( e ),t 0
0 02
= =0 6 F i(t) = +( )( e )
2
(t) = 00 e ⁄ = 00e =0 0 2 e ,t 0
(t)
i(t) = = 20e u(t)m
10. [Ans. A]
Q(0 ) = 2 m
9. [Ans. A] (0 ) =
( )
= = 0
S is open for < ≤0
For t 0, = 0 = 00
At t = 0 the status of the circuit is shown
= R = 0 m sec
in Fig. 1
0.75 A (t) = ( 00 0e )u(t)
0.75 A
d
i (t) =
0.75 A S 0Ω
i (0 )
dt
= 0 0 0 2000 e u(t)
1.5 A 0Ω
15mH = e u(t)
0Ω
i(0 )
11. [Ans. D]
i (0 ) = 0 , i(0 ) = 0
When the switch in closed at t = 0
S is closed for 0 ≤ t <
Capacitor C1 will discharge and C2 will get
At t = 0 , i (0 ) = i (0 ) = 0
charge since both C1 and C2 are ideal and
The status of the circuit is shown in Fig. 2
there is no-resistance in the circuit
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 177
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
charging and discharging time constant 15. [Ans. *] Range 0.45 to 0.47
will be zero. A series LCR circuit operating frequency
Thus current will exist like an impulse is such that current leads the supply
function. voltage so
The current at resonance = = amp
12. [Ans. D]
R= = H = F
2 v The magnitude of current is the value at
resonance
0 Ω
+ 10V
=
+ 2Ω Ω 2
v 2A 0 0
_ = 0 = =
20 2 = √R + (x x ) √ +( )
i i
k i(t)
0 +
urrent after long time = = m F
0k 2k
At t = 0 the voltage across the capacitor
is 10
Where, = = 0 = = 2000i(t)
Now at t= 0 dv di
i =c = 0 002
dt dt
+ 4k di
i = [0 002 + i(t)] amp
dt
di
= 2 + 000i(t)
dt
+ =
The current is m = 2 m di
4
2 + 000i(t) + 2000i(t) =
dt s
di
2 + 000i(t) + 2000i(t) =
dt s
000
2 [s (s) + (s)] =
2 s
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 178
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
17. [Ans. A]
= Ri(t) + ∫ i(u)du Current through R = 5/1 =5A
Current delivered by 5V source = 5 1
=R + aplace transform ]
S = 4A
= =
2. [Ans. B]
is a D.C voltage source,
The relevant circuit is shown in fig.
so = where depends on
+ +
S k
= = L (t)
s(RS + ) R (s + ) C
k
i(t) = e
R Fig.
() =
It is a standard LC circuit.
With v (t) = cos( t)
or sin( t + 0 )
3. [Ans. D]
Equivalent circuit at t = 0 is,
18. [Ans. *] Range 31.24 to 31.26
i V I
2H 0Ω +
+ + 0Ω L 10A 10V
2i
0u(t) (t)
By nodal analysis,
( )
0+ =0 2 0 = 00
( )
Since we have to evaluate (t) in steady = = = 4
state the inductor will behave as a short
circuit and hence = i
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 179
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
4. [Ans. A] 8. [Ans. A]
V-3( + ) 0 = 0 …… (1) The status of the circuit at t = 0 is
shown in fig. 1.
0 = 0.2
A
0 +02 = 0……… (2)
Eliminating I2 for eq(1) and (2) we get +
3V 3V
= 4 + 1F 2F
5. [Ans. C] Fig. 1 B
i(t) The status of the circuit at t = 0 is
mA shown in Fig. 2.
4 S A S
2 +
3V + V
A1 A2
3V
2 s s s
B Fig. 2
Charged stored in the capacitor = area
under i – t curve = = =
Q= +
= (2 0 ) (4 0 ) + (4 + 2) 9. [Ans. D]
2 2
Initial current through the inductor is
0 ( 2)
zero and capacitor voltage is charged
0
upto to voltage
6
= [4 + ] 0 = n (0 ) = 00
2
As current through inductor and voltage
6. [Ans. D] across cannot change abrupty.
apacitor charged upto s, so total So, after closing the switch
charge stored in capacitor = Q = 13nC i (0 ) = i (0 ) = 0
Voltage across the capacitor before And (0 ) = (0 ) = 00
connecting to indictor The circuit is s – domain
Q 0
= = =4 sL
0 0 (0 ) 00
=
Voltage across the capacitor at time t I(s s s
(t)at t = s ) 1/s
(t) = cos t] C
t= 0
√ (s) =
= 2.357 rad = (s + )
(t) =4 cos
00
06 = ( )
s +
7. [Ans. C]
⁄√
= F;R = 6Ω T=R = 4sec = 00√ ( )
s + ( ⁄√ )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 180
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
11. [Ans. B]
(0 ) = 4 (0 ) = 4 16. [Ans. D]
( ) At t = 0
i (0 ) = = A Voltage across capacitor =
tt 0
12. [Ans. B] +i R+i R+ =0
Power supplied by the source = cos d
+ 2c R+ =0
Where = angle between dt
= 4 inductor and capacitor do not Taking Laplace
consume power.
+ (2Rc) s (0)] + =0
Therefore, power dissipated in R = Power s
supplied by the source + 2Rcs 2R + =0
P = cos s
= √2 cos ( + 2Rcs) = 2R
4 s
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 181
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
2R 1µF
(s) =
+ 2Rcs S( + 2Rcs)
+ +
2R 2Rc
(s) = + Vi(t) M
+ 2Rcs + 2Rcs s Vo(t)
(t) (e) = e + e
+ Input is 2V for t 1s.
* (t) = ( + )( e )+ + Time constant ( ) = = 0 0
=
17. [Ans. A] So (0 ) = 2
Applying superposition theorem Laplace Equivalent circuit after the change
Resolving 0 sin t source 1/sc 2/s
+
(t) = sin ( 0t + tan ( ) 0)
√ ( )
F s 2 s s
(s) = =
R+
(s) =
Rsc +
= = c
+ + j (s) = = ce
+s
( ) Now voltage across Resister at t = 2s
= 0 sin( t) (t) = (t) R
+
( ) = ce R
= 0 sin( t) = Rc e
+ j
( ) = e ]
0
= sin t tan ( )]
√ +2 2. [Ans. A]
20
(t) = sin( 0t The circuit is shown in Fig.
√ 00 +
( 0 tan ( ))
0 + +
0
+ sin( t (t)
√ +2 R (t)
tan )
IN Fig.
1. [Ans. A] (t) = + cos( t)
Vi(t) Due to 5V d.c alone , C is open and no
current flows through R,
= 0 and =0
2
ue to cos ( t) alone, with
1
0 t
THE GATE ACADEMY tPVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
th th th
( ) = (0 ) = A
3. [Ans. A]
For t < 0, the circuit is shown in Fig. 1
4. [Ans. B]
1
I=0 I2 From Fig. 3: Write the Outer loop
I1 equation:
1H d (t)
2 (t) ]+ + 0=
dt
At t = 0
1F 10 V d
(0 ) = (0 ) = +
dt
Fig. 1(for t <0)
= /sec
After a long time, at t = 0 L behaves as
short circuit and C behaves as open
5. [Ans. B]
circuit. The relevant circuit is shown in
The given circuit is shown in Fig. 1
Fig.2.
1
t steady state i e , as t → , capacitor
I=0 I2(0 )
behaves as open circuit. The circuit at
I1(0 ) IL(0 ) steady state is shown in Fig.2
2 L 2k 0 F
V1 V2
R1
(0 ) C 10 V
1k R2
9V 20 F
Fig. 2(at t = 0 )
At t = 0 , I1(0 )=0, iL(0 )= I2(0 )=0 and
v (0 ) = 0 Fig. 1
For t > 0, the switch, K is closed and the 2k C1
V1 V2
relevant circuit is shown in Fig. 3
R1
K 1 I2
I
1k
I1 9V C2
1H
2
5V Fig. 2
1 10 V
Apply voltage division across R1 = 2k
F and R2 = 1k
Fig. 3(t >0)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 183
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
= = ( )
j
V1 is divided between C1 = 0 F and 0
C2 = 20 F 0 0
Apply, again voltage division across C1
+ +
and C2 0
0
= = = j
+ 0
6. [Ans. D]
From the given circuit, =0
For t < 0, the status of the circuit is
=
shown in Fig. 1 inductor behaves as short
j = ( )
circuit after a long time.
=
i(0 ) = =
10
8. [Ans. ]
i
tt=0
10 V ± 1H
Fig. 1 + (inductor
0 in steady
for t 0, the status of the circuit is shown state)
in Fig. 2 6
Current through the inductor cannot
change instantaneously. 6
i(0 ) = i(0 ) = initial value (I.V) T = = = (0 )
2
After a long time inductor behaves as At t= 0
short circuit.
i( ) = 2 = final value (F. V) 2
Time constant = = , = 20 + +
0
10
i 6
10
4A 10 1H
= 0 = 0 ]
Fig. 2
9. [Ans. 32]
( )
i(t) = + (F )( e ) Load impedance = = (4 j2)
for t 0 Ideal current source
= + (2 )( e ) i(t) = 4 sin ( t + 20 )
=2 e Average real power = i
=( ) 4
√
6
Power = 4= 2
2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 184
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
=
2 0
= F
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 185
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1 1
1
(A) a low-pass filter 1
2 ∠ (7 4j)Ω
5 5
5∠3
j3 j3
(A) 8VAR (C) 28 VAR
(B) 16 VAR (D) 32 VAR
ECE - 2010
B
6. The current I in the circuit shown is
(A) 0 (C) 12.5∠3 2 m
(B) 5∠3 (D) 17∠3
~ 2 ∠
1 rad s
1 5
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 186
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE/EE/IN - 2013
9. In the circuit shown below, if the source 13. The circuit shown in the figure, the value
of capacitor C (in mF) needed to have
voltage Vs= 10053.130 V then the
critically damped response i(t) is ________.
Thevenin’s equivalent voltage in volts as
4 4
seen by the load resistance RL is
3 j4 j6 5
i(t)
RL= 10
j4 1
(A) 100900 (C) 800900 14. In the magnetically coupled circuit shown
(B) 80000 (D) 100600 in the figure, 56 % of the total flux
emanating from one coil links the other
10. Two magnetically uncoupled inductive coil. The value of the mutual inductance
coils have Q factors q1 and q2 at the (in H) is ______ .
chosen operating frequency. Their 1
respective resistances are R1 and R2.
When connected in series, their effective 6 cos (1⁄16)
is
(A) q q
(B) (1⁄q ) (1 q ) 15. The steady state output of the circuit
(C) (q q ) ⁄( ) shown in the figure is given by
(D) (q q ) ⁄( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 187
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
y(t)
sin t
~
1 1 The phasor diagram which is applicable
( ) ( )
√3 to this circuit is
2 2
( ) ( ) (A)
√3 I
EE - 2006
1. In the figure the current source is 1 ∠0 A,
R = 1Ω, the impedances are Zc = j Ω, (B)
I
and ZL = 2jΩ. The Thevenin equivalent
looking into the circuit across X-Y is
x
(C)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 188
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
SW T1 R
B C
+
25V C (A)
Vp +
(A) 25 V, 0.0A Im
(B) Very large voltage, very large
current Re
(C) 5.0 V, 0.5 A
(D) 5.0 V, 0.5 A
(B)
XY C
∠ ~ Im
O
2V 2V
(A) 0 (C) 0 VYX
VYX Re
VYX VYX
0 2V 0 2V
Re
6. The R-L-C series circuit shown is supplied
from a variable frequency voltage source. EE - 2008
The admittance locus of the 7. The Thevenin's equivalent of a circuit
network at terminals AB for increasing operating at = 5rad/s, has
frequency is = 3.71∠ 15.90 V and
ZO =2.38 – j 0.667Ω. At this frequency,
the minimal realization of the Thevenin's
impedance will have a
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 189
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(A) (C) 1
(D) √2
(B)
1 1 √
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 190
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
2 R
( )
R C
2
~
( ) (A) √1 (C)
(D)
(B)
IN - 2007
t
2. In the circuit shown in the following
2 figure, the current through the 1Ω
resistor is
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 191
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(B) j
L=1H j
C = 0.25F
V = 1V
1Ω
I = (5cos2t)A
j
(C) j ( )
j ( )
(A) (1 + 5 cos 2t) A (C) (1 5 cos 2t) A j
(B) (5 + cos 2t) A (D) 6A
(D) j ( )
j ( )
3. Consider the AC bridge shown in the
j ( )
figure below, with R, L and C having
positive finite values
IN - 2008
Then
5. In the circuit below the average power
consumed by the 1 resistor is
sin t 1 √2 sin (1 t) 1Ω
1 √2 cos (3 t) 1 mH
(A) if
(B) if (A) 50 W (C) 5000 W
(B) 1050 W (D) 10100 W
(C) if
√
(D) cannot be made zero 6. For the circuit shown below the voltage
across the capacitor is
4. Consider the coupled circuit shown
below. 1 Ω
j1 Ω
~ (10+j0)V
j1 Ω
ig a
At angular frequency , this circuit can be
represented by the equivalent (A) (10 + j 0)V (C) (0 + j100)V
T – network shown below. (B) (100+j0)V (D) (0 – j100)V
7. For the circuit shown below the steady-
state current I is
I
cos(1000t)V
1Ω
ig b
Indicate the correct set of expressions for
V(t)= 5√2
1mH 1000 F
the impedances of the T – network
(A) j ( )
j ( )
j
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 192
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(A) 0A
(B) 5√2 cos (1000t)A
(C) 5√2 cos (1 t )
(D) 5√2A
IN - 2010
Statement for Linked Answer Questions: 8
&9
A coil having an inductance (L) of 10mH
and resistance R is connected in series
with an ideal 100 F capacitor (C). When
excited by a voltage source of value
10√2 cos (1000t)V, the series RLC circuit
draws 20W of power.
IN - 2011
Common Data for Question 10 & 11
Consider the circuit shown below:
2
2 sin(5t)
.1 cos(5t)
i(t)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 193
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE 6. [Ans. A]
1. [Ans. C] j
( ) ( || 1⁄ )
( ) ( 1⁄ ( || 1⁄ )) 2 ∠
( )
1 ~ 1
j
1
( ) ( 3 1)
( )
ut J , ( ) ( ) (L = 20 mH, C = 50 )
(J ) Nodal analysis at node A
s , (J ) 2
s , (J ) j 1 1 j
1⁄ J 1⁄ * 1 j1 5 1 +
t , (J )3
3J 2
Filter is band-pass filter.
j1 2 1
j j
2. [Ans. D] [ 1 ] j1
2 2
For maximum power transfer, j1
J
1
3. [Ans. D] j1
current impedance
53 ((5 3J)||(5 3J)) 7. [Ans. D]
34 This is standard concept of parallel
5 3 173
1 resonant circuit
4. [Ans. A] 8. [Ans. C]
Replace 10V by short circuit and 1A by | | √4 3 5Ω
open circuit
( 1). (1 1⁄ ) 9. [Ans. C]
1
2 1⁄ 1
j4
5. [Ans. B] 3 j4
1
∠53 13
The RMS current in the load is given by j4
5∠53 13
⃗ ∠ tan ( ) j4 2 ∠
2∠ tan ( ) 4∠ 2 ∠
8 9
2 , reactive power
8 9
4 4
16
10. [Ans. C]
Also note that the active power consumed
by the load 4 7 28
fter series connection
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 194
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
( ) 1
2
1 1
√
2
11. [Ans. B] 1 4 1
√
Total ower (s) 4 2
1 1 4
∠ cos .8 ∠ cos .8 4
.8 .8 c
18 1.5j 4 1
c 1 m
4 1
12. [Ans. *] Range 0.39 to 0.42
x 14. [Ans. *] Range 2.49 to 2.52
(T⁄2 , 1)
1 oupling coefficient given is .56
e know, √
√
t
iven 4 5
T 2 T 2
.56 √4 5
1 2.5 4
√ ∫ x dt
T
15. [Ans. B]
Equation of line
x
1
(t )
T ⁄2
y(t)
2t
T sin t
1 2t
√ *∫ ( ) dt +
T T
1 4t y(t) ( ) sin[ t ( )]
√ * +
T 3T | ( )| .25
By nodal analysis
4 1 x 1∠ x x
√
3 8 1 cj ⁄
2 cj
1 1 cj 1∠
x[ cj ]
√6 2
.4 8 2 3 cj 1∠ 2
x[ ] x
2 2 3 cj
13. [Ans. *] Range 9.99 to 10.01 x 1
y
4 4 2 2 3 cj
1 1
| ( )|
i(t)
4 √4 9
9 12
2
For critically damped √3 c
1 1 2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 195
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE V
1. [Ans. D]
To calculate Thevenin’s impedance, 200
current – source is open – circuited V
x
R=1 2 T/2
ZL=2j Zth 1 1
T
f 15
ZC= j
y Vrms value of the input voltage
z z z
1
1 2j j * ∫ dt+
T
= 1 j
Open – circuit voltage at terminals X – Y
z 1
1 (1 j) ∫2 dt ∫( 2 ) dt
T
√245 volts [ { }]
2
2. [Ans. B] 2
1 k
Assuming resistance of the heater = R 23
(i) When heater connected to 230 V. 1.739 k
50 Hz source, energy consumed by
the heater = 2.3 units or 2.3 kWh in 3. [Ans. A]
1 hour
Power consumed by the heater
2.3k h
1 hour
2.3 k
rms value of the input voltage
23 j( )
At resonance,
23 so
2.3 1 23 Therefore, input impedance is purely
(ii) When heater connected to 400 V resistive, is minimum and the input
(peak to peak ) square wave source voltage and output current are in phase
of 150 Hz [ j( )]
( )
but
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 196
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1 5. [Ans. A]
j
l
∠ 9 ∠
R
∠ C
4. [Ans. D]
R IR using ,.
T1
s1
Vs
s2 ( )
P1
( )
25V VP C
P2 ( )
T1
( )
VT
T2 Method -1
* +
All the three windings has same number
of turns, so magnitude of induced emf’s in when
all the three windings will be same i.e. * +
| | | | | |
Polarity of the windings is decided on the * +
basis of dot – convention.
when
As capacitor is charged to 5 V with left
plate as positive.
Method-2
So, T1 is positive wrt T2
5 * +
As T2 has negative polarity. So, P1 has √ ∠ ( )
negative polarity ∠18 ( )
√ ∠ ( )
Therefore, VP = 5
Similarly, S1 has negative polarity ∠ (18 2 tan ( ))
So, 5
Magnitude of
5
.5 So, option (c) and (d) can not be correct,
1 as magnitude is 2V in these two options.
Angle of 1 8 2 tan ( )
When
∠ 18 2tan ( )
18 2 9 36
when
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 197
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
∠ 18 2 tan ( ) 18
On the basic of above analysis, the locus
of is drawn below:
2V
O Ref
when ∠ when
R=0
√
6. [Ans. B] 7. [Ans. B]
Admittance of the series connected RLC Thevenin’s mpedance
2.38 j .667
( ) as real part is not zero , so has resistor
( ) m[ ] j .667
( ) Case –I
*By rationlization} Z0 has capacitor (as Im[Z0]is negative )
Separating, real and imaginary part of Case – II
admittance. Z0 has both capacitor and inductor, but
inductive reactance capacitive
e[ ]
( ) reactances
For any value of , the real part is always at = 5 rad / sec
positive. For minimal realization case – (i) is
When or considered
Therefore, Z0 will have a resistor and a
At (resonance) capacitor.
√
e[ ] (maximum value)
( )
8. [Ans. C]
( ) Input impedance
( )
1
( ) z j ‖
j
( )
z j
At (resonance) 1 j
√
0.1H
Imaginary part of zero
m( )
For
z 1F 1
Therefore, [ ] j .1
On the basis of above analysis, the 1
admittance locus is j ( .1 )
1 1
At resonance, imaginary part must be
zero.
.1
1
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 198
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1 11. [Ans. B]
.1
1 rms value of input voltage
1 1 1 √2
9 1
√2
3 rad/sec rms value of current
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 199
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
15. [Ans. C] ( )
tt ( )
( ) 1
d
dt 1
1
∫d ∫ dt
t ( )
k ( ) 1 1
At t = 0, 2
[ ]
k 2 1 1
t 1 1
2 1 1 1 1
t 1 1
2 2 2
2 1 1 1 1 1
t 2 1 2 1 2 2
1
2 1 t 1 1
1
2 2
1 1
16. [Ans. C]
2 2 ( )
Magnitude of
| | (using maximum power 1 1
transfer theorem) 2 2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 200
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
2 2 i i (1 5 cos 2t)
2 (2 ) 3. [Ans. D]
. 1, The A.C bridge is shown in Fig
2. [Ans. A]
The circuit is shown in the figure 1 Let , ,
1
j ,
of the vridge is balanced if product
(5 cos 2t)
4. [Ans. A]
The coupled circuit is shown in Fig. 1
1 1
i
Fig. 2
From figure 2, i 1
Due to AC source (5 cos 2t) alone, the
circuit is shown in figure 3, where the ig 1
Fig. 3
For 2, 2 .25 .5,
2 1 2
As , the parallel RLC circuit is ig 2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 201
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
.1 i( )
cos(5t)
)
i(t)
cos(1
1 Fig. 1
Given: 5 rad sec
1m 1
5√2e
R=2 , .1 , 2
Taking cos (5t) = Re[1e e ]
v(t)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 202
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
⃗⃗⃗
9
j2
j2
⃗⃗⃗⃗ 2∠
Fig. 2
The circuit is further simplified to the
circuit in Fig. 3 and Fig. 4
j1 2 j2 1
⃗
Fig. 3
(1 j) 2 j2
⃗
Fig. 4
From Fig 4
(1 j)2 (1 j) √2∠45
⃗
2 j2 1 j √2∠ 45
1∠9 1∠ 9 j
i(t) ⃗
e[ e ] e[1e e ]
e[e ( )
] cos(5t 9 )
sin(5t)
11. [Ans. C]
Phasor current through 2 1 j
1 j j
1
i (t) 1 cos(5 t)
Power is dissipated in the resistance, 2 .
Assuming that the source values are given
in RMS value
Power delivered by the 2 sources
= Power dissipated in the equivalent 2
of Fig. 4
(1) 2 2
Note: Assuming Peak value for the
sources,
Power delivered by the 2 sources
=( ) 2 1
√
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 203
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Laplace Transform
0.002
C
R
1mV
+
+ +
Vi R Vo (A) (C)
(B) (D)
Filter 2
(A) 4 (C) ⁄
(B) 1 (D) ⁄
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 204
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE – 2014
1. The driving point impedance Z(s) for the
circuit shown below is
F F
(A) (C)
(B) (D)
2. [Ans. A]
I(S)
+
~ ( ‖ )
LS
V(S)
( )
Li (0 )
+
……………
⁄
0 0 0 So here,
Now,
3. [Ans. D]
⁄ ⁄ ⁄
Put ,
4. [Ans. C]
( ⁄ ) So, * +
( ⁄ )
………………………
( ⁄ )
⁄
( ⁄ ) I(s) =
⁄
( ( ⁄ ))
⁄
( ⁄ ) Now , ( ‖ )
( ⁄ )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 205
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
In time domain,
( )
6. [Ans. D]
100 μF
0
100 μF
⁄
⁄
Substituting the values we get
EE
1. Ans. A]
F F
peda e f du a e ‘ ’d a
peda e f apa f F
( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 206
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Two-Port Networks
(B) * + (D) * +
(B) (D)
(A) L H R Ω F
ECE - 2008 (B) L H R Ω F
Statement for linked Answer Questions 3 (C) L = 0.1H, R = 2Ω 0.1F
and 4 (D) L H R 2Ω F
A two port network shown below is
excited by external dc sources. The ECE - 2010
voltages and currents are measured with 6. For the two-port network shown below,
voltmeters and ammeters the short circuit admittance parameter
(All assumed to be ideal) as indicated. matrix is
Ω
Under following switch conditions, the 1 2
readings obtained are: Ω Ω Ω
(i) –open , - closed 2
2
(ii) –closed , – open (A) * +S (C) * +S
2
2
(B) * +S (D) * +S
2
2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 207
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 208
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
2 k 49i1
Input loop
F
F
2
(A) 2 F (C) 2 F
2
(A) * + (C) * + (B) F (D) Fs
2 2
2
(B) * + (D) * + EE - 2010
2
4. The two-port network P shown in the
EE - 2006 figure has ports 1 and 2, denoted by
1. The parameters of the circuit shown in terminals (a, b) and (c, d), respectively. It
the figure are R MΩ R = 10 Ω, has an impedance matrix Z with
A = V/V.If = 1 V, then output parameters denoted by . A 1Ω resistor
voltage, input impedance and output is connected in series with the network at
impedance respectively are port 1 as shown in the figure. The
R R impedance matrix of the modified two-
+ port network (shown as a dashed box) is
+
_ e a c
_
P
(A) 1V, , 10 Ω (C) 1 V, 0,
(B) 1 V,0, 10Ω (D) 10 V, ,10Ω f b d
(D) [ ]
IN - 2007
(A) z parameters,* + 1. The DC voltage gain in the following
(B) h parameters,* + circuit is given by.
R R
(C) h parameters,* +
(D) z parameters,* + R
EE - 2009
3. The equivalent capacitance of the input (A) AV (C) AV +R
loop of the circuit shown is (B) AV (D) AV
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 209
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN - 2008 IN - 2013
2. For the circuit shown below the input 3. Considering the transformer to be ideal,
resistance R11 = | is th tr nsmission p r m t r ‘ ’ of th
2 port network shown in the figure
3I2
+ below is
1 2 2 2
Ω 2V3 2Ω 1:2
+ I1 I2
+I I2 + V1 5 5 V2
1
V1 2Ω V3 V2 2
(A) 1.3 (C) 0.5
(B) 1.4 (D) 2.0
(A) Ω (C) Ω
(B) 2 Ω (D) Ω
ECE 3. [Ans. C]
1. [Ans. B] =
=
| current source will be
s (1) =0 |
open)
|
| = r
s (2) =0 |
| = 1.5
2. [Ans .D]
The ABCD parameter equations are given =* +
by,
4. [Ans. A]
wh n th n twork is t rmin l R fig =h h
R =h h
From giv n p r m t rs
2
R R
R R = 1.5 = 3
H=* +
RL
Fig. 1
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 210
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
5. [Ans. D]
R L
R L ⁄ Note: is Independent of
(R L R ⁄ L⁄ )
R L⁄ 8. [Ans. C]
As per the given conditions, we can draw
R L R L⁄
the following two figures.
RL
R L L R
3A
⁄ N
B
(
⁄R ⁄L ) A ± 10
2 V
2
s 2
Comparing (1) and (2)
⁄ 2 F
⁄R R 2
2A
⁄L 2 L H B
A ± 10V N 2.5
6. [Ans. A]
|
|
Let Vth and Rth be the Thevenin voltage &
| 2 resistance as seen from part B.
[ ] 2
* + R
2
7. [Ans. D]
iv n * +
2
2 R
From the circuit shown in Fig. 1 2
2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 211
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
2 N
i= N
10. [Ans. B]
ort p r m t rs ort 2 Lo
2
For network B
s
s s 2
Port 2 is short circuited
h n ws 2 2
From
s s
[ s ] s
s s
From 2
s s
s 2
[ s ]
s s
s s
[ s
s s s s s
s
s
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 212
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE
h 1. [Ans. A]
= 1V
2 =
2
= R = 10
12. [Ans. B]
s s 2. [Ans. C]
h h
h h
R R I1 I2
s s
s s
V1 V2
om ining n
h |
[(R ) (2R ) R] s s
s R s
*(2R ) (R ) R + s R s h |
R s h h
s s R o h – p r m t rs [ ] * +
(2R ) (R ) R h h
s R s
3. [Ans. A]
s 2Rs Rs R s
Assume a 1A current source at input
R s
terminals,
sr s R = 1A
R k
s }R i k k
F
s s i
k
s s s
~ F
F
13. [Ans. C] i
[ ] Applying KVL
i i j
* +
i [2 j ]
* + Input impedance 2 j
2
As imaginary part is negative, input
impedance has equivalent capacitive
reactance .
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 213
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
2 2 2
h r 2 put it in qu tion
2
2 F
o[ | ]
4. [Ans. C]
The impedance matrix of the modified 3. [Ans. A]
network is calculated from fig. given 2 2 2
1 I1 2
below:
[ ] [ ][ ] V1 5 5 V2
2 n 2
[ ] [ ][ ] |
[ ] [ ] * + t
2
1 2
From qu tion
2
2
From qu tion
Fig.
2 2
IN From qu tion n
1. [Ans. A]
V=
2. [Ans. D]
2 3I2
+
Ω 2V3 2Ω I2
d c
+ I1 b + + +
2
V3
V1 2Ω
f e
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 214
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Network Topology
[ ]
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 215
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
2 5
I II III
Fig.
4 6
3
Fig.
IV
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 216
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 217
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE - 2007 EE - 2014
2. If u(t), r(t) denote unit the unit step and 5. The function shown in the figure can be
unit ramp functions respectively and represented as
u(t) * r(t) their convolution, then the
function u (t+1) * r(t 2) is given by
(A) (1/2) (t 1) (t+2)
(B) (1/2) (t 1) (t 2)
(C) (1/2) (t 1)2 u(t 1)
(D) none of the above
t
EE - 2008
3. Given a sequence x[n], to generate the
(A) u t u t u t
sequence y[n] = x[3 4n], which one of
the following procedures would be u t
correct?. (B) u t u t u t
(A) First delay x[n] by 3 samples to
generate z [n], then pick every 4th (C) u t u t u t
sample of z1[n] to generate z2[n], and u t
then finally time reverse z2[n] to
obtain y[n] (D) u t u t u t
(B) First advance x[n] by 3 samples to
generate Z1[n], and then pick every
4th samples of z1[n] to generate z2 [n] 6. An input signal x t s πt is
and then finally time reverse Z2[n] to sampled with a sampling frequency of
obtain y[n] 400 Hz and applied to the system whose
(C) First pick every fourth sample of x[n] transfer function is represented by
to generate v time-reverse z z
( )
v to obtain v & finally z
advance v by 3 sample to obtain Where, N represents the number of
y[n] samples per cycle. The output y(n) of the
(D) First pick every fourth sample of x[n] system under steady state is
to generate V1[n], time-reverse V1[n] (A) 0 (C) 2
to obtain V2[n], and finally delay (B) 1 (D) 5
V2[n] by 3 samples to obtain Y[n]
7. For the signal
EE - 2011 f t s πt s πt s πt
4. A zero mean random signal is uniformly the minimum sampling frequency (in Hz)
distributed between limits satisfying the Nyquist criterion is ________
and its mean square value is equal to its
variance. Then the r. m. s. value of the IN - 2007
signal is 1. Consider the periodic signal
(A) (C) √ x t c s πt c s πt
√
(D) √ where t is in seconds. Its fundamental
(B)
√ frequency, in Hz, is
(A) 20 (C) 100
(B) 40 (D) 200
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 218
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 219
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN - 2014 (A) t s t y
12. Time domain expressions for the (B) t s t y
voltage t t r v s (C) t s t y
t s t (D) t s t y
t = c s t Which one of
the following statement is TRUE?
ECE s π s π
1. [Ans. D] Every trigonometric function repeats
after π t rv
t s π π s π π
π π ) (
π
t S c ‘ ’ s y teger, there is no
p ss v u f‘ ’f rw c ‘ ’c
2. [Ans. A] an integer, thus non-periodic
f u t 7. [Ans. A]
s
ẏ t y t u t , P = 5, Q = u t ,
m tu t fr qu cy
√ I.F. =
s y t ∫
√ √ w
w r
y
f
π y t
t y t s ∑ y
t
5. [Ans. C ] EE
Cascade means convolution 1. [Ans. D]
If the amplitude of a signal have some
6. [Ans. D] finite boundaries for all values of time
Assume x to be periodic, (with period then it is called as bounded signal.
N)
x x
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 220
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
|f t | i.e, z z x
}f r t
r |f t | f tt v v u Now reverse (time reverse) z will
So a bounded signal may possess finite give y[n] = z x
energy or infinite energy.
For example u (t) is bounded signal but it 4. [Ans. A]
possess infinite energy because it is a
Variance
power signal.
It can be zero or nonzero outside a finite
interval ( t t
But it is always true that it will be always
finite for any value of time t.
Mean square value
2. [Ans. C]
RMS value
u t r t √
∫r u t 5. [Ans. A]
Result graph r p r p
r p
z t ∫ r r p
u u t
z t ∫
r p
For (t ≥
t
u t
z t ( )
r p
f r t≥
t t
z t t t t t
u t
For t≥
z t t
For t≥
6. [Ans. C]
z t t u t
x t s πt
t πft πt f
3. [Ans. B]
m p r fx t
Y[n] = x[3 – 4n] = x[ 4n+ 3]
So to obtain y[n] we first advance x[n] by ms
3 unit. s mp p r
i.e, z x
Now we will take every fourth sample of ms
z um r f s mp s c cyc
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 221
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN y t ∑ x t
1. [Ans. A]
X(t) = (1+0.5 cos πt c s πt This is the representation of a signal x(t)
c s πt c s πt c s πt in weighted and sum form and it obeys
c s πt c s πt the principle of superposition and
c s πt homogeneity. So, this is linear but it is
x t x t x t time varying as for x(t t ),
w r y t ∑x t t
x c s πt And y t t ∑x t t
x c s πt Therefore
x c s πt y t t y t s t m v ry
Now, tm p r fx t 6. [Ans. C]
π
s
π x t y t ∫ x
s
Value of y t ‘t’ depends on values of x for
s times from t t
As output is depending on future values
of input, the system is Non casual
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 222
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
x t t t t
∫x t t t t {
s w r u t u t
π π
∫ (t ) s t t s
At t = 2 value is 1
Hence, correct option is (B) 12. [Ans. A]
8. [Ans. C] t t
Given the system, y(t) = { x t }
y t x t x t
t
[
x t x t ]
t
As y(t) is obtained from linear operation v t s t
on x(t), the system is linear . t c s t
As the input x(t) is multiplied by a time t c s t
varying function , the system is t c s t
Time – varying.
For a bounded input x(t) , x(t) is
bounded, y(t) is also bounded. Therefore t s t y
the system is stable.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 223
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 224
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 225
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 226
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
h(t) = . The response of this If the input to the system is cos(3t) and
system for a unit step input u(t) is the steady state output is A sin(3t + ),
(A) u(t) + then the value of A is
(B) u t (A) 1/30 (C) 3/4
(C) u t (B) 1/15 (D) 4/3
(D) t u t
13. Given two continuous time signals 17. Consider an LTI system with impulse
x(t) = and y(t) = which exist for response h(t) = u t . If the output of
t > 0 the convolution z(t) = x(t) * y(t) is the system is y t u t u t
(A) u t then the input, x(t), is given by
(B) u t (A) u t
(C) (B) u t
(D) (C) u t
(D) u t
EE - 2013
14. Which one of the following statement is 18. A 10 kHz even-symmetric square wave is
NOT TRUE for a continuous time causal passed through a bandpass filter with
and stable LTI system? centre frequency at 30 kHz and 3 dB
(A) All the poles of the system must lie on passband of 6 kHz. The filter output is
the left side of the j axis. (A) a highly attenuated square wave at 10
(B) Zeros of the system can lie anywhere kHz.
in the s-plane (B) nearly zero.
(C) All the poles must lie within |s| (C) a nearly perfect cosine wave at 30
(D) All the root of the characteristic kHz.
equation must be located on the left (D) a nearly perfect sine wave at 30 kHz.
side of the j axis.
19. A continuous-time LTI system with
EE - 2014 system function H( ) has the following
15. x(t) is nonzero only for t , and pole-zero plot. For this system, which of
similarly, y(t) is nonzero only for the alternatives is TRUE?
t . Let z(t) be convolution of x(t)
and y(t). Which one of the following
statements is TRUE?
(A) z(t) can be nonzero over an
unbounded interval.
(B) z(t) is nonzero for t
(C) z(t) is zero outside of
t
(D) z(t) is nonzero for t .
(A) | | | | | |
16. Consider an LTI system with transfer (B) | | s mu t p m x m t
function (C) | | | | | |
(D) | | c st t
s
s s
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 228
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(B) c s (t )
(B) √
y(t)
(C) s t
1 √
4
t (D) s (t )
2 6 √
1
IN - 2011
(C)
y(t) 5. Consider the signal
t≥
x(t) = {
1
t
Let X( ) denote the Fourier transform of
t
1 1 3 5 this signal. The integral
∫ is
(A) 0 (C) 1
(D) y t)
(B) ⁄ (D)
1
IN - 2013
3 5
1 2
t 6. The impulse response of a system is
h(t) = t u(t). for an input u(t 1), the
output is
(A) u t
IN - 2008 (B) u t
2. Which one of the following discrete-time
systems is time invariant? (C) u t
(A) y [n] = nx [n] (C) y[n] = x[ n] (D) u t
(B) y [n] = x [3n] (D) y [n] = x[n 3]
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 229
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN - 2014
7. The impulse response of an LTI system is
given as :
π
{s
π
It represents an ideal
(A) non-causal, low-pass filter
(B) causal, low-pass filter
(C) non-causal, high-pass filter
(D) causal, high-pass filter
ECE 1 1
1. [Ans. C] x[k]
x → y [s ( π )] x
The system is linear as y(n) is
proportional to the input x(n) 0 2
Times varying as x(n) is multiplied not by 1 1
a constant but by a function of n. h[k]
Stable as bounded input, x(n) gives
bounded output , y(n) :
|s ( π )| ≤ and |y | ≤ |x | +1
0 2
Not invertible as several inputs: k (n) ,
where k is any arbitrary integer, give the
same output equal to zero. 1
The system is Linear, stable and
non – invertible
(It is also Time – varying).
2. [Ans. D]
y ∑ x
3. [Ans. D]
y
h(t) = u t u t
y
For the system to be stable ,
y
y
∫ t t
y
y For the above condition, h(t) should be as
y shown below.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 230
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
t
∑ s v syst m s t st
u t u t
9. [Ans. D]
t
s s
s s
Therefore y(s) = X(s).H(s)
Graph for s
s s s
s s s
taking inverse
w t
y t u t u t
h(t) ∫ x c s
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 231
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
x
y t ∫c s {x x x } { c um v ct r }
x
{x x x } { c um v ct r }
∫ ∫ c s Designing the matrix using same
sequence
su u st
x x x
syst m s t stable.
x x
11. [Ans. A] x x x
[ x x x ]
( ) u
Now circular convolutions given by
x x x
c
c
g(1) [ ]
c
g(0)
c
Now circular convolution of c with
it self
c
y ∑ c
c c [ ]0 1
c c
1[- k] c
Taking transpose both side
1 c
1/2
c
0 1 0 1 c [ ]
c c c
1/4
c
k Let
0 1 0 1 P S
c c
y ∑
Take DFT both side
y
P S 0 1 0 1
c c
c c
y ∑
P S
y
h[1 – k] will be zero for k > 1 and g[k] will
13. [Ans. *] Range 0.19 to 0.21
be zero for k<0 as it is causal sequence. f
s c t r ct ( )
| |
g [1] = 0 ∫ s c t t
12. [Ans. A] f
∫ |r ct ( )| f P rs v st r m
Matrix method | |
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 232
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
f
tr ( ) z
z
r
f
r (∫ tr ( ) f)
∑ ∑s
f
∫ tr ( ) f
| |
17. [Ans. A]
t s t u t
s
14. [Ans. *] Range 44 to 46 S : Syst m s st
f r ≤t≤ c us t s ut y t r
t , t
t rw s
S : s p t ftm
t u t u t t t
s * + s p t ftm
s s s
y s s s S : A non-causal system with same
transfer function is stable
s u t (a non-causal system)
r st y st t utput m sy s
but this is not absolutely integrable thus
m unstable
s Only S and S are TRUE
c s t f rm f % s pp y ‘ ’
Hospital Rule? 18. [Ans. D]
m
x t t y t
y t x t t c v ut
15. [Ans. *] Range 9.9 to 10.1 f x f f
f r ≤ ≤ f f
x ,
t rw s y t x t
x z z z z z
Convolution in time domain is 19. [Ans. B]
multiplication z domain
z x z x z s
s s s s
f rf y ,we have to find For a stable causal LTI systems, all system
coefficient of z fy z poles should lie on LHP of s-plane.
S t s So to make H(s) causal, we need to cancel
out the pole at s = 2
16. [Ans. A] So, s s
y y x
y z y z z x z
y z
x z z
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 233
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
For x t t
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 234
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
s t ∫ t t
s t t
∫ t t
|
Thus z t is zero outside
t by property of
f r t convolution
s t u t
16. [Ans. B]
13. [Ans. A]
s
X(s) = s s s
s s s | |
√
t | |
√
Z(s) = taking partial fraction
z t u t 17. [Ans. B]
t u t
14. [Ans. C] s
Since it is a stable system all poles should s
lie in the left half of s-plane y s
|S| s ± This implies one pole lie s s
in RHS y s s s
x s
s s s
s
s
s
s
s
t u t
18. [Ans. C]
10 kHz even symmetric square wave have
frequency component present
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 236
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Fig. 4
x(t) = 1 t t
y t t * t t * t
using the properties of convolution:
s t * t t
( )( )( ) t * t t
( )( )( )( ) y t t t
( )( ) The resultant of the triangles in Fig. 3 is
( )( )
shown in Fig. 4
su st tut s
w t| | c st t
2. [Ans. D]
y(n) =x(n 3) represents a time delay
IN
system with delay = 3 secs.
1. [Ans. D]
It is a Time invariant system as can be
y(t) = x(t) * h(t)
confirmed from the following Test.
x(t) and h(t) are shown in Fig. 1 and Fig.2
Test for time – invariance:
x(t)
If y1(n) = y(n-n0), then the system is time
1
invariant
1
1 rt v syst m x y x -3)
1
x y
Fig. 1 x x
From (1) y x
h(t)
1
y
0 4 t
2
3. [Ans. A]
z z z z
Fig. 2
z z z z
y
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 237
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
4. [Ans. D]
x t T/F y t
Given,
Transfer function t
√
And input x(t) = sint
t
√ √
y t s t
√
5. [Ans. C]
Given x (t) = t≥
t
x t f
r pr p rty:
∫ f f ∫ x t |
π
6. [Ans. C]
t tu t ⁄p u t
s ⁄s s
s
y s s s
y t * + ut
7. [Ans. A]
For a system to be non-causal its impulse
response h(n) should depends upon
future value of n and if h(n) is
independent of the past value it never
means that system is non-causal
And it is the equation of LPF with cutoff
frequency
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 238
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
of ∫ ( ) s (B) ⁄ (D)
(A) 5 (C) 16π
(B) 10π (D) 5+j10π ECE- 2014
8. For a function g(t), it is given that
ECE - 2008
∫ t t for any real
3. The signal x(t) is described by
f r ≤t≤ value if
x(t) =, .
t rw s y(t) = ∫ t ∫ y t t s
Two of the angular frequencies at which (A) 0 (C) ⁄
its Fourier transform becomes zero are (B) – (D) ⁄
(A) π π (C) 0, π
(B) π π (D) π π 9. Consider a discrete time periodic signal
ECE - 2009 x[n] = s ( ) Let be the complex
4. The Fourier series of a real periodic Fourier series coefficients of x[n]. The
function has only coefficients { } are non-zero when
P. cosine terms if it is even k = Bm ± 1, where m is any integer. The
Q. sine terms if it is even value of B is ______.
R. cosine terms if it odd
S. sine terms if it is odd 10. A Fourier transform pair is given by
Which of the above statement are
( ) u ⇔
correct? ( )
(A) P and S (C) Q and S
Where u[n] denotes the unit step
(B) P and R (D) Q and R
sequence. The values of A is _______.
ECE - 2011
5. The trigonometric Fourier series of an EE- 2006
even function does not have the 1. x(t) is a real valued function of a real
(A) dc term variable with period T. Its trigonometric
(B) cosine terms Fourier Series expansion contains no
(C) sine terms terms of frequency = 2π (2k) / T;
(D) odd harmonic terms
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 239
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE- 2010
(C)
7. x t is a positive rectangular pulse from
t t t with unit height as
shown in the figure. The value of
∫ | | { where is the Fourier
(D)
transform of x t } is
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 240
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 241
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
14. A function f(t) is shown in the figure. 2. If the waveform, shown in the following
f t figure, corresponds to the second
derivative of a given function f(t), then
/
the Fourier transform of f(t) is
/ f t
/ t t
1
/
t
1 +1
The Fourier transform f f t is
2
(A) real and even function of .
(B) real and odd function of . (A) 1 + sin (C)
(C) imaginary and odd function of . (B) 1 + cos
(D)
(D) imaginary and even function of .
IN- 2011
∑ y qu s 9. Consider a periodic signal x(t) as shown
below
(A) ⁄ (C) ⁄
x(t)
(B) ⁄ (D) 3
1
IN- 2010
8. f(x), shown in the adjoining figure is
represented by
f x ∑{ c s x s x }
The value of is
f x
π π π π π x
(A) 0 (C) π
(B) π⁄ (D) π
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 243
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE 6. [Ans. C]
1. [Ans. A] c s s
x t
s
x [ (t )] ( ) c s
s c * +
2. [Ans. B]
( ) s c s c
∫ f Now r ct ( ) ⃡ s c( )
t
s c( )⃡ r ct ( )
∫ ( )
t
ys c ⃡ r ct ( )
| | [ ]
π π π y t { t }
t { t t }
3. [Ans. A] t t
{r c ( ) r ct ( )}
∫x t t
1
∫ t | ½
-3 -1 +1 3
s
( )
7. [Ans. D]
The concept of matched filter assumes
that the input signal is of the same form
g(t) as the transmitted signal(except
difference in amplitude ). This requires
that the shape of the transmitted signal
± not change on reflection.
π π h(t) = g( t ⇔ f (f)
G f f f sr
4. [Ans. A ] g(t) = (fourier transform)
P & S are correct
y t
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 244
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
( ) u ↔ -1
Fig . 1
( ) u ↔ Fundamental frequency = π/
= π/
( ) u ( ) x t x (t ) shown in Fig. 2
possesses Even symmetry and also half
↔ ( ) wave symmetry.
Fundamental Fourier term of
s ( ) x t c st ( t)
Where M = peak to peak value of
EE x t
1. [Ans. C]
Since trigonometric fourier series has no
sine terms and has only cosine terms
therefore this will be an even signal i.e. it
will satisfy
x(t) =x( t)
or we can write
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 245
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
x1(t) 4. [Ans. C]
1 x t r ct t ⁄
x t ≤t≤
t = 0 otherwise
0
1 x t ∫x t t
Fig. 2
As x(t)= x (t ⁄ ) ∫ t ( )
Fundamental component of
⁄ ⁄
π * +x ⁄
x t c s [ (t )]
π
π π w r x t ≤t≤
c s* t +
π 0, otherwise
3. [Ans. B] x t ∫x t t
Highest frequency of the input signal,
fh = 1kHz as shown in its spectrum of
( )
Fig. 1
| | r| f | ( )
M ⁄ ⁄ ⁄
[ ]
⁄ ⁄
⁄
0 1 * +
f(in kHz)
Fig. 1 s ⁄ ⁄
x t
⁄
Sampling interval , ms f z
x t x t
f f . Therefore Aliasing or overlap of
s ⁄ ⁄ ⁄
the adjacent spectra in the sampled [ ]
⁄
spectrum because f f .
s ⁄
The sampled spectrum , c s ⁄
⁄
U* f f ∑ f f
as shown in Fig. 2. s c( )c s( )
π
The resultant spectrum, U* is
c st t f r ‘f’ s s w w c 5. [Ans. B]
is the same figure given in option(b) y t x t t x t t
| |
Since y(t) is periodic with period T.
fs Therefore x t t x t t will also
M
be periodic with period T.
f
0
Fig. 3 is fourier series coefficient of signal
| | | f |
x(t) therefore
f
[ ]
f(in kHz) c s t
-2 -1 0 1 2 3 s c f r
Fig. 2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 246
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
i.e. t
∫[ ∫ ]x t t
w r ± ± ±
t π/
π
t π ∫[ ∫ { } ]x t t
π π
6. [Ans. C] π ∫x t x t t
I. A periodic signal x(t) has always
infinite energy
π ∫ |x t | t
∫ |x t | t
7. [Ans. D]
t
0
∫| | ∫
Fig. 1
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 247
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Fig. 2 y s ( ) s
s ( )s
11. [Ans. C]
Fourier series exists for periodic waves.
Since it is a square wave, convergence 16. [Ans. B]
occurs at most points x t v fu ct sr
y t (x t ) t f ur r tr sf rm
12. [Ans. B] t
y
Since F( ) is FT of f(t) hence
y m ry
∫ u u f t t
IN
f t ff t s v
1. [Ans. A]
t is proportional to f(t) if f(t) is even.
t
13. [Ans. A] Given ,
Poles of the system are the roots of the
equation |S |
r * + Use the F.T. pairs:
t
* + putt
u t
s
S * + * +
s If t replaced by ( t), is replaced by
s (
* +
s
|S | s s u t
P s ±
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 248
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
u t u t
So, y t t/
|| ||
5. [Ans. C]
||
In general, K Given x(n) = ( ) u
||
t t y x
2. [Ans. C] ∑ y ∑ ( ) u
From the given plot,
t t t
∑ ( )
Take F.T on both sides
Use the following pairs and properties: rst t rm
Let f(t) t mm r t
f t
t 6. [Ans. A]
t t {x t t }
{ x t t }
c s t
c s | | | || |
c s 7. [Ans. C]
The fourier transform of
3. [Ans. A] u t s s >0
f z; f z f z
f u t will exist
u m t fr qu cy f x t f0=0.2
If
Hz (HCF of are the frequency)
a<0
f f rm c f f
harmonic
8. [Ans. A]
The given function f(x) is periodic
4. [Ans. D]
function with period, T = π
| | F(x) is shown over one period from 0 to
| | π in Fig.
The d.c value of f(x) = ∫ f x x
r u rf x
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 249
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
f(x)
1.5
1.0
x
0
-1.0
-1.5
Fig.
9. [Ans. B]
Clearly, period of the signal x(t) is 3.
So, T = 3
And ∫ x t t
∫x t t
10. [Ans. A]
Given 6 point DFT of x[n] with
y symm try pr p rt s
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 250
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Z-Transform
ECE - 2010
ECE - 2007
6. Consider the z-transform
2. The z-transform x[z] of a sequence x[n] is
z z z ; |z| . The
given by x[z] = . It is given that the
inverse z-transform x[n] is
region of convergence of x[z] includes the (A) 5
unit circle. The value of x[0] is (B) 5
(A) 0.5 (C) 0.25 (C) 5 u u u
(B) 0 (D) 0.5 (D) 5 u u u
3. The samples x [n] (n = 0, 1, 2, ...) are given Which one of the following statements is
by valid?
(A) 5 (1 – ) (C) 5 (1 – ) (A) Both S1 and S2 are true
(B) 5 (D) 5 (B) Both S2 and S3 are true
(C) Both S1 and S3 are true
4. The expression and the region of (D) S1, S2 and S3 are all true
convergence of the z-transform of the
sampled signal are ECE - 2011
8. Two systems z and z are connected
(A) , |z| < e-5
in cascade as shown below. The overall
(B) , | z | < e-0.05 output y(n) is the same as the input x(n)
(C) , | z | > e-0.05 with a one unit delay. The transfer function
- -
of the second system z is
(D) , |z| > e-5
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 251
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
=∑ z
( ) z
z | |
x y (C) y [ n ] y (z)=∑ z
(D) y [ n ] y (z)= z + z +1
EE - 2007
IN - 2011
1. The discrete – time signal
2. Consider the difference equation
x[n] X (Z) = ∑ z ,
y[n] y x and suppose that
Where denotes a transform – pair
relationship, is orthogonal to the signal x[n] = ( ) u . Assuming the condition of
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 252
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE r| z | r |z|
1. [Ans. D] z
z
ROC {x x } {x x }(if there z
are no pole-zero cancellation)
5. [Ans. A]
2. [Ans. B] Recall the z – transform pairs:
ROC is |z| For the Right sided sequence:
x 0.5 u x u |z| | |
For Left sided sequence:
3. [Ans. B] u |z| | |
z
s . / ( ) u |z|
s z
z
( ) |z|
s z
For x(n) containing both the above
s s
terms the ROC is the overlapping region:
t
Therefore samples |z|
⁄
6. [Ans. A]
For the given X(z) , note that the ROC is
4. [Ans. C] the entire z – plane except
z z
z ∑ z
Recall the z – transform pair:
Recall the time shifting property:
∑ z If g(n) G(z)
z z
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 253
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
z 8. [Ans. B]
For given X(z) , y x
x(n)=5 Taking z – transform of both sides
z z z
7. [Ans. C] z
z
z
Given : H(z)=
For cascaded system
Express H(z) in +ve powers of z and find z z z
the zeros and poles. z
z z
z( z) z (z ) z
z z z
(z z ) (z ) (z ) z
z
Poles are at z = ¼ and z = ½ lying inside
the unit circle in the z – plane. 9. [Ans. C]
| |
Consi r t t r p ss ’s: x ( ) ( ) u
(i)|z|
x x s y
For a casual system h(n) =0, n< 0 and
h(n) is a Right sided sequence and ROC is x ∑ x z
the region outside the circle passing
| |
through the right most pole z = ½
∑ x ( ) z
syst m s us
For stability of LTI system unit circle
should be inside the ROC ∑ x ( ) z
syst m s st S sv st t m t
(ii)|z|
∑ x ( ) z
H(n) is a Left sided sequence and the
system is not causal.
t s t c us : ∑ x ( z) ∑ ( z )
f r ≥
As unit circle is not inside the ROC , the , z ( z) -
system is unstable.
S s t – valid statement.
,( z ) ( z ) -
(iii) |z|
The ROC is the annular region between s
two circles bounded by the poles: | z| | z |
At z z
|z| |z| | |
H(n) is a two sided signal existing for
sw sf r ≥ Syst m s
x ( ) u
not causal. As unit circle is not inside the
ROC , the system is unstable. x
S s v st t m t
t S S r tru S s t tru
s| z |
r|z|
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 254
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 255
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
z | z | |z|
u | |
( ) 2. [Ans. B]
z
|z| | | y y x
z
z z
u |z| | | z
z z z
3. [Ans. A] r put x ( ) u
(1 z z has ROC as entire Z-plane
z
which implies that it is polynomial. z |z|
(z )
z s p
z
z z z
4. [Ans. B] ( z ) (z )
z
z
z ( ) (z )
z z
z z
z 1
z ( ) (z )
z
z
z z ( ) (z )
z z z
z z z
z z
x z z z y * ( ) ( ) +u
x { }
x x
3. [Ans. C]
For a system to be stable, it should
IN
contain Z=1 circle in its ROC
1. [Ans. A]
Given, r ( )
x[n] = u
x z ∑ x z
4. [Ans. C]
∑ u z ∑ z Only this option gives poles inside unit
circle.
∑( )
z z
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 256
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Laplace Transform
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 257
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE - 2010 EE - 2012
Common Data for Questions 2 and 3 5. Consider the differential equation
Given f t and t as shown below: y t y t
y t t
f(t) t t
y
wt y t | |
t
1
um r c v u f |
t (A) 2 (C) 0
0 1 (B) 1 (D) 1
g(t)
IN - 2006
1 1. Given, x t x t t xp t u t
the function x(t) is
t (A) xp t u t
0 3 5
(B) xp t u t
2. t can be expressed as (C) t xp t u t
(A) t f t (D) xp t u t
(B) t f( )
IN - 2010
(C) t f( t )
2. u(t) represents the unit step function. The
(D) t f( ) Laplace transform of u(t- is
(A) (C)
3. The Laplace transform of t is
(B) (D)
(A)
(B) IN - 2013
(C) 3. The discrete-time transfer function
(D) is
(A) Non minimum phase and unstable.
EE - 2011 (B) Minimum phase and unstable.
4. Let the Laplace transform of a function (C) Minimum phase and stable.
f(t) which exists for t > 0 be s and the (D) Non-minimum phase and stable.
Laplace transform of its delayed version
f t be s . Let (s) be the complex IN - 2014
conjugate of s with the Laplace 4. The transfer function of a system is given
v r s t s s . If by
/
G(s) = , then the inverse Laplace s
| | s
transform of G(s) is The input to the system is ( )=sin100 t .
(A) mpu s t In periodic steady state the output of the
(B) y mpu s t– system s f u t y t s πt
(C) an ideal step function u(t) ). The phase angle ( ) in degree is
(D) an ideal delayed step function u(t– ___________.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 258
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE s s s
r
1. [Ans. C] s s s s s
s s} v t tx t u t
s
sF(s) has poles ± , which lie on the s
s
imaginary axis. s
s
v u t r mc t pp s s s
For the given F(s) , f(t) = s t u t
≤f ≤ s s
Hence the final value can be taken as :
≤f ≤ s s
Taking inverse Laplace transform on both
2. [Ans. D] side
poles of S.Y(s) lie on right half of S- y t u t
plane)
s = 1 is right s – plane pole 6. [Ans. B]
Unbounded. s
s f t
s s
Initial value
3. [Ans. A]
s
For the given LTI system mf t ms s s
s s
H(s) =
s ( )
The frequency response is given by mf t
s ( )
t
4. [Ans. B]
7. [Ans. B]
s x t u t u t
0∫ f 1
s
x s
With zero initial condition. s s
Now taking Laplace transform
5. [Ans. B] s y s sy s y s
s
y t y t x t
y t x t
t t t y s
Taking Laplace transform on both side s s s
(assuming zero initial conditions). y s
s s s s s s s s s s
s
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 259
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
t t
t f( ) f( )
s s s
Time shifting (delay by 2)
1
EE
1. [Ans. B]
t
0 1 2 3 4 5
y t ∫x t t
Fig. 3
if we take x(t) as casual input
ut
3. [Ans. C]
x t u t
Form Fig. 3 in the above question,
g(t) = u(t 3) u(t 5)
y t ∫ u t t
Use L.T pair and property:
u t
∫ t s
u t t
s
* + f t s
s s
s
* + f r t s u
4. [Ans. B]
f t t → s
2. [Ans. D]
f t t → s s
Time scaling (Expansion by 2) and Time
s s s
shifting by 3 get g(t) from f(t) s
| s | | s |
f(t) , f(t/2) and g(t) = f ( ) are shown s s | s | ,
fig. 1,2 and 3 G(s)
f(t) t t )
The inverse LT of G(s) is a unit ideal
1
impulse delayed by .
t
0 1 5. [Ans. D]
Fig.1 + y t t
Time scaling (expansion by 2) Converting to s – domain,
s2y(s) – sy(0) – y (0) + 2[sy(s) – y(0)] +
f(t/2) y(s) = 1
[s2 + 2s + 1] y (s) + 2s + 4 = 1
1
y(s) =
t find inverse lapalce transform
0 1 2
y(t) [– 2 e–t te–t] u(t)
Fig. 2 = 2e–t + te–t – e–t
| =2–1=1
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 260
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN
1. [Ans. A]
Given,
x t x t t xp t u t
taking Laplace transform on both sides
we get,
s s
s
s
Taking inverse Laplace transform of X(s)
is
x t xp t u t
2. [Ans. C]
Laplace transform of u(t) =1/s
Use Time shifting property:
If the L.T of f(t) is F(s),
Then L.T of x(t) = f(t s s s
f u t- s
3. [Ans. D]
Transfer function is
Clearly all the zeros are on the RHS of
imaginary axis so the system is non-
minimum phase.
Also, the poles z = 0.5 is inside the unity
circle thus the system is stable.
4. [Ans. *]Range 67 to 69
P s
s
t ( ) t
c s
t π
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 261
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE - 2009
10. The 4 –point discrete Fourier transform
1 0 1 x (DFT) of a discrete time sequence
{ 1, 0 ,2, 3} is
The corresponding cumulative (A) [ 0 , 2 +2j , 2 , 2 2j]
distribution function (CDF) has the form (B) [2, 2 +2j , 6,2, 2j]
(A) CDF (C) [ 6 , 1 3j , 2 , 1 + 3j]
1
(D) [ 6 , 1 +3j , 0 , 1 3j]
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 263
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
∑x ≤ ≤
The ratio of the power in the 7th √
harmonic to the power in the 5th Denote this relation as DFT(x). For
harmonic for this waveform is closest in , which one of the following
value to _______. sequences satisfies DFT (DFT (x)) = x ?
(A) x = [1 2 3 4]
23. Let z pz (B) x = [1 2 3 2]
z qz (C) x = [1 3 2 2]
z z r z . The quantities p, (D) x = [1 2 2 3]
q, r are real numbers.
|r| EE - 2006
Consider P q . If the
1. A discrete real all pass system has a pole
zero of H(z) lies on the unit circle then
at z = 2 300 it, therefore
r = _____
(A) also has a pole at 300
24. For an all-pass system (B) has a constant phase response over
the z-plane: arg| z | = constant
z w r | ( )| for
(C) is stable only, if it is anticausal
all . (D) Has a constant phase response over
If m , then b equals the unit circle: arg| | =
(A) (C) /
constant
(B) (D) /
EE - 2007
25. A modulated signal is
Statement for Linked Answer Questions 2
y t m t c s πt where the
& 3:
baseband signal m(t) has frequency
2. A signal is processed by a causal filter
components less than 5 kHz only. The
with transfer function G(s). For a
minimum required rate (in kHz) at which
distortion free output signal waveform,
y(t) should be sampled to recover m(t) is
G(s) must
_____
(A) Provide zero phase shift for all
frequency
26. A causal LTI system has zero initial
(B) Provide constant phase shift for all
conditions and impulse response h(t). Its
frequency
input x(t) and output y(t) are related
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 265
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(C) Provide linear phase shift that is filter with a cut-off frequency of 20 Hz.
proportional to frequency The resultant system of filters will
(D) Provide a phase shift that is function as
inversely proportional to frequency (A) An all-pass filter
(B) An all-stop filter
3. G(z) = z + z is a low-pass digital (C) A band stop (band-reject) filter
filter with a phase characteristics same as (D) A band-pass filter
that of the above question if
(A) (C) (1/3) EE - 2014
(B) / 7. A sinusoid x(t) of unknown frequency is
(D)
sampled by an impulse train of period 20
4. Consider the discrete-time system shown ms. The resulting sample train is next
in the figure where the impulse response applied to an ideal lowpass filter with a
of G(z) is g[0] = 0, g[1] = g[2] = 1, cutoff at 25 Hz. The filter output is seen to
be a sinusoid of frequency 20 Hz. This
+ means that x(t) has a frequency of
Σ G(z)
+ (A) 10 Hz (C) 30 Hz
(B) 60 Hz (D) 90 Hz
K
IN - 2006
The system is stable for range of values of 1. A digital filter has the transfer function
K
(A) [ 1, ½] (C) [ 1/2, 1] H(z) = If this filter has to reject a
(B) [ 1, 1] (D) [ 1/2, 2] 50 Hz interference from the input, then
the sampling frequency for the input
EE - 2008 signal should be
5. A signal x (t) = sinc( t) where is a real (A) 50 Hz (C) 150 Hz
constant (s c x ) is the input (B) 100 Hz (D) 200 Hz
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 266
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 267
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE
1. [Ans. B]
m(f)
f
500 500
= m(t) in time domain.
500 500
3. [Ans. C]
m f f
Autocorrelation function is an even
function
4. [Ans. B]
500
PSD is always a positive quantity
20kH 500 20kHz
z pass filtering with f
After low z
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 268
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
5. [Ans. C] 9. [Ans. A]
h(t) = u t H(s) = P P x xp |x| xp |x|
∫P x x
6. [Ans. D]
| | | |
Input x(t) = 2cos(2t) r ∫{ } x
Frequency response
π
r∫ x
Output r
π r
π π
10. [Ans. D]
x t t x t 4-point DFT of sequence {1,0,2,3} is given
π as
π [ ][ ]
{ }
{
}
π [ ] [ ]
11. [Ans. A]
c s t s t h[2] =1 and h[3]= 1
h [n] = { }
√
[ c s t s t] h[n] is high pass filter & FIR filter.
√ √
c s t π 12. [Ans. B]
√
c s t π PSD of white noise
/ z
7. [Ans. A] PSD of output
f | f | f
8. [Ans. A] | f |
P f x t u t tu t utput s p w r
t u t
∫ f f
x ∫f x x
17. [Ans. B]
For 8-points DFT;
x x x x x x and
13. [Ans. B] it is conjugate symmetric about x[4]
PS x x
18. [Ans. C]
= FT t tu t ⁄p u t
s ⁄s s
s c fu ct s
y s s s
14. [Ans. C] y t * + ut
s s c s c s
19. [Ans. A]
s t [c⏟ s πt c s
⏟ πt ] t s t c s t
s [ π⁄ ]
Maximum frequency in s t is 600Hz
( s t )
SO, are rational
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 270
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
When all the zeros are outside the unit 24. [Ans. B]
circle Maximum phase z
z
When some zeros are inside unit circle z
some outside unit circle mixed r f z sz z
phase
Poles of H(z) is z z
22. [Ans. *] Range 0.50 to 0.52 r p ss syst m w w
Consider one period from t t r
p
t s c
x
t t t 25. [Ans. *] Range 9.5 to 10.5
t
u t s
y t m t c s πt
c s π to recover m(t) minimum required rate
c s π should be twice the minimum frequency of
π m(t)
P w r f m rm c | | f f z
c s π
| |
π 26. [Ans. *] Range 0.99 to 1.01
| | y y
S y t x t
| | t t
y y
* y t + x t
23. [Ans. *] Range t t
z s
z (P ) s
Pz z s s s
z t
z (q ) t ∫ t t
qz t
z
z z r z s
z rz s s s s
s
z z s s
s * +
z rz z z* r z + s
s s
(z ) (z ) (z ) (z )
s s s s
One zero is at origin. The other zero lies at So number of poles G(s) = 1
z
r 27. [Ans. B]
Since, this zero lies on unit circle |z|
x [ ]
z r √
r
z r
r [ ] x
S c v |r| r √
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 271
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
z z
z
[ ] x [ ] x z z
z
r z
z z
Now check for each Options
S t syst m w st f t’s ut r
EE most pole will lie inside the unit circle.
1. [Ans. C] Location of poles
For causal system, if all poles are inside ±√
z
the unit circle then system is stable, and
converse is true for anti-causal system. √
2
2
r √
√
2. [Ans. C]
sc t s s t sf y pt
For distortion free output phase shift must
(A)
be linear function of frequency i.e.
proportional to frequency this is because 5. [Ans. A]
delay to all frequency component will be x(t) = sinc( t s π t
equal. h(t) =s t s π t
x(t) = s π t
3. [Ans. A]
1/
For distortion free output phase shift must
be linear function of as will as all the
frequency component must be amplified
𝜔
by same amount so z π π
corresponds to frequency . While
z corresponds to frequency 3 . h(t)= s π t
In order to have same amplification of 1/
frequency component at ,
4. [Ans. A] 𝜔 π
π
Given
g(1) =g(2) =1. Otherwise 0 y(t) = h(t) * x(t)
i.e. g[n] =
therefore 1/
G(z) = z z if
Therefore overall transfer function of
y
closed loop system
π π
z
z
z
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 272
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1/ 7. [Ans. C]
if Sinusoid x(t) frequency say f .Hz
s mp fr qu cy
Or Y(j𝜔
π π
z utput z
f
So y(t) = s π t f z u t frqu cy tr s t
y(t) = s c t f
IN
or y(t) = s c t f
1. [Ans. A]
So output is of the form k sinc( t In order to reject the 50 Hz interference,
Where m sampling frequency must be as low as the
noise frequency (so that they are
6. [Ans. D] separated in time domain and has less
The frequency response, f of LPF with interference)
cutoff frequency, 30 Hz is shown in Fig. 1. So, f z
The frequency response f of HPF with
cutoff frequency, 20 Hz is shown in Fig. 2 2. [Ans. B]
If these two filters are cascaded, the Let X(f) be the spectrum of the
overall frequency response of the bandlimited signal, x(t). let Xs(f) be the
resultant system H(f) = H1(f) H2(f), shown spectrum of the sampled signal xs(t)
in Fig. 3, represents a BPF with
Bandwidth, B = 10 Hz f f ∑ f f
H1(f)
Where fs is the sampling frequency i.e.,
X(f) is repeated at
±f ± f ± f tc
From the given spectrum of Xs(f) in the
0 10 20 30 40 f
question, fs = 250 s/sec
Fig. 1 S mp t rv
H2(f) Ts= ms=4ms
3. [Ans. B]
Since output y depends on input, such as
f no delay, delay by 1 unit, delay by 2 unit,
30 20 0 20 30
delay by 4 unit, so it will sum all the
sample after 4Ts (maximum delay), to get
Fig. 2 one sample of y[n].
H(f)
t ms c
4. [Ans. C]
x(t) band limited to FHz
f i.e., fm = FHz
30 20 0 20 30
y(t) = x(0.5t) + x(t) –x(2t) is
x(t) – maximum frequency = z
Fig. 3
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 273
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
5. [Ans. A] for ≤ ≤
Given y(n) = x(n) – y where M is the number of points filter
y here,
Now,
y y x
Take z – transform:
z [ z ] z
H(z) =
∑
6. [Ans. B]
z z
( )
c s s
| ( )| √ c s s 9. [Ans. B]
√ c s Given H(z) =
√ s This T.F corresponds to a 3rd order digital
| ( )| s ≤ ≤ π filter
so, | ( )| , if π D F – I realization requires 2N delays
w r D F – II realization or canonic realization
π with minimum number of delay elements
π f r
requires N delays.
f z Where N is the order of the order of the
filter
7. [Ans. A] – I requires 6 delays
z z z z D F – II requires 3 delays
Let, z z z
then,
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 274
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
10. [Ans. B]
z [z z z z z
The discrete time system with rational
transfer function , H(z) is stable if the ]
poles of H(z) lie inside the unit circle in
z ⌊z z z ⌋
the z – plane.
z z
r z ts v rs / z t
z
stable , both the poles and zeros of H(z)
must lie inside the unit circle in the z –
plane.
As the impulse response, h(n) = Inverse
Z.T of H(z) has only finite duration =7
11. [Ans. B]
samples, the given digital filter is an FIR
Highest frequency component in x(t) is
filter.
150 Hz. So, the Nyquist sampling rate is
300 Hz.
13. [Ans. B]
But, x(t) is sampled at 100 Hz. While
Given that
cos(100 πt) with frequency 50 Hz will be
recovered satisfactorily after passing ( ) [ ]
through the low – pass and sin(300πt) will c s s
get aliased resulting in filter output sin
(100 πt). | ( )| √ c s s
Cos (100 πt s ’t c tribute to aliasing.
√ c s c s s
12. [Ans. D]
√ c s c s( )
From the given pole – zero plot of the
digital filter, the system function cut ff | |
( )( ) √ √
z π π
c s r
[ z (z ) z ] z √
z πr ⁄s mp z
[(z z ) z ] π π
r ⁄s mp z
π
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 275
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
s
1/s
1 1 1/s
u
(A) 0 (C)
(B)
(D)
The set of equations that correspond to
this signal flow graph is ECE - 2014
x x 3. For the following system,
(s)
(A) (x ) = [ ] (x ) +
x x
s (s)
u s
[ ] .u / (s)
x x
(B) (x ) = [ ] (x ) + w n (s)
x x ( )
t tr ns r un t on ( )
s
u
[ ] .u / s s
( ) ( )
s s(s )
x x s
x x ( ) ( )
(C) ( ) = [ ]( ) + s s(s )
x x
u 4. Consider the following block diagram in
[ ] .u /
the figure.
x x (s) (s)
(D) [x ] = [ ] (x ) +
x x
u
[ ] .u /
(s)
tr ns r un t on s
(s)
(A) (C)
(B) (D)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 276
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE - 2007 EE - 2010
1. The system shown in figure below. 3. As shown in the figure, a negative
feedback system has an amplifier of gain
b0 c0 b1 C1 100 with 10% tolerance in the forward
Σ Σ path, and an attenuator of value 9/100 in
the feedback path. The overall system
Σ Σ 1/s Σ Σ1/s p
gain is approximately:
a a
1
0
With EE - 2014
(A) X = s , 4. The closed-loop transfer function of a
Y= ⁄(s system is (s) The steady
s ) s ( )
(D) X s , s s
(s) (s)
⁄(s s ) s
EE - 2008
2. A function y(t) satisfies the following Assuming n ,
() the input-output transfer function
differential equation, + y(t) = (t),
( )
where (t) is the delta function. (s) of the system is given by
( )
Assuming zero initial condition and s
( ) (s)
denoting the unit step function by u(t), s s
y(t) can be of the form s
( ) (s)
(A) (C) u(t) s s
(B) (D) u(t) s
( ) (s)
s s
s
( ) (s)
s s
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 277
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
s R 1 1 1 C
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 278
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE 2. [Ans. B]
1. [Ans. D] (s)
(s) (s)
s
x
u x
(s)
x
u
x
(s) (s) [ ]
s s
o (s) (s) (s)
x x x u (s) (s)
x x x u (s)
s s
x x x (s)
x x r or
u (s) s
x
[ ] [ x
][ ] [ ] 0u 1
x x
3. [Ans. D]
One can denote any state by any name When x (s)
So, that answer is (s)
(s)
x x
u s
[x ] = [ ] (x ) + [ ] .u /
x x s
s
y(s) s
x (s) s(s )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 279
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
s s s
s s s
(s) (s) s s
All the loops touch forward paths
( )
(s) (s)
s s s s
s ng M son’s g n ormul
(s)
(s) s
(s) (s)
(s)
(s) s ( )s ( )
(s)
(s) ( s) (s s )
(s) ()
(s) ( s) (s s )
(s)
EE Σ
1. [Ans. D]
(s) xy
Σ s Σ s (s) yz
(s) s
Comparing eg. (I) and (ii), we get
s
xy
s s
s
Signal flow graph of the block – diagram yz
s s
Hence option (D) is correct
s s 2. [Ans. D]
( )
Take LT on both sides,
( )
s.Y(s)+Y(s) =1 Y(s) = ( )
y(t) = u(t)
There are forward paths
3. [Ans. A]
T.F = =10
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 280
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Also, 6. [Ans. B]
(s) M M . /
( )
s s (s) s
. /
s
(s) ( ) 2. [Ans. C]
(s) In this case, open loop gain sensitivity is
( )
. / measured with respect to KG. Because
here open loop gain = KG
s
s s
s ( ) ( )( )
( )
s s
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 281
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
6. [Ans. D]
( )( ) ( s ount)
s n (s)
t n (s)
os (s)
( )( )
( )
( or l rg )
For analytical region there should be no
s poles
( ) ≠
s ( ) os sn os sn ≠
( )
os ≠
( n )
≠
So close loop transfer function is sensitive
to perturbation in H(s) but not to
7. [Ans. A]
perturbation in G(s) for large k values.
u(s) s s y(s)
3. [Ans. A]
forward path =
. /;
( ) |
( ) ( )
= ( ) ( )
( ) Loop =
4. [Ans. C]
(s)
=1 ( )
( )
8. [Ans. A]
( ) Writing the given open loop transfer in
( ) form of
5. [Ans. A] g t
The transfer function of a Zero-order- . /. /. /
Hold system having a sampling interval T So, at low frequencies, the approximate
is ( ) model equivalent to original transfer
function will
( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 282
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE - 2007
4. The frequency response of a linear, time-
invariant system is given by H(f)= (D)
. The step response of the system is j
(A) 5 (1 )u(t) (C) (1 )u(t)
(B) 5 (1 )u(t) (D) (1 )u(t)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 283
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
y(t) p r m t r ‘p’ s
(A) √ (C) 1
√
(B) (D)
1 √
t
ECE - 2011
12. The differential equation
y x(t) describes a
system with an input x(t) and an output
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 284
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
t
15. The natural frequency of an undamped
(B) second-order system is 40 rad/s. If the
system is damped with a damping ratio
y(t) 0.3, the damped natural frequency in
rad/s is ________.
s
ECE - 2012
13. A system with transfer function 18. For the second order closed-loop system
(s )(s ) shown in the figure, the natural frequency
(s)
(s )(s )(s ) (in rad/s) is
is excited y s n( t). The steady-state (s)
(s)
output of the system is zero at s(s )
(A) r s (C) r s
(B) r s (D) r s
ECE - 2014
(A) 16 (C) 2
14. For the following feedback system
(B) 4 (D) 1
(s) . The 2%-settling time of
( )( )
the step response is required to be less EE - 2007
than 2 seconds. 1. Consider the feedback control system
shown below which is subjected to a unit
step input. The system is stable and has
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 285
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
0.5
0.25
0
0 1 2 3 4
Time
+ +
y
+ 1
r(t) 1
S(S+1) + y(t)
0.8
7. If the disturbance is measurable, its effect on
the output can be minimized significantly
using a feedforward controller (s) To
t eliminate the component of the output due to
(A) 0.25 (C) 1 (t) s n t ( ) Should be
(B) 0.8 (D) 4 (A) (C) √
√
(D) √
(B)
√
Statement for Linked Answer Questions 4
&5
8. Let (s) ontroll r I (t) s n t
A unity feedback system has open loop
the amplitude of the frequency component of
transfer function G(s) = .The time
( ) y(t) due to d(t) is
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 287
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN - 2011
(A) √ (C) √
11. The unit-step response of a negative unity
feedback system with the open-loop
(B) √ (D) √
transfer function G(s) = is
IN - 2010 (A) (C)
9. A unity feedback system has an open loop (B)
(D)
transfer function (s) .The value
( )
of k that yields a damping ratio of 0.5 for ECE/EE/IN - 2013
the closed loop system is 12. Assuming zero initial condition, the
(A) 1 (C) 5 response y(t) of the system given below
(B) 3 (D) 9 to a unit step input u(t) is
(A) 0 (C) 1
(B) 0.5 (D) 2
ECE (s )
1. [Ans. A] s
y(t) x(t) (t) s
(s) (s) (s)
utput
s s
( ) ( )u(t)
s √
When t = at steady state
√ output = 1
x(t) s n(t)u(t)
3. [Ans. B]
y(t) s n .t /
√ ,st p r spons -
* +
s
2. [Ans. C]
(t)
s
(s)
s
4. [Ans. B]
(s)
s ()
output (s) (s)
(s )s
( )
s .s / s
s(s ) s s
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 288
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
t p r spons
s .s / s s
(t) ( )u(t)
(s ) s Which is also the required impulse
s .s / s s response of the system.
w ns
When s = 8. [Ans. D]
Comparing the given transfer functions
⁄
with
(s) y(t) , -u(t)
s s
s ξ s
5. [Ans. D] ln ξ
s
In dominant pole concept the factor that Therefore P is undamped
has to be eliminated should be in time
constant form s s
ξ
(s )(s s )
s ov r mp
. / (s s )
s s
s s ξ
s rt lly mp
6. [Ans. C]
ov rs oot p n s on ξ s s s
√
M ξ
r ξ os
s un r mp
Where is the angle made by pole from
negative real axis.
9. [Ans. A]
To make M same, should be the same.
10. [Ans. B]
7. [Ans. C] Steady state value = -2
Transfer functions Denominator
(s )
(s) ξ
(s )(s )
Input (s) ξ
s
Output, (s) (s) (s)
underdamped
v n l m s (s)
s (s ) 11. [Ans. B]
or l m
(s )(s ) (s)
t
√
or 1= P=
√ √
(s )
(s)
(s )(s )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 289
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
12. [Ans. A] ( s)
y y (s )(s )
y x(t)
t t (s+1)(s+2)+0.15+5s=0
Taking Laplace Transform of both sides s s s
s (s) s (s) (s) (s) s
(s) pt on (s) (s )
(s) s s ( s ) o (s) (s)
(s )
ol s r ts
(s )(s )
As poles are on the right hand side of s- (s )(s ) (s )
plane so given system is unstable system. s s
Only option (A) represents unstable s
system. Hence Option C is correct
pt on ( )
s
s
o (s) (s)
(s )(s )(s ) (s)
(s) (s)
s s s (s) (s)
s (s) (s) (s) (s)
(s) (s)
pt on (s) ( ) (s) * +
s (s) (s)
o (s) (s)
(s)
(s) (s)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 290
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(s)
s s
(s)
s s 2. [Ans. C]
r (s) m
s
s s
l m s (s) l ms
s s s
+ i
18. [Ans. C]
r ns r un t on
s s ∫ t
t
or or r un t syst m
Taking Laplace transform
s ξ (s) ( s ) I(s)
s
(s)
I(s)
s
EE
1. [Ans. A] ∫ t
Step input (s) s
s (s) (s)
(s) I(s) * +
s s s
(s)
(s)
(s)
(s)
s ξ s t (s)
s s
(s)
(s) .s s /
(s) ( )( ) Characteristic eq.
s s ξ s
n (s) s s
(s) (s) (s)
Comparing with
(s) (s) (s) (s)
s s
(s) (s) (s)
(s)
(s) [ ] √
(s)
(s) (s)
(s) * +
(s) (s)
√
(s) √
(s) (s)
s (s)
Steady state value of Z
√
t s (s)
√
s Overshoot
t
⁄
. /. / √
= 0.163 or 16.3%
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 291
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
3. [Ans. C] 5. [Ans. C]
M(s)
√ s s
Comparing with standard form
√ M(s)
r s s ξ s
Setting time (t ) ξ
ms ξ
6. [Ans. D]
t y st t v lu o r spons
T Input is unit step
So steady state error
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 292
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
8. [Ans. A] Given
R(s) C(s) ,
+ G(s) +
4. [Ans. B]
(s)
( )
n t
√
s (s)
| ⁄
(s)
x(t) ,u(t) u(t )- 5. [Ans. B]
x(s) [ ] , -
s s s
( )
s |
s (s) 6. [Ans. A]
( ) ( )
( ) . /. / ( ) ( )
( )
IN
m ( )
1. [Ans. D] s
m ( )
(s) s
s ( ) ( )
( ) t n ( ) 7. [Ans. D]
Phase lag t n ( ) Output due to
It satisfy , r s - d(t)= (t) (t) (s)
( )
(t) [ ]
2. [Ans. B] s(s )
or n (s) ( )
s nt * +
(s) ( )
s ( ) ( )
or r(t) u(t)
os t on l rror onst nt
√ ⁄
t (s)
8. [Ans. B]
y(s) (s) , (s) (s) y(s)-
OR ( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 293
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
9. [Ans. D]
T(s) =
( )
= √ and = or
√
or K = 9.
10. [Ans. B]
(s)
s(s )
For unit Ramp input, r(t) t u(t)
lo ty rror onst nt
t (s)
11. [Ans. D]
(s)
(s) s
The unit step response is given by
(s)
s(s ) s s
(t) ( ) u(t)
12. [Ans. B]
H(s)
u(s) Y(s)
⁄
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 294
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE - 2007
Which of the following statements is true? 1. The system shown in the figure is
(A) The closed loop system in never U1 + s
st l or ny v lu o Σ s
(B) or som pos t v v lu s o t
closed loop system is stable, but not
U2
for all positive values s
Σ +
(C) For all positive v lu s o t los
(A) stable
loop system is stable
(B) unstable
(D) The closed loop system is stable for
(C) conditionally stable
ll v lu s o ot pos t v n
(D) stable for input u1, but unstable for
negative
input u2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 295
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
2. If the loop gain K of a negative feedback (C) unstable and of the minimum phase
system having a loop transfer function type
( ) (D) unstable and of the non-minimum
to be adjusted to induce a sustained
( )
phase type
oscillation then
(A) The frequency of this oscillation
6. The frequency response of the linear
must be ⁄ rad/s. system ( ) is provided in the tabular
√
(B) The frequency of this oscillation form below.
must be 4rad/s ( ) ( )
(C) The frequency of this oscillation 1.3
must be 4 or ⁄ rad/s 1.2
√ 1.0
(D) Such a K does not exist
0.8
0.5
EE - 2008
0.3
3. Figure shows a feedback system where
The gain margin and phase margin of the
K > 0. The range of K for which the
system are
system is stable will be given by
+ (A) n
Σ s(s )(s ) (B) n
(C) n
(A) 0 < K < 30 (C) 0 < K < 390 (D) n
(B) 0 < K <39 (D) K > 390
EE - 2014
EE - 2009 7. In the formation of Routh-Hurwitz array
4. The first two rows of Routh's tabulation for a polynomial, all the elements of a row
of a third order equation are as follows. have zero values. This premature
s3 2 2 termination of the array indicates the
s2 4 4. presence of
This means there are (A) only one root at the origin
(A) two roots at s= ± j and one root in (B) imaginary roots
right half s-plane (C) only positive real roots
(B) two roots at s = ± j2 and one root in (D) only negative real roots
left half s-plane
(C) two roots at s= ± j2 and one root in 8. For the given system, it is desired that the
right half s-plane system be stable. The minimum value of
(D) two roots at s = ± j and one root in for this condition is __________
(s) (s)
left half s-plane (s )
s ( )s ( )s ( )
EE - 2011
5. An open loop system represented by the
( )
transfer function G(s) = ( )(
is 9. A system wth the open loop transfer
)
(A) stable and of the minimum phase function
type (s)
(B) stable and of the non-minimum s(s )(s s )
phase type
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 296
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
not the system is stable from the values of k for which the closed loop
information given system will remain stable is:
(A) 1 <k <3 (C) 5 < k <
IN - 2006 (B) 0 < k < 10 (D) 0 < k <
1. The range of the controller gains (Kp, Ki)
that makes the closed loop control system IN - 2011
(shown in the following figure) stable is 4. rst two rows o out ’s t l o
given as third-order characteristic equation are
(s) (s) s 3 3
s (s )(s ) s 4 4
It can be inferred that the system has
Ki (A) one real pole in the right-half of s-
(A) Ki < 0 and Kp < 20
12 plane
K (B) a pair of complex conjugate poles in
(B) Ki < 0 and Kp i 20
12 the right-half of s-plane
(C) Ki 0 and Kp 0 (C) a pair of real poles symmetrically
Ki placed around s = 0
(D) Ki 0 and Kp 20 (D) a pair of complex conjugate poles on
12
the imaginary axis of the s-plane
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 297
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
3. [Ans. C]
losed loop gain is
( )
(s) s s s
Characteristic equation X X
(s) s ( )s
Calculation of break point
los loop system is stable only for
r or or ll pos t v o
(s )(s )
the closed loop system is stable.
(s )(s )
4. [Ans. C] s
s
Perform Routh analysis to the polynomial
in denominator of G(S). (s)
s 1 3 5 , -
s 2 6 3
s (∈) 7. [Ans. *] Range 1.9 to 2.1
For (s) to remain stable, the poles of
s ( ) 3 (s) should lie in LHP of s-plane
s 1 2–P
( )
s 3+P
. / s 2–P
( )
o m x mum v lu o s
3
Number of sign changes =2
EE
5. [Ans. A] 1. [Ans. D]
Characteristic equation is 1+G(S)H(S)= 0 u ( ) s y ( )
( ) s
1+
s s + s (k + 2) + (k + 1) = 0
1 k+2
a k+2 s
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 298
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
( ) 5. [Ans. B]
(s )
( ⁄ ) ( ) For G(s), poles are at 2 and 3 Stable
(s )
( ) ( ) Also, zeroes are to the right of S-plane
Pole is in LHS of s-plane, Hence stable. non-minimum phase type
u ( ) y ( )
6. [Ans. A]
s
At gain across over frequency ( ),
magnitude of ( ) is 1.
| ( )|
s
Phase of ( ) ( )
s
Phase of margin = ( )
( ⁄ ) ( )
( ) ( )
At phase cross frequency ( )p s o
s ( )s ( )
(s )(s ) M m gn tu o ( ) t
Hence unstable as it has pole at right | ( )|
hand side of S-plane Gain margin= log
2. [Ans. B] log
( )
T(s) =
( )
7. [Ans. B]
s 1 64+3k It is a special case under R-H stability
criteria. Imaginary roots are calculated
s using auxiliary polynomial
√
& k < 390 (for stability)
4. [Ans. D]
s s s
(s )(s ) S=
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 299
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
s 12
√ √
s ( )
√
M n mum v lu
9. [Ans. 5]
Characteristic equation
n
s(s )(s s )
(s s)(s s )
s s s s s s
s s s s 2. [Ans. C]
s(s )
s 1 6 k s s
s 4 4 0 √
√
s 5 K
s √ or √
s 1
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 300
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE - 2007 ( )
(A) (s) (s)
( )( )
1. A unity feedback control system has an ( )
open-loop transfer function (B) (s) (s)
( )( )
(s) . The gain K for which (C) (s) (s)
( ) ( )( )( )
s= 1+j1 will lie on the root locus of this (D) (s) (s)
( )
( ) )
system is
(A) 4 (C) 6.5
ECE - 2014
(B) 5.5 (D) 10
4. Consider the feedback system shown in
the figure. The Nyquist plot of G(s) is also
ECE - 2009
shown. Which one of the following
2. The feedback configuration and the pole-
conclusions is correct?
zero locations of G(s) = are shown
(s)
below. The root locus for negative values
of k, i.e. for s
Im ( )
breakaway/break-in points and angle of
departure at pole P (with respect to the
positive real axis) equal to
+
+ k G(s)
( )
Im(s)
(A) G (s) is an all-pass filter
(B) G (s) is a strictly proper transfer
function
(C) G (s) is a stable and minimum-phase
Re(s) transfer function
P
(D) The closed-loop system is unstable
for sufficiently large and positive k
(A) ± √ and 00 (C) ± √ and 00
(B) ± √ and 450 (D) ± √ and 450 5. In the root locus plot shown in the figure,
the pole/zero marks and the arrows have
ECE - 2011 been removed. Which one of the following
3. The root locus plot for a system is given transfer functions has this root locus?
below. The open loop transfer function
corresponding to this plot is given by
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 301
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(C) j
(A)
( )( )( )
(B)
( )( )( )
(C)
( )( )( ) +1
2 1 +2
( )( )
(D)
( )( )
EE - 2010
( ) 2. The characteristic equation of a closed-
loop system is
s(s )(s ) (s ) .
Which of the following statements is true?
(A) Its roots are always real
The constant damping ratio line, for (B) It cannot have a breakaway point in
ξ nt rs ts t root lo us t po nt the range ,s- 0
The distance from the origin to point A is (C) Two of its roots tend to infinity along
given as 0.5. The value of K at point A the asymptotes Re, -
is__________ (D) It may have complex roots in the
right half plane.
EE - 2006
1. A Closed – loop system has the EE - 2011
characteristic function 3. The open loop transfer function G(s) of a
(s )(s ) + K (s ) = 0. Its root unity feedback control system is given as,
locus plot against K is . /
G(s) =
j𝛚 ( )
(A)
From the root locus, it can be inferred
that when k tends to positive infinity.
(A) three roots with nearly equal real
2 1 +1 +2
parts exist on the left half of the s-
plane
(B) j (B) one real root is found on the right
half of the s-plane
(C) the root loci cross the j axis for a
fin t v lu o ≠
2 +1 +2 (D) three real roots are found on the
right half of the s-plane
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 302
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(B) (D) ( )( )(
X ( )( )( ) )
X
IN - 2009
1.5+j1.5 5. A unity feedback system has the transfer
( )
X X X function ( )
. The value of b for which
8 4 0
the loci of all the three roots of the closed
loop characteristic equation meet at a
single point is
(A) 10/9 (C) 30/9
(A) 11.3 (C) 41.25 (B) 20/9 (D) 40/9
(B) 21.2 (D) 61.2
IN - 2011
IN - 2007 6. Consider the second-order system with
Statement for Linked Answer Questions 2
the characteristic equation
and 3 ) (s )
s(s . Based on the
A transfer function with unity DC gain has
properties of the root loci, it can be shown
three poles at and and no
that the complex portion of the root loci
finite zeros. A plant with this transfer
of the given system for is
function is connected with a proportional
described by a circle, and the two
breakaway points on the real axis are
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 303
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(A)
√ (C) √ IN - 2014
(D) √ 8. A loop transfer function is given by :
(B) √ (s )
(s) (s)
( )
IN - 2012 The point of intersection of the
7. The open loop transfer function of a unity asymptotes of G(s)H(s) on the real axis in
gain negative feedback control system is the s-plane is at ___________.
given by G(s) = ( )(
ngl t
)
which the root locus approaches the zeros
of the system, satisfies
(A) t n . /
(B) = t n . /
(C) = t n . /
(D) = t n . /
ECE
1. [Ans. D]
ro u t o p sor r wn rom op n loop pol s to t t po nt
pro u t o p sor r wn rom op n loop z ro to t t po nt
√ √ √
√
2. [Ans. B] 5. [Ans. B]
( )
√
( )
Angle of departure is
Where Σ z Σ z
3. [Ans. B]
From plot we can observe that one pole
terminates at one zero at position and
three poles terminates to . It means
there are four poles and 1 zero. Pole at There are 4 poles/zeros at
goes on both sides. It means there are two s = 1,
poles at There has to be one pole – zero pair at
both cannot be poles or zeros
4. [Ans. D] at the same time.
For larger values of K, it will encircle the So option A and D are crossed out
critical point ( ) which makes There are 2 asymptotes. So number of
closed-loop system unstable. poles is two more than number of zeros.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 304
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ntro po nt w r t symptot s m t
Angles of asymptotes
( )
( )
( ) or
( )
EE
2. [Ans. C]
1. [Ans. B]
Characteristic equation
Characteristic function )(s ) (s )
s(s
(s )(s ) (s ) (s )
(s )
(s) (s) s(s )(s )
(s )(s )
Comparing with 1 + G(s) H(s) = 0
Open loop transfer function
G(s)H(s) = open-loop transfer function
(s) (s)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 305
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(s )
( )
s(s )(s )
Number of zeros = Z = 1, zero at
Number of poles = P = 3
Poles at 0, &
Number of branches terminating at 2 ⁄ 0
infinity =
Angle of asymptotes
( )
So all these roots have nearly equal real
( ) parts on left half plane when
( ) 4. [Ans. C]
n
Σ pol s Σ z ros
ntr o
( )
X
Im g n ry
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 306
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
o
2. [Ans. B] s
With unity DC gain, poles at or
s n and no finite zeros s
(s )( s s) (s s )
l nt s s s s s s
(s )(s )(s )
s ( )s s
3. [Ans. C] ow s is not the breakaway point
( ) o s ( )s
T(s)= ( )( )( )
( ) For all the three root loci to meet at a
s s s ( ) single point, we need that this equation
s has equal roots.
s ( ) o( )
s ( )
( ) ( ) ( )
row has zero elements if 6k = 60 or ( )( )
k = 10 then 2 roots lie on the imaginary axis
given by s s √ . If k > 10, so or
the root at √ s t to o s pl n But b = 20 is not the required value of b
because it will cancel out an open-loop
4. [Ans. C] pole
( ) ( )
(s) o st r qu r v lu
( ) ( )
( ) ( ) ( )
=0
( )
6. [Ans. C]
s s ( )
S= K=
√ ( )
RL exists at 3.41 .( )( ) ( ) /
( )
( )
√
S= √
7. [Ans. D]
s
( ) (s)
s(s )(s )
(s ( ))(s ( ))
(s)
s(s )(s )
5. [Ans. B]
(s )
(s)
s (s )
For unity feedback, characteristic
equation is 1+ G(s) = 0
s s s
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 307
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
t nt ( )
[ t n ( )]
* [ t nt ( )]+
t n ( )
8. [Ans. ]
Int r s t on o symptot s
sum o pol s sum o z ros
num r o pol s num r o z ro
( ) ( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 308
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE - 2006
1. The open-loop transfer function of a G(s)
unity-gain feedback control system is
given by, G(s) = ( )(
. The gain
)
margin of the system in dB is given by
(A) 0 (C) 20
(B) 1 (D) 4. Which of the following statement is true?
(A) G(s) is an all-pass filter
2. Consider two transfer functions, (B) G(s) has a zero in the right-half plane
(s) and (s) . The (C) G(s) is the impedance of a passive
3-dB bandwidths of their frequency network
responses are, respectively (D) G(s) is marginally stable
(A) √ √
5. The gain and phase margins of G(s) for
(B) √ √
closed loop stability are
(C) √ √ (A) 6 dB and (C) 6 dB and
(D) √ √ (B) 3 dB and (D) 3 dB and
Re
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 309
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(C) (D)
(D)
EE - 2006
1/s 1/s 1/s 100
u y 1. Consider the following Nyquist plots of
loop transfer functions over = 0 to
= . Which of these plots represents a
7. The gain margin of the system under
stable closed loop system?
closed loop unity negative feedback is
(1) Im
(A) 0 dB (C) 26 dB
(B) 20 dB (D) 46 dB R
=
8. For the transfer function Re
( ) the corresponding Nyquist 1
plot for the positive frequency has the form
(A)
(2) Im
5 =
Re
(B)
(3) Im
j5
=
Re
(C) (4) Im
=
⁄ Re
1
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 310
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE - 2007 (A) Im
2. If x = Re G(j ), and y = Im G(j ) then for
, the Nyquist plot for 3/4
G(s) = 1 / s(s+1) (s+2) becomes
asymptotic to the line Re
(A) x = 0 (C) x = y
(B) x = (D) d = y / √
EE - 2009
3. The polar plot of an open loop stable 𝛚=0
system is shown below. The closed loop 𝛚=0 Im
system is (B)
Imaginary
Real
Re
3/4
EE - 2010
Re
5. The frequency response of
(s) ,s(s )(s )- plotted in the
complex ( ) plane (for ) is
𝛚=0
1/6
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 311
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE - 2011 IN - 2009
6. A two-loop position control system is 4. A unity feedback control loop with an
shown below. open transfer function of the form
( )
Motor
(s) (s) has a gain crossover frequency of 1 rad/s
s(s ) and a phase margin of . If an element
√
having a transfer function is inserted
s √
Tacho-generator into the loop, the phase margin will
The gain k of the Tacho-generator become
influences mainly the (A) (C)
(A) peak overshoot (B) (D)
(B) natural frequency of oscillation
(C) phase shift of the closed loop IN - 2011
transfer function at very low Common Data for Questions 5 and 6
frequencies ( ) The open-loop transfer function of a unity
(D) phase shift of the closed loop negative feedback control system is given
transfer function at very high by G(s) = ( )
frequencies ( ) 5. The value of K for the phase margin of the
system to be 45° is
IN - 2008 (A) 250√ (C) 125√
1. For the closed loop system shown below
(B) 250√ (D) 125√
to be stable, the value of time delay TD (in
seconds) should be less than
6. v lu o or t mp ng r t o to
be 0.5, corresponding to the dominant
(s) (s)
closed-loop complex conjugate pole pair
is
(A) 250 (C) 75
(A) ⁄ (C) ⁄
(B) 125 (D) 50
(B) ⁄ (D)
IN - 2012
Statement for Linked Answer Questions 2
7. The open loop transfer function of a unity
&3
negative feedback control system is given
Consider a unity feedback system with
by
open loop transfer function
G(s) = . The gain margin of the
G(s) = ( )(
( )( )
)
system is
2. The phase crossover frequency of the
(A) 10.8 dB (C) 34.1dB
system in radians per second is
(B) 22.3dB (D) 45.6dB
(A) 0.125 (C) 0.5
(B) 0.25 (D) 1
IN - 2014
8. The loop transfer function of a feedback
3. The gain margin of the system is
control system is given by
(A) 0.125 (C) 0.5
(B) 0.25 (D) 1 (s) (s)
s(s )( s )
Its phase crossover frequency (in rad/s),
approximated to two decimal places, is __.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 312
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE 6. [Ans. D]
1. [Ans. D] 𝐹or option (D).
( )
(s) ( )
(s )(s )
or g n m rg n s not tr ns r un t on o (s)
t n ( ) t n . /
7. [Ans. C]
t n ( ⁄ ) (s) (s)
s(s )
=0 t n ( )
For phase cross-over frequency,
o (s) [ ]
( ) ( )
M ( ) ( )
root locus will cut the = 0 axis only
M n log
when k
So gain margin = 0 1 8. [Ans. A]
( )
2. [Ans. C] =5
BW depends only on denominator and is So ( ) is a straight line parallel to
equal to √( ) axis.
3. [Ans. D] EE
At ( ) ( ) 1. [Ans. A]
Assuming no.of open loop poles in the
GM = 20 log | |
( ) ( ) RHS of s – plane = P = 0
Complete nyquist plots
4. [Ans. B] Im
5. [Ans. C]
At ( ) ( ) GM = 20
log | |
At ( ) ( )
PM =
No.of encirclements = N = 0
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 313
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
symptot to x = s
3. [Ans. D]
2 clockwise encirclement of 1 + j0
= 0; N = 2 =2
5. [Ans. A]
( )
( ) (
(( ) ) ) (( ) ( ))
As G( )
s ( ) -0 +
Option (A) satisfies above
Two clockwise encirclement of – 1
Hence N = 2
Z=2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 314
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
6. [Ans. A] 2. [Ans. C]
( )
( ) t n ( )
T(s) =
( )
( )
( ) t n ( ) t n ( )
( )
r s ξ
r s
M is dependent on K (A) is correct
is independent of K (B) is not
correct 3. [Ans. A]
( )
T(J ) = ( ) ( )
( )
( ) t n . /
t low r qu n s ( )≈
t g r qu n s ( )≈ 4. [Ans. A]
( ) n ( ) r p rt lly orr t M o (s)
( t n . /) √
IN
( √ )
1. [Ans. C] (s) =
( √ ) ( )
s
(s) y(s) PM of (s) = ( )
5. [Ans. B]
PM = 45°= 180° t n . /
t n . / rad/sec
(s) y(s) ( ) |( |
)
√
G(s) =
6. [Ans. A]
For system to be stable G(s) should lie in
the left of ( 1, 0) r t r st qu t on
(s )
For finding the critical/ marginal value s s s ( )
apply phase condition The dominant poles are given by
w w s s ( )
or (s) s s ( )
s
(s) | |
s
w w
So w or
√ √
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 315
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
G.M in dB = log 0 1
t n ( )
As t n
So =1
r s
r s
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 316
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
function is
( )
1. The value of 'a' so that the system has a
phase-margin equal to is approximately
equal to
(A) 2.40 (C) 0.84
(B) 1.40 (D) 0.74
(A) (C)
2. With the value of 'a' set for a phase-
(B) (D)
margin of the value of unit-impulse
response of the open-loop system at
ECE - 2014
second is equal to
5. The phase margin in degrees of
(A) 3.40 (C) 1.84
(B) 2.40 (D) 1.74 ( ) calculated using
( )( )( )
the asymptotic Bode plot is ________.
ECE - 2007
3. The asymptotic bode plot of a transfer 6. In a Bode magnitude plot, which one of
function is as shown in the figure. The the following slopes would be exhibited at
transfer function G(s) corresponds to this high frequencies by a 4th order all-pole
Bode plot is system
|G( )|(dB) (A) (C)
(B) (D)
60
20 dB/decade 7. The Bode asymptotic magnitude plot of a
minimum phase system is shown in the
40
figure.
40 dB/decade
20
2
0 0 ( )
0.1 1 10 100 ( )
60 dB/decade
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 317
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE - 2006 EE - 2008
1. The Bode magnitude plot of 2. The asymptotic Bode magnitude plot of a
H (j ) = (
( )
is minimum phase transfer function is
)( )
shown in the figure.
(A) ( )
( ) 40 dB/ decade
40 (dB)
20
20
20 dB/ decade
0.1 (r s)
0 +1 +3 Log ( ) (log scale)
+2 20
0 0 dB/ decade
20
0 +1 +2 +3 Log ( ) r s
0.1 2 5 25
( ) ( )
(A) ( )(
(C) ( )(
) )
( ) ( )
(B) ( )(
(D) ( )(
) )
( )
(D)
40 EE - 2014
4. The Bode magnitude plot of the transfer
20
( )( )
function (s) is shown
. /( ). /
0
+1 +2 +3 Log ( ) below:
Note that -6 dB/octave = -20 dB/decade.
The value of is_______
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 318
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN - 2008
2. The Bode asymptotic plot of a transfer
t v
function is given below. In the frequency
(r ⁄s ) range shown, the transfer function has
dB
5. For the transfer function
(s ) + 20dB / decade
( )
s(s )(s s ) 20dB / decade
IN - 2010
3. The asymptotic Bode magnitude plot of a
log
lead network with its pole and zero on the
left half of the s-plane is shown in the
The maximum phase angle and the adjoining figure. The frequency at which
corresponding gain respectively, are the phase angle of the network is
(A) 30° and 1.73dB maximum (in rad/s) is
(B) 30° and 4.77dB
(C) + 30° and 4.77dB
(D) + 30° and 1.73dB
IN - 2006
r s
1. A unity feedback system has the following
(log scale)
open loop frequency response:
(r s ) ( ) ( ) (A) (C)
√
2 7.5
(B) (D)
3 4.8 √
4 3.15
5 2.25 IN - 2013
6 1.7 4. The Bode plot of a transfer function G(s)
8 1 is shown in the figure below.
10 0.64
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 319
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
40 (A) (C)
32
(B) (D)
20
5. The discrete – time transfer function
0 is
1 10 (A) Non – minimum phase and unstable.
-8 100
(r s) (B) Minimum phase and unstable.
(C) Minimum phase and stable.
(D) Non – minimum phase and stable.
ECE 4. [Ans. A]
1. [Ans. C] . / ( )
G(s) =
| ( )| . / ( )
M ( )
w r ( ) t n ( ) 5. [Ans. *] Range 42 to 48
( )
M
t n ( )
√
√
= 0.84
2. [Ans. C]
( )
(s) g(t) u(t) t u(t)
( )
At t = 1, g(t) ( )( )( )
From the plot frequency at which gain is 0
3. [Ans. D] dB is r s
( )
(s)
s(s )( ) M
o plot s ( ) orm
6. [Ans. A]
r t’s typ syst m so
In a transfer function if all are poles if we
log | plot the BODE diagram, then an each and
every corner frequency we have to
| introduce a line of slope
K = 100 and hence on the 4th frequency the slope
of line will become – 80 dB/sec and will
continue upto infinity
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 320
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
5. [Ans. A]
(s )
(s)
s(s )(s s )
( s )
log
s( )( s) . /
log log
( )
log log
log log n m x mum r qu n y r s
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 321
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
6. [Ans. C] . /
(s)
( ) . /
has 2 poles and 1 zero
s
s 3. [Ans. B]
t n t n This condition is only for phase lead N/W
=√
√
( ) 4. [Ans. B]
( ) ( ) 32 dB
1 10
√
t n √ t n
√ to
Is 1 dec are change & change is (G) is
√ . /
√ √ 40dB
g n √
√ lop s
. /
√ r r pol s s or g n
g n log √ So, G(s)=
= 32 dB
IN
1. [Ans. D] (given) log . /|
M log
r =
log ( )
s M
= 3.88 dB
5. [Ans. D]
z
2. [Ans. C] (z)
Compare with Bode magnitude plot of z
For minimum phase system, all poles and
standard transfer function.
zeros must lie inside the unit circle. For
. / stable system, all poles must be inside the
( )
unit circle. For the system, zero is at 2
. /
pole is at 0.5. This system is stable but
non – minimum phase.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 322
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE - 2006
Z
1. The transfer function of a phase-lead
compensator is given by (s) -
+
where . The maximum phase-shift
provided by such a compensator is
(A) ⁄ (C) ⁄ Group I
(B) ⁄ (D) ⁄
ECE - 2007
2. A control system with PD controller is
shown in the figure. If the velocity error
constant Kv =1000 and the damping ratio
ξ t n t v lu s o p and KD are
+ s y
Group II
r Σ s(s )
1. PID controller
2. Lead compensator
3. Lag compensator
(A) Kp=100, KD=0.09 (A) Q – 1, R – 2 (C) Q – 2, R – 3
(B) Kp=100, KD=0.9 (B) Q – 1, R – 3 (D) Q – 3, R – 2
(C) Kp=10, KD=0.09
(D) Kp=10, KD=0.9 ECE - 2009
5. The magnitude plot of a rational transfer
3. The open-loop transfer function of a plant function G(s) with real coefficients is
shown below. Which of the following
is given as 0 (s) 1. If the plant is
compensators has such a magnitude plot?
operated in a unity feedback ( )
configuration, Then the lead compensator 20dB
that can stabilize this control system is
( ) ( )
(A) (C)
log
( ) ( )
(B) (D)
(A) Lead compensator
ECE - 2008 (B) Lag compensator
4. Group 1 gives two possible choices for the (C) PID compensator
impedance Z in the diagram. The circuit (D) Lead – lag Compensator
elements in Z satisfy the condition
ECE - 2010
R2C2 >R1C1. The transfer function
6. A unity negative feedback closed loop
represents a kind of controller. Match the system has a plant with the transfer
impedances in Group I with the types of function G(s) = and a controller
controllers in Group II.
(s) in the feed forward path. For a unit
step input, the transfer function of the
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 323
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
controller that gives minimum steady (D) A lag-lead compensator that provides
state error is an attenuation of 20 dB and phase
(A) (s) lead of 450 at the frequency of 3
rad/s
(B) (s)
( )( )
(C) (s) EE - 2008
( )( )
2. The transfer function of two
(D) (s) s
compensators are given below
(s ) s
ECE - 2012 (s ) (s )
Statement Linked answer Questions 7 and Which one of the following statements is
8 correct?
The transfer function of a compensator is (A) C1 is a lead compensator and C2 is a
given as lag compensator
(s) . (B) C1 is a lag compensator and C2 is a
lead compensator
7. Gc(s)is a lead compensator if (C) Both C1 and C2 are lead
(A) compensators
(B) (D) Both C1 and C2 are lag compensators
(C)
(D) IN - 2006
1. The transfer function of a position servo
8. The phase of the above lead compensator 1
is maximum at system is given as G (s) = . A first
s(s 1)
(A) √ r s (C) √ r s
order compensator is designed in a unity
(B) √ r s (D) √ r s
feedback configuration so that the poles
of the compensated system are placed at
EE - 2007
– 1 j1 and 4. The transfer function of
1. The system 900/s(s+1)(s+9) is to be
the compensated system is
compensated such that its gain-crossover ( )
(A) (C)
frequency becomes same as its ( )
( )
uncompensated phase-crossover frequ- (B) (D)
ency and provides a 450 phase margin. To
achieve this, one may use Common Data Questions 2, 3, 4
(A) A lag compensator that provides an The following figure describes the block
attenuation of 20 dB and a phase lag diagram of a closed loop process control
of 450 at the frequency of √ rad/s system. The unit of time is given in
(B) A lead compensator that provides an minute
amplification of 20dB and a phase ontroll r l nt stur n (s)
lead of 450 at the frequency of 3 m(s)
r(s) (s)
rad/s ( )
s
(s)
(C) A lag-lead compensator that provides
an amplification of 20 dB and a phase
lag of 450 at the frequency of √
rad/s.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 324
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 325
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE 4. [Ans. B]
1. [Ans. D]
M xp s s t (s)
t n t n s
From maximum phase shift s
s
t
( ) (t )
, ( ) - ( )
s
( ) (s) (s )(s )
(s) s
( )
The above equation is a PID controller
or
√ s
t n (√ ) t n
√ s
( ) ( )
2. [Ans. B] ( ) ( )
( ) The above equation is a lag compensator.
(s)
(s s ) ( )
m (s) (s)
( ) 5. [Ans. D]
m
(s ) ( ) plot shows presence of 2 poles &
2 zeroes in Bode equivalent plot
comparing Eq.(1) with standard 2nd
order equation 6. [Ans. D]
m
√
s
ξ m
S.E(s)= s for (D)
s ( ( ) ( ))
3. [Ans. A] 7. [Ans. A]
(s) t n t n
s (s )(s )
for phase lead should be positive
The lead compensator C(s) should first
stabilize the plant i.e. remove term t n t n
( )
(s )
(s) (s) Option (A) & (C) satisfies, it may be
(s )(s ) (s )
Only option (A) is satisfies. observed have be observed that option (C)
will have poles and zero in RHS of s – plane,
thus not possible (not a practical system)
it can be concluded that option (A) is right
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 326
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
⁄ t n t n is always negative
sl n s l g omp ns tor
IN
1. [Ans. C]
√ r s Let the T.F of the compensator be (s)
o t omp ns t syst m
( )
EE (s) (s) ( )
1. [Ans. D] ( )
(s) (s)
( )
|
s(s )(s ) (s)
s(s ) (s)
r s ol s o t omp ns t syst m r g v n s s
√ √ s
(s )
| ( ) ( )| | | t (s)
s(s )(s ) (s )
r t r st qu t on
s(s )(s ) (s )
,(s ) -(s )
s ( )s ( )s
. / (s s )(s )
s s s
. /
( )
M log
| ( ) ( )|
(s )
M log ( ) (s)
(s )
Negative GM implies that the system is
unstable. should become gain 2. [Ans. A]
cross over frequency, r s , v n
the magnitude should be 0dB. m(s) (s) { ( )}
o m t m gn tu ‘ ’ t s
r s a lag compensator which { (s) (s)}
s
gives an attenuation of 20dB(before
compensation the magnitude is 20dB)
m( ) * ( ) ∑ ( )+
and to obtain 45 phase margin at
r s a lead compensator with I(s)
a phase lead of 45 is used. s pl tr ns orm o (t) t
s
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 327
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
3. [Ans. B] s ( ) 0
The given diagram can be reduced as For stable system all elements of first
(s) (s) column should be greater than zero. By
(s)
substituting all the given options in
o nt o ’ w ll g v n g t v v lu
except option D.
s
( ) ( )
6. [Ans. C]
r ns r un t on (s) ( ) ( ) Open loop transfer function of a dc motor
as
( )
( )
( ) R(s) (s) (s)
( ) ( )
(s) (s)
( )
d(t)= sin 0.2t
or g tt ng mult ply ng tor
| | Topic: P controller with unity feed back
Formula: For first order system loop
| | ( )
√ ( ) transfer function is comparing
( )
( )
with . Now for
o mpl tu o output (t) ( )
n t l mpl tu closed loop overall transfer function is
given by
( ) . /
4. [Ans. B] ( ) . /
o
(s)
(s)
((s )( s ) )( s ) ( y omp r ng rom ormul )
In Question given that time constant of
closed loop system is times of
( )
( ) (( )( ) )( ) so
Characteristics equation is
s s ( )s . /
( )
For stability, according to R-H array
s 6 (6+3k2)
s 11 ( ) approximate value
s ( ) 0
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 328
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
7. [Ans. D]
y(s) (s) ( (s) y(s)) [ ]
s
y(s)
(s) (s) [ ]
s
(s) [ ]
s
(s) [ ]
Zero means at
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 329
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 330
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(A) (C)
ECE - 2013
(B) (D) Statement for Linked Answer Questions 10
and 11:
ECE - 2011 The state diagram of a system is shown
8. The block diagram of a system with one below. A system is described by the state
input and two outputs 𝑦 and 𝑦 is given – variable equations
below. ̇ u y u
1 1 1 1 1
u y
u y
s
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 331
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
u s s s EE - 2006
x x x 1. For a system with the transfer function
y
( )
H(s) = , the matrix A in the
state space form ẋ = Ax + Bu is equal to
The corresponding system is
(A) always controllable (A) [ ]
(B) always observable
(C) always stable
(B) [ ]
(D) always unstable
(B) ( )
(D) ( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 332
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(A) [ ] u
t
y
(B) 0 1
the matrices P, Q and R as follows:
(C) 0 1 0 1
(D) 0 1 0 1
, -
EE - 2010 The system has the following controllability
6. The system ̇ with and observability properties:
0 1 0 1 is (A) Controllable and observable
(B) Not controllable but observable
(A) stable and controllable
(C) Controllable but not observable
(B) stable but uncontrollable
(D) Not controllable and not observable
(C) unstable but controllable
(D) unstable and uncontrollable
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 333
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 334
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE 6. [Ans. B]
1. [Ans. A]
∅(t) = L *( I ) + ẋ
(s) ẋ s s (s)
( I ) 0 1
( I ) 0 1 x x
( )
ẋ
os t s nt
(t) = 0 1 ẋ x u… … ( )
s nt os t
ẋ x x … … ( )
2. [Ans. A] y (x ẋ )
s (s) (s) I (s) (x x x )
y x … … ( )
u From equation 1, 2, 3 the state variable
t
(s) (s) I (s) u(s) representation of the system is
(s )(s ) (s) (s) ẋ 0 1x 0 1u
u(s) 𝑦 , -
( )
( ) ( )
7. [Ans. C]
3. [Ans. A] ,sI -
∅ ∅ s
Let A = [ ] , -0 10 1
∅ ∅ s
s s
∅ ∅ ∅ ∅
& , -[ ]
∅ ∅ ∅ ∅ (s )
∅(t) 0 1 s s
s
(( I ) ) s s
(s )(s ) s & Method II
find eigen vector It can also be solved by applying the
M son’s g n ormul
4. [Ans. D]
From above, , I - 0 1 8. [Ans. B]
(s)
0 1 u(s) s
(s) x (s)
5. [Ans. C] x (s) u(s) s
p p x (s) y (s)
, - 0q q1
u(s) s x (s)
p q un ontroll l p, q Similarly
x (s) y (s)
u(s) s u(s)
so sx (s) x (s) u(s)
y (s) x (s)
sx (s) x (s) u(s)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 335
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
y (s) x (s)
ẋ (t) x (t) u(t) y (t) x (t) y
u
ẋ (t) x (t) u(t) y (t) x (t)
ẋ x
[ ] 0 1 0x 1 0 1 u(t)
ẋ From the graph we can find that
x x u ,u x - ( ) ẋ
rom qu st on y ,y y - , - 0 1 ẋ x u… ( )
n
ẋ ( ),x ẋ -
9. [Ans. D]
ẋ x ẋ
x x
From eq. (i) put value of ẋ
*x + = [ ] [x ] + [ ]u
ẋ x ( x u)
x x ẋ x x u…… ( )
x s m l rly y ẋ ( )
y=, - [x ] y x x u … ( )
x ẋ x ( x ) ( u)
[ ]
ẋ x ( x ) u
A=[ ]& B = [ ] In matrix form
ẋ x
[ ] 0 1 0x 1 0 1 u
ẋ
So, AB = [ ][ ] = [ ] x
ẋ 0 1 0x 1 0 1 u
And
=* + x
y , - 0x 1 u
So, the controllability matrix, h y , -x u
⌈ ⌉ =[ ] 11. [Ans. A]
s
10. [Ans. A] sI (s )
For state variable form, we have to find
[(s ) s ]
number of integral (1/s) in the graph
Take inverse Laplace transform both side
Assign output of these integral with state
variable & input of these integral with s
derivative of state variable. ,sI -
1. Then find out the relation between [(s ) s ]
these derivative in terms of state
0 1
variable and input t
2. Similarly we can write the relation
between output and these variable
and input using state flow graph
3. Lets assume & as state variable
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 336
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
12. [Ans. B]
…
[ ] [ ] 2 3
, -
[ 2 3]
Controllable matrix
0 1
, - [ ]
x (t) x ( )
Rank is less than 3, so uncontrollable x (t) x ( )
Observability matrix
o , ( ) - 15. [Ans. B]
Applying linearity property
[ ]
0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
n so o s rv l o
o x(t) 0 1 [ ]
13. [Ans. A]
From the state diagram, the state [ ]
equations are
̇
[ ̇ ][ ][ ] [ ] 16. [Ans. D]
̇ (t) ,( I ) -
, I - s
0 1
𝑦 , -[ ] s
s
0 1
The state controllable matrix is s s
, ̇ ̇ -
(t) [s s ]
* +
s
t
The rank of S is 3 0 1
So the system is always controllable
EE
14. [Ans. C] 1. [Ans. B]
ẋ x x ( ) (s) (s )
[ ] 0 1 0x 1 (s)
ẋ ⏟ x ( ) (s) s s s
( ) ( )
(t) (s ). /
( ) ( )
t t (s)
(I t … ) t
(s) s s s
2 3 s x (s) s x (s) sx (s) x (s)
t u(s)
0 1 0 1t 0 1
2 Replacing s by
t x x x
0 1 … x u(t) … ( )
3 t t t
x
t ẋ x
t
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 337
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
x s
ẋ x 0
1
t , s
- 0 1
Replacing eq.(i) (s )(s )
ẋ x x x u(t) (s )
, -0 1
s
ẋ x x x u(t)
(s )(s )
ẋ x s s
ẋ x (s )(s ) s s
ẋ x x x u(t)
ẋ x
5. [Ans. B]
[ẋ ] [ ] [x ] [ ] u(t)
ẋ x 0 1
s
o [ ] ( I ) 0 1
s
s (s )(s )
2. [Ans. D] ( I )
s [ s ]
(s) , - (0 1 )0 1
s ( )
3. [Ans. A] [s s s ]
m m ( ) s
s ( ( )) s ( )
0 1
4. [Ans. C]
Selecting x (t) and x (t) as state variables 6. [Ans. C]
x (t) , AB] | ≠ controllable
ẋ (t) x (t) x (t) u(t)
t (s) ( I ) & (t) ( (s )) has
x (t)
ẋ (t) x (t) u(t) exponential with positive power
t
ẋ (t) x (t) Unstable
[ ] 0 1[ ] 0 1 u(t)
ẋ (t) x (t)
ẋ 7. [Ans. A]
M , -
o 0 1 0 1
0 1
y(t) x (t)
x (t) t(M ) ≠ ontroll l
y(t) , -[ ]
x (t) M , - 0 1
y
t(M ) ot o s rv l
o , -&
, I - s
0 1 0 1 8. [Ans. A]
s
s Y(t) , - *, I - (s)+
0 1
s s
( I ) 0 1
s s
0 1
, I - s
(s )(s )
, I - [s ]
r ns r un t on
, I - s
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 338
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
s(s ) s
[, I - (s)]
[s(s )] [(s ) s ]
x (t) * I + 0 1
[ ] ,, I - (s)- t
x (t)
[ ] 12. [Ans. A]
y(s)
r ns r un t on (s)
x (t) (s)
Y(t) , -[ ]
x (t) ( I )
lm (s) l ms ( )
s s(s s )
10. [Ans. C] IN
v n 0 1 0 1 1. [Ans. C]
(s)
or ontroll l (sI )
(s)
, - 0 1
u(t) (t) → (s)
≠ ontroll l (s) (sI )
For observability:
y(t) s → (sI )
, - 0 1
ot o s rv l 2. [Ans. A]
(s) ( I )
11. [Ans. C] ( I ) [ ]
( )
0 1
( I ) 0 1
State transition matrix I ( )
s
I 0 1 (s) ., -0 1 0 1/
s ( )
s
0 1 -0 (s)
s ., 1/
I ( )
(s )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 339
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
3. [Ans. B]
The poles of the s/y are obtained from the
s/y matrix, f
det (SI – F )= 0
0 1
S(S + 2) + 4 = 0
4. [Ans. A]
T(s) = ( I )
, - 0 10 1
( )
( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 340
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Input
Output
~ i
(B)
(A) 6V
Input
(B) 6V Output
(C)
12V
(C) 12V
Input
Output
6V
(D)
(D)
6V Input
Output
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 341
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE - 2008
4. In the following limiter circuit, an input 6. The bias current through the diodes is
voltage = 10sin100 t is applied. (A) 1 mA (C) 1.5 mA
Assume that the diode drop is 0.7V when (B) 1.28 mA (D) 2 mA
it is forward biased. The Zener
breakdown voltage is 6.8V.The maximum 7. The ac output voltage is
and minimum values of the output (A)
voltage respectively are (B)
(C)
1k
(D)
D1
D2
8. A Zener diode, when used in voltage
6.8 V
Z
stabilization circuits, is biased in
(A) reverse bias region below the
(A) 6.1V, 0.7 V (C) 7.5 V, 0.7 V breakdown voltage
(B) 0.7 V, 7.5 V (D) 7.5 V, 7.5 V (B) reverse breakdown region
(C) forward bias region
ECE - 2009 (D) forward bias constant current mode
5. In the circuit below, the diode is ideal. The
voltage V is given by ECE - 2012
9. The diodes and capacitors in the circuit
shown are ideal. The voltage v(t) across
the diode is
ECE - 2011
Statements for Linked Answer Questions 6 (A) –1 (C) 1 –
and 7 (B) i (D) 1 – i
In the circuit shown below, assume that
the voltage drop across a forward biased
diode is 0.7V. The thermal voltage
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 342
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE/EE/IN - 2013
11. In the circuit shown below, the knee
current of the ideal Zener diode is 10 mA. (A) both and are ON
To maintain 5 V across RL, the minimum (B) is ON and is OFF
value of RL in and the minimum power (C) both and are OFF
rating of the Zener diode in mW, (D) is OFF and is ON
respectively , are
14. The diode in the circuit shown has
= 0.7 Volts but is ideal otherwise.
100
If = 5sin(𝜔𝑡)Volts, the minimum and
maximum values of (in Volts) are,
ILoad respectively,
10V
RL
VZ=5V
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 343
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
+ +
D1
D2
i
z ~ Vi
10V 5V
V0 RL =
(A)
16. Two silicon diodes, with a forward
voltage drop of 0.7 V, are used in the
circuit shown in the figure. The range of
10
input voltage for which the output
voltage is
10
(B)
(A) 5
(B)
(C)
(D) 5
EE - 2006 (C)
1. What are the states of the three ideal
diodes of the circuit shown in figure? 10
5 10
10V
5A
(D)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 344
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE - 2007 (B)
3. The three – terminal linear voltage
regula r i e e a l a
resistor as shown in the figure. If Vin is
10 V, what is the power dissipated in the
transistor?
+10V
(C)
RL
Vin
6.6V
Zener diode
(D)
(A) 0.6 W (C) 4.2 W
(B) 2.4 W (D) 5.4 W
EE - 2008
4. The equivalent circuits of a diode, during
forward biased and reverse biased
conditions, are shown in the figure.
0.7
+ + V
5. In the voltage doubler circuit shown in
he igure he wi h ‘S’ i l e a
+
Assuming diodes D1 and D2 to be ideal,
load resistance to be infinite and initial
capacitor voltages to be zero, the steady
state voltage across capacitors C1 and C2
will be
~ 𝜔𝑡
S
~ i
EE - 2009
6. The following circuit shown has a source
voltage Vs as shown in the graph. The
current through the circuit is also shown
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 345
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
10V 15V
15
10
(A) 4V (C) 7.5V
5 (B) 5V (D) 12.12V
Vs (Volts)
0
EE - 2011
-5 8. A clipper circuit is shown below.
-10 1k
-15
0 100 200 300 400
Time (ms) D
1.5 ~
1.0 5V
Current (mA)
0.5
a
4.3
a
a
(B)
10
EE - 2010 4.3
7. Assuming that the diodes in the given
circuit are ideal, the voltage is 4.3 10
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 346
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
5.7
1.7V
0.7
0.7 5.7
(A) (C)
(B) (D)
(D)
10 IN - 2011
2. Assuming zener diode has current-
voltage characteristics as shown below on
the right and forward voltage drop of
diode is 0.7 V, the voltage in the
10
circuit shown below is
EE - 2014
9. The sinusoidal ac source in the figure has
an rms value of . Considering all
√
possible values of , the minimum value
of in to avoid burnout of the Zener I
diode is __________
2.7V V
0.7V
√ ~
(A) 3.7 V (C) 2.2 V
(B) 2.7 V (D) 0 V
IN - 2008
1. In the circuit shown below, the ideality
factor of the diode is unity and the
voltage drop across it is 0.7V. The
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 347
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE
1. [Ans. B]
When , zener diode is in forward When
bias so
When , zener diode is in reverse
bias, so when , zener diode
will be OFF and .
When , zener diode will be in
breakdown region and .
4. [Ans. C]
When , is forward bias and
2. [Ans. C]
are OFF, and
Option – C, Circuit makes Full –wave
When is +10V, are ON and zener
rectifier.
diode is in reverse bias so
V
3. [Ans. C]
For zener 5. [Ans. A]
and When , diode is ON and V =
When , diode is OFF and V = 1 V
So V = min (
6. [Ans. A]
7. [Ans. B]
r
When , current
~ r
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 348
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
10. [Ans. D]
8. [Ans. B]
Zener diode operated in reverse in i
breakdown region.
i
r
Since diode will be forward biased voltage
across diode will be 0.7 V
i
Stabilized
~ 5v
40 mA
10 V
la per ea e i ier 10 mA
he ex i e y he la pi g
section clamp the positive peak to 0 volts
When zener starts
and negative peak to 2 volts. So whole
will be held @ 5V.
cos ( i l wer y 1 volts
pu i
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 349
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1k i
y
i
tz
1k
w X
When Z is relatively positive to y
Both D1& D2 are & l a When positive maximum
Gets shorted.
i
13. [Ans. D]
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 350
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
So current through
Current through 1k , mA
i
So mA
= 0.5893
Power dissipated in transistor
i i r hi
i 4. [Ans. A]
When diode is OFF, the equivalent circuit
is shown as follows:
i
i i r hi
i
EE
~
1. [Ans. A] i
Let is ON, OFF and OFF, then
equivalent circuit
5. [Ans. D]
In this case, 10A When , is ON and is OFF so
A charges upto 5V and .
So voltage across diode When , is ON and is OFF, so
charges by -10 V and
So is in reverse bias i.e. it is OFF. So in steady state,
Voltage across diode V it is and
also in Reverse bias so OFF.
Voltage across diode it is in 6. [Ans. A]
forward bias and ON. It is
2. [Ans. A]
When , and are OFF, so
When
, is ON and OFF so, mA, and diode conducts
, diode will be reverse bias
and I will become zero.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 351
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
10. [Ans. B]
S
S
i This is less than reverse breakdown
voltage of diode . So our
assumption is correct
i
3. [Ans. 10]
Diode goes to forward biased due to
10 V and 8V across diode and current
i through diode is
i
4. [Ans. *] Range 40 to 43
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 352
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Nodal at
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 353
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE - 2006
9.
1. An n- channel depletion MOSFET has
following two points on its curve:
(i) d
(ii)
Which of the following Q-points will give
the highest trans-conductance gain for
small signals.
(A)
(B) The value of current is approximately
(C) (A) 0.5 mA (C) 9.3 mA
(D) (B) 2 mA (D) 15 mA
ECE - 2011
ECE - 2007
5. For a BJT, the common – base current
2. The DC current gain ( ) of a BJT is 50.
g i α .98 d he c ec r b e
Assuming that the emitter injection
junction reverse bias saturation current
efficiency is 0.995, the base transport
. . This BJT is connected in the
factor is
common emitter mode and operated in
(A) 0.980 (C) 0.990
(B) 0.985 (D) 0.995 the active region with a base drive
current . The collector current
3. For the BJT circuit shown, assume that for this mode of operation is
the of the transistor is very large and (A) 0.98 mA (C) 1.0 mA
= 0.7 V. The mode of operation of the (B) 0.99 mA (D) 1.01 mA
BJT is
10 kΩ 6. In the circuit shown below, for the MOS
transistor, and the
threshold voltage . The voltage
at the source of the upper transistor is
2V 6V
1 kΩ
5V W/L = 4
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 354
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE - 2013 10. For the MOSFETs shown in the figure, the
7. In the circuit shown below, the silicon threshold voltage | | = 2 V and
npn transistor Q has a very high value of ( ) . . The value of
. The required value of R2 in k to
(in mA) is ______.
produce IC = 1mA is
VCC
3V
R1
IC
60 k
R2
RE
500
(A) 20 (C) 40
(B) 30 (D) 50 11. For the MOSFET shown in the figure,
assume W/L = 2, = 2.0 V,
8. In a MOSFET operating in the saturation
100 / and = 0.5 V. The
region, the channel length modulation
transistor switches from saturation
effect causes
region to linear region when (in Volts)
(A) an increase in the gate – source
is__________
capacitance
(B) a decrease in the transconductance
(C) a decrease in the unity –gain cutoff
frequency
(D) a decrease in the output resistance
ECE - 2014
9. For the n-channel MOS transistor shown
in the figure, the threshold voltage is
0.8 V. Neglect channel length modulation
EE - 2006
effects. When the drain voltage =1.6 V,
1. Consider the circuit shown in figure. If
the drain current was found to be 0.5
the of the transistor is 30 and ICBO is 20
mA. If is adjusted to be 2 V by changing
nA and the input voltage is + 5 V, then
the values of R and , the new value of
transistor would be operating in
(in mA) is
+12V
. Ω
Ω
Q
+5V
(A) 0 mA (C) 4.3 mA
(B) 3.6 mA (D) 5.7 mA
.
EE - 2010
5. The transistor circuit shown uses a silicon
transistor with = 0.7V, and a
dc current gain of 100. The value of is
+10 V
(A) d
(B) e er e d 10 k 50 k
(C) e er e d
(D) d e er e
EE - 2007
3. The common emitter forward current
g i f he r i r h w i F = 100. 100
+10V
Ω
(A) 4.65V (C) 6.3V
(B) 5V (D) 7.23V
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 356
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
I IN - 2006
I
1. The biasing circuit of a silicon transistor
(C) (D) is shown below. If = 80, then what is VCE
for the transistor?
V V +12V
EE - 2011
7. The transistor used in the circuit shown
RB Ω RC Ω
be w h f d is negligible.
15k 2.2k
8
1k D
= 0.7V
.
(A) 6.08 V (C) 1.2 V
(B) 0.2 V (D) 6.08 V
IN - 2007
2. In the circuit shown below, . .
If the forward voltage drop of diode is
0.7V, then the current through collector
will be
(A) 168 mA (C) 20.54 mA
(B) 108 mA (D) 5.36 mA
EE - 2014
8. The transistor in the given circuit should .
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 357
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
10 V IN - 2014
6. In the figure, transistors T and T have
Ω
2V identical characteristics. of
transistor T is 0.1 V. The voltage is
Ω high enough to put T in saturation.
Voltage of transistors T T and T is 0.7
V. The value of ( ) in V is ___________.
9
T
The voltage is
(A) 0.2 V (C) 7.4 V
(B) 2 V (D) 10 V
IN - 2010
4. The matched transistors and shown T T
in the adjoining figure have =100.
Assuming the base-emitter voltages to be
0.7V, the collector-emitter voltage V2 of
the transistor is
IN - 2013
5. In the transistor circuit as shown below,
the value of resistance RE in k is
approximately,
+10V
IC=2.0 mA
1.5k
15k .
. Vout
6k VCE=5.0 V
RE
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 358
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE 5. [Ans. D]
1. [Ans. D] α
From the below graph it is clear that α
.98
a increase conductance i.e. slope of 9
.98
graph is increased.
. .
6. [Ans. C]
The transistor which has
12mA and
6
So that transistor in saturation region.
V
The transistor which has
Transfer characteristic of n-channel D- Drain is connected to gate
MOSFET. So that transistor in saturation
3. [Ans. B]
Given is large so d 7. [Ans. C]
Assuming BJT is in active
Applying KVL in Base. Emitter loop
.
.
. 9.8
w .9
.
So BJT is in saturation ~
4. [Ans. B]
Assuming . d
.
=1mA i ce is very large
.
So, eg igib e
So,
= 2.04 mA 2 mA ge dr cr e i er f re i r
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 359
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
. . .
.
w r gi e circ i
r . .
r . . b i i g i
.
. .
. .8
. .
8. [Ans. D]
EE
9. [Ans. C] 1. [Ans. B]
ere Let the device is in saturation and
i r i regi . V
.
Collector current = 5.3mA
.
. . .8 .
For saturation = 0.178 mA
.
. Base voltage .
. current through 100 re i ce
.8 .
.
. .
. = 0.127 mA
.
c rre hr gh re i ce
.
10. [Ans. *] Range 0.88 to 0.92
= 0.29 mA
Base current . 9 .
= 0.163 mA
So this is less than it means device
is not in saturation. It is in active region.
2. [Ans. C]
When . he will be in
reverse active mode .i.e. Reverse on and
will be ON.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 360
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
8. [Ans. *] Range 22 to 23
9. To calculate max, take end condition
.
9 i .
.
. i
.9
i .
ci e
.
Ti i c i e regi .
.8
4. [Ans. B] .
.
IN
1. [Ans. B]
.
.
9
9
. and drop across diode = 0.7
. . So device is not active region.
.
Let the device is in saturation and
. V
i ery rge .
.9
As both transistors are perfectly matched .9
and . of both transistors. .
8
. mA .
6. [Ans. C]
When V will be + ve both transistor and
diode will be on making V across them
Zero and Current I will be flow and when
V is -ve both will be off offering infinite
resistance so current I will be Zero.
.
7. [Ans. D]
Transistor is in Saturation region
.
.
.
.
.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 361
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Apply KVL . 8
. For matched transistor
.
. di is same for both the
transistors)
Now apply KVL in the outer port of
transistor
9 . 8
9. .8
Apply KVL to output terminals
5. [Ans. A]
9. . 10 V
.9 . .8 2m A
. Ω V=IR=1.5k × 2mA=3V
15k
3. [Ans. C] =10-3=7V
10V gi e
2V
6k
gi e
. be
. 6. [Ans. *] Range 5.5 to 5.8
gi e
9
Now again apply KVL to the collector
resistor of the right and transistor
T
.
.
. .
. T T
.
4. [Ans. B] .
rre hr gh re i ce
.
.
i Apply KVL on path 1
9 .
. .
=1.66mA
.
.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 362
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
.
Tr i r ide ic
y h
. –
.
. .
.98 .
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 363
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 364
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(A) ( )= ( i )
(B) ( )= ( i )
(C) ( )= i
(D) ( )= i
ECE - 2010
8. The amplifier circuit shown below uses a
silicon transistor. The capacitors and (A) Ω (C) Ω
(B) Ω (D) Ω
can be assumed to be short at signal
frequency and the effect of output ECE - 2013
resistance can be ignored. If is 10. The small-signal resistance(i.e., dVB/dID)
disconnected from the circuit, which one in k offered by the n – channel MOSFET
of the following statements is TRUE? M shown in the figure below, at a bias
point of VB =2V is (device data for M:
device transconductance parameter
kn μnCox(W/L) 4 μ / , 2 threshold
voltage VTN=1V and neglect body effect
and channel length modulation effects)
VB
ID
~
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 365
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE - 2014
11. For the amplifier shown in the figure, the
BJT parameters are
and thermal voltage = 25 mV. The
voltage gain ( / ) of the amplifier is
_____ .
(A) g (C) g
(B) (D)
μF
μF
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 366
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(A) 1 (C) 20
(B) 10 (D) 100
IN - 2006
1. An amplifier circuit is shown below.
Assume that the transistor works in
active region. The low frequency small-
signal parameters for the transistor are
g = 20 mS, 0 = 50, =, =0. What
is the voltage gain, ( ) of the
amplifier?
+Vcc (A) 3.75 (C) 9
(B) 4.5 (D) 19
Ω
IN - 2009
Common Data Questions 4 and 5
Ω
Vi ~ The circuit shown in the figure uses three
identical transistors with = 0.7V and
Gi e : = = Ω
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 367
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Q3
R3
12V
= 6V
2. [Ans. B]
in increased by 10%, i.e.
By KVL,
4μ
i e ge
By KVL, in E – B loop,
e e e
3. [Ans. A]
6. [Ans. D]
4. [Ans. C] Voltage gain ( )( )
Both transistor carry same current and
u i e ge
both are in saturation
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 368
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
( ) e i
7. [Ans. B]
The e i e we f u u ge
is
h
h
( i ) For the calculation of gain we need to
calculate . so DC analysis is required
8. [Ans. A]
The moment is disconnected from the
circuit,
h ( h )
but with capacitor, h
which also reduces voltage gain
So, increases and decreases.
9. [Ans. C]
i = 1 + 0.1 cos ( )
Calculate = 3V
Solution:
whe e i he he ge
[ ] 44
e u e
4
10. [Ans. B]
μ
( )
L
μ
( )
L
i
μ ( )
L
( ) i
4
4
4 i ( )i
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 369
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
i
i μ
g e i
i i
i i
i e e
4 4
f he e e figu e
i i
( ) i i
( )i ( )
Now assuming that is very large, the
i ( ) ( )
collector current g flows through the
i
emitter terminal.
( ) i
g
g
4 4 4 4 g
g
So if g which is nearly
12. [Ans. *] Range 1.04 to 1.12
constant g
( )
( )
13. [Ans. B]
This is a common-collector configuration.
15. [Ans. *] Range 9.39 to 9.41
i i e ( )i eg i e can vary
u between 12V in the positive direction and
0V in the negative direction biased
around
So, positive excursion of output voltage =
`
4
Replacing the transistor with T –
Negative excursion of output voltage
equivalent model, we get
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 370
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
i i
i
i
~ 4
i
(i i ) i
i i
( )i i 4 ( )
i
( ( ) )
i
i i
2. [Ans. D]
i ( )i
g whe e
g
Small signal analysis of circuit
i g and Q point to be in
the middle of the load line
( ) i
~ g
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 371
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
~ Ω
Vi
w L he e e i e i ui
4. [Ans. A]
Emitter voltage of transistor,
g
L ① 10 V
i i (i g ) So
Where i i
i i i (i g i )
i (
) 5. [Ans. B]
i When output is taken between one
( )i collector and ground then
(i g )
g (i e i g e e g i )
i
i and if take the output between two
[ ] collectors then differential gain.
i
g
2. [Ans. C] collector resistance
For CB, current gain is close to unity while
g /
voltage gain is very high.
and here output is taken between one
3. [Ans. A]
collector and ground therefore gain
g
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 372
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE - 2010
Common Data for Questions 1 and 2 RD
Consider the common emitter amplifier 10 k C
shown below with the following circuit V0
parameters: Vi
M
g A/V, RL
, 10 k
and
(A) 8 (C) 50
(B) 32 (D) 200
ECE - 2014
ECE - 2013
3. The ac schematic of an NMOS common –
source stage is shown in the figure below, IN - 2011
where part of the biasing circuits has 1. The amplifier shown below has a voltage
been omitted for simplicity. For the n- gain of an input esistance of
channel MOSFET M, the transconductance and a lower 3-dB cut-off frequency of 20
gm =1mA/V, and body effect and channel Hz. Which one of the following statements
length modulation effect are to be is TRUE when the emitter resistance is
neglected. The lower cutoff frequency in doubled?
Hz of the circuit is approximately at
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 373
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
v ~
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 374
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
~ [ ]
IN
1. [Ans. A]
h
g The small signal model is
The resistance seen by the source
h
h
h
2. [Ans. B]
Lower cut-off frequency due to h
f
h h doubled Zi
increases
ou e ec eases
3. [Ans. A]
owe frequency decreases as
w increases
c
s inc eases
w ec eases
ec ease ec eases
f
f ≅8
p ifie
p ifie
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 375
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
2k𝛀
ECE - 2007 1nF
μH
2. In a transconductance amplifier, it is
desirable to have
(A) A large input resistance and a large
output resistance
(B) A large input resistance and a
2k𝛀
small output resistance 2.7V
(C) A small input resistance and a 2k𝛀
large output resistance ~
(D) A small input resistance and a
small output resistance
(A) Maximum (C) Unity
ECE - 2009 (B) Minimum (D) Zero
3. In the circuit shown below, the op-amp is
ECE - 2014
ideal the transistor has
5. In the ac equivalent circuit shown in the
figure, if is the input current and is
Decide whether the feedback in the
very large, the type of feedback is
circuit is positive or negative and
determine the voltage V at the output of
the op-amp
10V
V
+
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 376
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
10
(B)
10
5
~
(C)
(A) Voltage shunt feedback
(B) Current series feedback
(C) Current shunt feedback 5
(D) Voltage series feedback
10
7. The desirable characteristics of a
transconductance amplifier are (D)
(A) high input resistance and high output
resistance
(B) high input resistance and low output 10
resistance
(C) low input resistance and high output
resistance 5
(D) low input resistance and low output
resistance
EE - 2009
EE - 2006 2. The nature of feedback in the op-amp
1. A relaxation oscillator is made using circuit shown is
OPAMP as shown in figure. The supply +6V
2
voltages of the OPAMP are 12V. The K
voltage waveform at point P will be
R1
Vin ~ 6V
R2
C _ (A) Current - Current feedback
+
2kΩ (B) Voltage - Voltage feedback
(C) Current - Voltage feedback
P (D) Voltage - Current feedback
10kΩ
10kΩ
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 377
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE - 2014
3. In the Wien Bridge oscillator circuit
shown in figure, the bridge is balanced
when
μF
IN - 2007
1. A FET source follower is shown in the
( ) figure below:
√
+ 15 V
( )
μF
( )
√
( )
1
4. An oscillator circuit using ideal op-amp
and diodes is shown in the figure.
ECE/IN - 2013
2. In the feedback network shown below , if
the feedback factor k is increased , then
the
The time duration for +ve part of the Vin V1 A0 Vout
cycle is and for ve part is . The
value of will be _______________
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 378
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE 6. [Ans. B]
1. [Ans. D] Current Series
Ideal transconductance amplifier has O/P is taken at collector which is voltage
infinite input and output resistance. emitter node will be current and
resistor is grounded
2. [Ans. A] Series
3. [Ans. D] 7. [Ans. A]
EE
1. [Ans. A]
2 2 Output will be either at .
( Refer Diagram below) When output will be at diode
connected to resistance will be on
making voltage at point P equal to 6V.
When output is at diode connected
5v
to 2 resistance will be on making
voltage at point equal to .
V
+
+
- 2. [Ans. B]
-
+ It is voltage – voltage feedback.
+
3. [Ans. C]
Barkhausen criteria for oscillation (for
positive feedback)
5. [Ans. B]
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 379
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
( )( )
(
2
Real and imaginary part on LHS and RHS
are same so imaginary part = 0
( )
2
( 2 )
~ ( )
( ) ( )
( )
2 2
2
2
2
[ ]
For (- Ve) cycle capacitor discharges from
2 2
Apply KCL at node ( )
( )
( )
2
K ( 2 )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 380
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
( 2 ) ( ) IN
1. [Ans. D]
2 Feedback in this circuit is drain voltage as
( )
negative.
2
2 2. [Ans. A]
( )
2 Given connection is voltage series F/B.
2
[ ] increases and decreases
2
y q
2
2
( )
[ 2 ]
( )
( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 381
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1 kΩ
k 1 kΩ
k k
k
(A) =√
(B) =e
(C) = ln 2
k
(D) = ln 2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 382
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
6. The transfer function (s)/ (s) is 10. Consider the Schmidt trigger circuit
(A) (C) shown below
(D) k
(B)
7. If sin t and
sin t , then the minimum k
and maximum values of (in radians)
k
are respectively
(A) –π/ and π/ (C) –π and
(B) and π/ (D) –π/ and A triangular wave which goes from 12V
to 12V is applied to the inverting input of
ECE - 2008 the OPAMP. Assume that the output of the
8. Consider the following circuit using an OPAMP swings from +15V to 15V.The
ideal OPAMP. The I-V characteristics of voltage at the non-inverting input
the diode is described by the relation switches between
I= (e ) where m (A) 12V and +12 V
and V is the voltage across the (B) 7.5V and 7.5V
diode (taken as positive for forward bias) (C) 5V and +5V
(D) 0V and 5V
D 4k
ECE - 2009
= 1 11. In the following astable multivibrator
circuit, which properties of t depend
100k on ?
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 383
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE - 2010
12. Assuming the OP AMP to be ideal, the
voltage gain of the amplifier shown below
is
(A) (C) ( )
(B) (D) ( )
ECE/EE/IN - 2013
15. In the circuit shown below what is the
output voltage (Vout) if a silicon transistor
Q and an ideal op – amp are used?
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 384
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
+15 V Q
1 k
k k
Vout
5V .7
15 V
+15 V
+15 V
1 k Vout
+1V -15 V
-15 V (A) (C)
(B) (D)
1 k 1 k
20. In the differential amplifier shown in the
(A) 4 (C) 8 figure, the magnitudes of the common-
(B) 6 (D) 10 mode and differential-mode gains are
and , respectively. If the resistance
ECE - 2014
is increased, then
17. In the low-pass filter shown in the figure,
for a cut-off frequency of 5 kHz , the value
of (in k ) is ________
k n
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 385
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(B)
(A) (C)
(B) (D)
(C)
12V
0.7V
(A) a bandpass filter
(B) a voltage controlled oscillator
(C) an amplitude modulator (D)
(D) a monostable multivibrator
EE -2006
1. For a given sinusoidal input voltage, the 0.7V
voltage waveform at point P of the
clamper circuit shown in figure will be 12V
EE -2007
2. The circuit shown in the figure is
~
oad
r
Vin
(A) A voltage source with voltage
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 386
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
k +10 V
8
10K
7
+
k 5.0V
IC 555 3
10K
S 0.01 10V
2, 6 k 5.0V
C 4 1
10V
EE -2008
5. The block diagrams of two types of half
wave rectifiers are shown in the figure.
The transfer characteristics of the
rectifiers are also shown within the block.
P Q
(C)
V0 V0
Vin 0 V0 Vin V0
Vin
0 Vin
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 387
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(A)
5V
2.5V
t(sec)
(B)
t(sec)
0
2.5V
5V
(C)
5V
0
t(sec)
5V
(D)
5V
0
t(sec)
5V
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 388
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
z
pamp
rms
The gain vs frequency characteristic of
output (Vo) will be k
(A)
Gain
(A) πm leading by 0
(B) πm leading by 0
(C) 1 π m leading by 900
0 (𝛚)
(D) πm lagging by 0
(B)
10. An ideal op-amp circuit and its input
Gain waveform are shown in the figures.
The output waveform of this circuit will
be
0 (𝛚)
(C)
Gain
6V
k
0 (𝛚)
+
(D) k
3V
k
Gain
0 (𝛚)
t t
EE -2009
9. The following circuit has k
C = 10 F . The input voltage is a sinusoid
at 50Hz with an rms value of 10V. Under
ideal conditions, the current is from the
source is
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 389
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(A)
t t
(B)
t
t t t
t
t t t
(C)
EE -2010
11. Given that the op-amp is ideal, the output
voltage is
(D)
EE -2011
12. For the circuit shown below,
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 390
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE/EE/IN -2012
14. The circuit shown is a
(| |)
utput 𝛚
ntput
(| |)
(A) (C) /
(B) (D)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 391
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
𝛚
/ ( )
/
( )
or
/
/
𝛚
/
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 392
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
k
Vin
(A) 50%
(B) 5%
(C) 50%
(D) negligible amount R2
(A) v0 1 (v v 1 )
R1 2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 393
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
8 4
I=5 mA 3
(A) 1.0 mV (C) 2.5mV
Output
6 (B) 2.0 mV (D) 3.0 mV
555
2 7
discharge IN - 2007
(C= 0.1 uF) 9. When light falls on the photodiode shown
1
in the following circuit, the reverse
saturation current of the photodiode
(A) 20 kHz (C) 40 kHz
changes from to .
(B) 30 kHz (D) 45 kHz
k
Statement for linked answer questions 6
and 7
In the Schmitt trigger circuit shown
below, the Zener diodes have VZ (reverse
saturation voltage) = 6V and VD (forward
voltage drop) = 0.7V Assuming the op – amp to be ideal, the
output voltage, of the circuit.
(A) does not change
(B) changes from 1 V to 2V
(C) changes from 2 V to 1 V
(D) changes from 1 V to 2V
.
10. Consider the linear circuit with and ideal
6. If the circuit has the input lower trip point
op-amp shown in the figure below.
(LTP)=0V, then the value of is given as
1 2
(A) 0.223 (C) 4.67
’ ’
(B) 2.67 (D) ∞
kΩ
-
7. The input upper trip point (UTP) of the Vi Vo
+
Schmitt trigger is
(A) 1.5 V (C) 2.42V
(B) 2.1 V (D) 7V The Z-parameters of the two port
feedback network are kΩ
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 394
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(A)
Vin
o/ i
4 dB
1 dB The circuit is a
(A) Low pass filter
20dB/decade
(B) Level shifter
f (C) Modulator
21. 9kHz (D) Precision rectifier
(B)
/ 13. Consider the triangular wave generator
0 dB shown below.
3 dB 40dB/decade
R kΩ
Input
1 kΩ
10 kΩ Output
f
21. 9kHz
(C)
o/ i
Assume that the op amps are ideal and
4 dB have ± 2 V power supply. If the input is a
1 dB
± 5 V, 50 Hz square wave of duty cycle
40 dB/decade 50%, the condition that results in a
triangular wave of peak to peak
amplitude 5 V and frequency 50 Hz at the
21. 9kHz f
output is
(A) RC = 1 (C)
(B)
(D) 5
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 395
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
0 +
t +
m + k
(C) cc k
VC cc m
cc
2/3 VCC
0
t
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 396
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Common Data Question for Q.No. 17, 18 & 21. A differential amplifier shown below has
19 a differential mode gain of 100 and a
Consider the op-amp circuit shown in the CMRR of 40dB. If . and
figure below: . , the output V0 is
k k
--
+ (A) 10V (C) 11V
(B) 10.5V (D) 15V
- 22. The op-amp circuit shown below is that of
- a
17. If . . and 7
and the op-amp is ideal , the value of the
is
(A) k (C) k
k
(B) k (D) k k k
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 397
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
24. For the op-amp circuit shown below is 27. The input resistance of the circuit shown
approximately equal to in the figure, assuming an ideal op-amp, is
2R
R 3R
k k
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 398
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 399
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
36. The value of of the series regulator (C) 6.7 V and 4.7 V
shown below is (D) 5.3 V and 3.3 V
40 V(DC)
kΩ
38. Assuming base-emitter voltage of 0.7V
and β of transistor , the output
voltage in the ideal opamp circuit
kΩ shown below is
5V
6 V(DC)
kΩ Ω
(A) 24 V (C) 30 V
(B) 28 V (D) 32 V 5V
1kΩ
is
~V
sin
470k
22k
0.25sin t
~ V0
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 400
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
R2
mA
10 k
X R1
10 k Z
Y
5V,
50Hz
~ V0 R3 V0
V1 R4
(A) 0.45 (C) 0.7
(B) 0.5 (D) 0.9
Fig. b
(A) 0 Hz (C) 2 kHz 42. Assuming its differential gain to be 10 and
(B) 50 Hz (D) 50kHz the op – amp to be otherwise ideal , the
CMRR is
Statement for Linked Answer Questions 42 (A) (C)
and 43 (B) (D)
A differential amplifier with signal
terminals X, Y, Z is connected as shown in 43. The differential amplifier is connected as
Fig. (a) below for CMRR measurement shown in Fig. (b) above to a single strain
where the differential amplifier has an gage bridge. Let the strain gage resistance
additional constant offset voltage in the vary around its no – load resistance R by
output. The observations obtained are : ± 1%. Assume the input impedance of the
when Vi= 2V, V0=3mV, and when Vi=3V, amplifier to be high compared to the
V0=4mV. equivalent source resistance of the
bridge, and the common mode
characteristic to be as obtained above.
The output voltage in mV varies
approximately from
(A) +128 to – 128 (C) +122 to – 122
(B) + 128 to – 122 (D) +99 to – 101
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 401
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
. 7
~
k k
(A) = 800 nA, =50 nA
(B) = 800 nA, =100nA
(C) = 400 nA, =50nA
(D) = 400 nA, 100nA 48. The figures show an oscillator circuit
having an ideal Schmitt trigger and its
45. The amplifier in the figure has gain of -10 input-output characteristics. The time
and input resistance of 50 k . The value period (in ms) of t is___________.
of and are
t
output
k
nput
(A) k k
(B) k k
(C) k k
(D) k k
. k
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 402
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE 4. [Ans. C]
1. [Ans. D] 2 kΩ
dv
k dt
( ) ( )
k
k
.
k k
k k
2. [Ans. D] ( ) ( ) .
k k
.
k k .
k
5. [Ans. D]
Applying KCL
k
exp ( )
k
Volt across 24 k due to virtual exp ( )
ground concept. So voltage across 12k k
is 3V ln i
k
ow ln
k
ln
k
watts ln
3. [Ans. B] 6. [Ans. A]
Unregulated voltage increases by 20%
i. e. New regulated voltage = 18V
watts
increases
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 403
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
10. [Ans. C]
( ) ( )
. k
( ) ( )
k
j k
j
j From KCL
j s
j
s
s k k k
s s
s s
..
7. [Ans. C] Threshold depends on output
s s So, when
s s
s
s When
s s
tan tan
tan 11. [Ans. A]
inimum value of π at ∞
maximum value of at 12. [Ans. C]
a
8. [Ans. B]
c
⁄
(e )
Where and b
Voltage across diode = 60 mV
Voltage across 4k resistor s k
k Op-amp is ideal, so it will satisfy the
m virtual ground property
Total voltage is m m a c
m . So, we can redraw the circuit as
9. [Ans. B]
At low frequency, capacitor is open and
inductor short so,
At high frequency capacitor is short and
inductor open so,
so it is low pass filter.
Circuit is similar to standard inverting
amplifier
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 404
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
[ ( )]
13. [Ans. B]
i
i i
i
Hence given circuit is a high pass filter
i
15. [Ans. B]
k
.7
Redraw the given circuit
Case (1)
5V
i
For non-zero value of , diode must be
off, so i
Then by virtual short
equivalent connection for transistor is
t
0
t
.7 0.7V
When , both diode are
conducting so =0V 16. [Ans. C]
ain of stage
14. [Ans. D] k k
( ) ( )
At k k
Hence circuit can be redrawn as below
1k k
-2V
m i m
i
1k Vout
i
+1V
-15 V
1k 1k
t ∞ ∞
Hence circuit can be redrawn as below Gain of stage II = * +
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 405
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
.
. k z if decreases CMRR increases
k k
a
.7
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 406
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE 5. [Ans. B]
1. [Ans. D] From the transfer characteristic of the
When is positive, will be –ve and rectifier P is
diode will be OFF, so V for
When is negative, will be ve and for
diode will be ON, so .7
2. [Ans. D]
Voltage at non inverting terminal,
From the transfer characteristics of the
rectifier Q is
Due to virtual ground for
current through Load, for
r
So this circuit acts as a current source
with current
3. [Ans. A]
An astable multi-vibrator is providing
pulses as given below.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 407
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
magnitude i v
ere π
s s
Let, is only on non-inverting terminal π mA
and it will be lagging by 90°
( )
10. [Ans. D]
k
( )
( ) k
12. [Ans. D]
C First section is differential amplifier
having gain off 1.
. .
= .
So gain frequency characteristics will
be as option (D)
9. [Ans. D]
Voltage at inverting terminal
So Output is
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 408
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
( ) 15. [Ans. B]
x
y
y
Applying superposition theorem
When y = 0
x x
when x
y/
13. [Ans. D] y
Low Pass Filter High Pass Filter
y x
from equation and
16. [Ans. A]
k
i
20Hz 30Hz
Pass band
14. [Ans. B]
f
V= =0
= =
=- =
= s
High pass Fitter with f rad /sec
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 409
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
17. [Ans. D]
3. [Ans. C]
When Op-Amp is used in ve feedback
then voltage difference between the
-
- terminals is treated as zero.
4. [Ans. A]
When The equivalent circuit is as follows:
is on
is off
( ) ( ) . ------------- (1)
when and
is on
is off ⟹ * +
From equation (1)
⟹ * +
=( )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 410
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
5. [Ans. B] 8. [Ans. D]
It is a sawtooth wave generator across DC output Voltage that is output offset
capacitor C. voltage,
( )
So maximum offset (dc voltage) at the
output will be,
t ( ) m
T T T
m m
d m
o
dt T T
d 9. [Ans. B]
dt
d k
dt .
a
T
f k z
T
The given circuit is
6. [Ans. C]
pply K at ‘a’
.7
=0
When
. When
I=
When reverse circuit of the photodiode
I . =0
.
changes from 100 to , the output
1.5 = voltage change from 1V to 2V
= 4.47
10. [Ans. D]
Given that the imp. Parameters are
7. [Ans. C] k k
6.7V k
k
I k
1.5V k
k
I=
. .
=
. Then the given op-amp circuit is
.
=I . = .
.
= .
= 2.45V
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 411
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
k k 12. [Ans. D]
R R
k
k .
a
Vin
b
pply K at ‘a’
pply K at ‘x’ t
Case-1
When ve half cycle then switch (s)
ain is closed and circuit will become
R R
11. [Ans. B]
p .
Vin
k k
p
k ( )
( )
7k
.
Case -2
When ve half cycle then switch s is
The given circuit is a second order low
open and circuit will become
pass filter therefore it has a
R R
dB/decade and it has 3 dB cut-off
frequency as
f .
π√
. k z Vin
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 412
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
No circuit flow through left side Op-Amp through resistor . But is shorted
due to open switch so out. So discharge time constant
= .So capacitor will
instantly discharge so correct output is in
So, the circuit as a rectifier (fullwave)
option (A)
13. [Ans. B]
15. [Ans. B]
O/P of first OPAMP
The UTP value selected in such a way that
t ∫ t dt, where k to recover a square wave of same
and O/P of second OPAMP frequency from the input signal
t t When The output is
∫ t dt When
K and
∫ t dt When
input is , 50Hz square wave. O/P We can recover a square wave of same
should be triangular wave of . frequency from the corrupted input signal
50Hz means 20msec, so in 10msec O/P when UTP and LTP value are
should charge from . to . ,
when . 16. [Ans. B]
k
t ∫ dt
k
-
+ +
m
+ k
k
- m
-
14. [Ans. C] Apply KCL at node
KΩ
RA reset .
discharge
KΩ RB out
. .
̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
tr gger .
.
threshold
. . .
ground .
.
.
Capacitor C charges toward through Now, Apply KCL at Node
and until in raises upto 2/3 .
This voltage is the threshold voltage of .
For an ideal op-amp
pin 6 which drives comparator 1 to
. .
trigger the flip-flop so that the output at
.
pin 3 goes low. In addition, the discharge
. .7 7
transistor is driven on. Causing the output
. m
at pin 7 to discharge the capacitor
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 413
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
17. [Ans. B] K K
k k . K . K
20. [Ans. A]
-- 21. [Ans. B]
+
. and
.
-
- d
Apply the KCL at the inverting node
[ ] . .
.
Put, 7 . and .
. . 22. [Ans. D]
7 [ ]
At low frequency, C is open and
. At high frequency C is short and
. 7 .
( )
k
so it is a high pass filter with max. gain of
18. [Ans. C] 2.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 414
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
24. [Ans. B] .
Equivalent circuit Now first open the zener diode then
circuit will be
k
k k
k
k
k k
.
Similarly, by neglecting current through So zener will be on and circuit will be as
K compare to current through k
i
resistance,
i .
k
.7 k
m
.7
.7 .
o will lie between and .
. . Because zener will be on then current 1
5.2 V mA will be divided in two parts and
output will be – 10V < < 3.2V
25. [Ans. A] f output
s s then i . m
i . m
s [ ] oi i
hence this is not possible
So it is all - pass filter.
When .
Then i . m
26. [Ans. B]
. .
Zener diode is in reverse bias. The i . m
equivalent circuit is, here i i i
k
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 415
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
k
Input resistance
⃗ a
b
Voltage at inverting terminal, k
pply K at a
Gain =
7k
s 7 k
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 416
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
So input impedance seen from with Since, and are all matched
respect to ground is 7k transistors
Now put So, say
The input impedance from with Then m
respect to ground or . m
7 7 k lso
7k . m
35. [Ans. A]
7k The ideal op-amp based circuit is shown
7 k
in figure 1. with T-network at the input
and feedback paths,. Note the specific
relations between resistances and
Now voltage at point P is
capacitances used. It can be shown that
7 7
this circuit acts as a double integrator and
hence it is a low pass filter specifically
By virtual ground capacitor, voltage at
transfer function
point Q is
. .
7
k
Now apply KCL at point Q
k 7 k
.
.
igure
33. [Ans. B]
k
s
s
s s
or .
m . . sec
s
. s s
The frequency response is given by
j which shows the gain falls by
40 dB per decade
Clearly m
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 417
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
37. [Ans. D]
When input voltage (During ve k
cycle)
Forward biased
Reverse biased
.7
ow .
39. [Ans. A]
.
1kΩ f
π π .
Where . sin t
f . k z . sin t
.7 40. [Ans. A]
.7 or
.7 41. [Ans. C]
.7 For Op-Amp
. Analysis
.7
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 418
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
s . k z
T. 7
s
d . k z
k .
d d
Lower 3 dB dominant frequency is 0.5
ere kHz.
Total response
one pole
s and reject response
OP-Amp is low pass response; east attenuated
frequency k z
Low frequencies
z
k z
f
. k z k z
s s
T.
s s
* +
43. [Ans. B]
* +
5V
* +* j +
R R
* j +
High pass response
R
High frequencies
[ ]
. k z
For variation is
d
7 . varies from 12.48mV to 12.56mV
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 419
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
m , given
k .
from bridge i
For change . m .
=127.8 mV
For change 47. [Ans. *]Range 15 to 16
op amp . m m It is second-order low pass system. t’s
. m m high cut-off-frequency
. m f
O/P varies from 7. m to . m π√
ere f k
44. [Ans. D] c c . 7
In an OPAMP,
f
nput bias current π√ k . 7
n / n . z
π k . 7 .
input offset current
n n 48. [Ans. *] Range 8.0 to 8.5
45. [Ans. B] T ln [ ]
Given k and gain
For an inverting amplifier, Gain = / ln [ ]
-10 / k .
Then k Time period .
. m secs
46. [Ans. 0.6]
k k
i
. k
i c
d
virtual ground
K at ode
i
i i
k . k k k
ki
ki ki
oi
. k k
ki
i
. k
. ki ki
ki . ki
ki
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 420
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Power Amplifiers
EE - 2007 EE - 2009
1. The input signal Vin shown in the figure is 2. Transformer and emitter follower can
a 1 KHz square wave voltage that both be used for impedance matching
alternates between +7V and 7V with a at the output of an audio amplifier. The
50% duty cycle. Both transistors have the basic relationship between the input
same current gain, which is large. The power Pin and output power Pout in both
circuit delivers power to the load resistor the cases is
RL. What is the efficiency of this circuit for (A) Pin = Pout for both transformer and
the given input? Choose the closest emitter follower
answer. (B) Pin > Pout for both transformer and
emitter follower
(C) Pin < Pout for transformer and
Pin = Pout for emitter follower
(D) Pin = Pout for transformer and
Pin < Pout for emitter follower
EE
1. [Ans. C]
load voltage = ±6.3 V
So efficiency
2. [Ans. D]
For emitter follower
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 421
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE-2006 ECE-2014
1. A new Binary Coded Pentary (BCP) 5. The number of bytes required to
number system is proposed in which represent the decimal number 1856357
every digit of a base-5 number is in packed BCD (Binary Coded Decimal)
represented by its corresponding 3-bit form is __________.
binary code. For example, the base-5
number 24 will be represented by its BCP EE-2007
code 010100. In this numbering system, 1. The octal equivalent of the HEX number
the BCP code 100010011001 AB.CD is
corresponds to the following number in (A) 253.314 (C) 526.314
base-5 system (B) 253.632 (D) 526.632
(A) 423 (C) 2201
(B) 1324 (D) 4231 EE-2014
2. A cascade of three identical modulo-5
2. The number of product terms in the counters has an overall modulus of
minimized sum-of-product expression (A) 5 (C) 125
obtained through the following K-map is (B) 25 (D) 625
(where, “d” denotes don’t care states)
1 0 0 1 3. Which of the following is an invalid state
0 d 0 0 in an 8-4-2-1 Binary Coded Decimal
0 0 d 1 counter
1 0 0 1 (A) 1 0 0 0 (C) 0 0 1 1
(A) 2 (C) 4 (B) 1 0 0 1 (D) 1 1 0 0
(B) 3 (D) 5
IN-2006
ECE-2007 1. A number N is stored in a 4-bit 2’s
3. X = 01110 and Y = 11001 are two 5-bit complement representation as
binary numbers represented in two’s a3 a2 a1 a0
complement format. The sum of X and Y It is copied into a 6-bit register and after a
represented in two’s complement format few operations, the final bit pattern is
using 6 bits is, a a a a a 1
(A) 100111 (C) 000111 The value of this bit pattern in 2’s
(B) 001000 (D) 101001 complement representation is given in
terms of the original number is N as
ECE-2008 (A) 32 a3 + 2N + 1 (C) 2N – 1
4. The two numbers represented in signed (B) 32 a3 – 2N – 1 (D) 2N + 1
2’s complement form are P = 11101101
and Q = 11100110. If Q is subtracted IN-2008
from P, the value obtained in signed 2’s 2. The result of (45)10 – (45)16 expressed in
complement form is 6-bit 2’s complement representation is,
(A) 100000111 (C) 11111001 (A) 011000 (C) 101000
(B) 00000111 (D) 111111001 (B) 100111 (D) 101001
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 422
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN-2009 IN-2011
3. The binary representation of the decimal 4. The base of the number system for the
number 1.375 is, addition operation 24 + 14 = 41 to be
(A) 1.111 (C) 1.011 true is
(B) 1.010 (D) 1.001 (A) 8 (C) 6
(B) 7 (D) 5
2. [Ans. A]
EE
1 0 0 1 1. [Ans. B]
0 d 0 0 Hex number (AB.CD)
0 0 d 1 ⏞
1010 ⏞ 1011 ⏞ 1100 ⏞ 1101
1 0 0 1 For finding its octal number, we add one
zero in both extreme and group 3 bit
together
3. [Ans. C]
010
⏟ 101⏟ 011⏟ 110⏟ 011⏟ 010⏟
x = 01110
y = 11001 quivalent octal number 253 632
x y( ) = 100111
Carry discard it 2. [Ans. C]
00111 in 6 bits will be 000111 Overall modulus = 5 = 125
4. [Ans. B] 3. [Ans. D]
igned 2 s complement of BCD counter counts up to 1001
P = 11101101
o P = 00010011 IN
igned 2 scomplement of 1. [Ans. D]
= 11100110 Given number is a a a a in 2’s
P = P (2 s complement of )
complement form.
= 00010011
We know that in 2’s complement form if
11100110
we copy MSB at left of MSB any times the
11111001
number remains unchanged.
2 s complement of (P ) = 00000111
So a a a a = a a a a a a =
When we left shift a number by 1 bit then
5. [Ans. *] Range 3.9 to 4.1
it is multiplied by 2, a a a a a 0 = 2
A decimal digit is represented by 4 bit in
Now,
BCD format, so for a decimal number with
a a a a a 0 1=a a a a a 1=2 1
digits requires 4d bit and
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 423
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
2. [Ans. C]
(45) (45) = ( 24) = (101000)
3. [Ans. C]
0.375 × 2 = 0.750
0.750 × 2 = 1.5
1.5 × 2 = 1.0
Hence answer is 1.011
4. [Ans. B]
Let the base is x, Here
(24) (14) = (41)
(4 x 2 x) (4 x 1 x)
= (4 x 1 x )
4 + 2x + 4 + x = 4x + 1
x=7
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 424
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE-2007 ECE-2014
1. The Boolean expression 5. The Boolean expression ( )( ̅)
̅̅ ̅ ̅ ̅ ̅̅ ̅ ̅ can ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
( ̅) ̅ simplifies to
be minimized to (A) X (C) XY
(A) ̅̅ ̅ ̅ ̅ ̅ (B) Y (D) X+Y
(B) ̅̅ ̅ ̅ ̅̅
(C) ̅ 6. Consider the Boolean function, F(w, x, y,
(D) z) = wy + xy + ̅ xyz + ̅ ̅ y + xz + ̅ ̅ ̅.
Which one of the following is the
ECE-2009 complete set of essential prime
2. If X = 1 in the logic equation implicates?
[X+Z{ ( +X ) }] { + ( X + Y)} (A) ̅̅ (C) ̅ ̅̅
=1 then (B) (D) ̅̅
(A) Y = Z (C) Z = 1
(D) Z = 0 7. For an n-variable Boolean function, the
(B) Y =
maximum number of prime implicants is
(A) ( ) (C)
EC/EE/IN -2012
3. In the sum of products function
(B) (D) ( )
( ) ∑( ), the prime implicants
are EE-2010
(A) ̅ ̅ Statement for Linked Answer Questions1
(B) ̅ ̅ ̅̅ ̅ and 2
The following Karnaugh map represent a
(C) ̅ ̅ ̅ ̅
function .
(D) ̅ ̅ ̅ ̅̅ ̅
F
ECE-2013 YZ
4. In the circuit shown below, Q1 has X 00 01 11 10
negligible collector – to – emitter F
saturation voltage and the diode drops YZ
0 1 1 1 0
negligible voltage across it under forward
bias. If Vcc is +5 V, X and Y are digital X 00 01 11 10
signals with 0 V as logic 0 and as logic 1 0 0 1 0
1, then the Boolean expression for Z is 0 1 1 1 0
1. A minimized form of the function is
R1 (A) 1 0 (C)0 1 0
Z
(B) (D)
R2
X Q1
Diode 2. Which of the following circuits is a
realization of the above function ?
Y
(A) XY (C) X
(B) (D)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 425
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(A) ( )
X
F
(A) Y
Z
X
(B) F
X Y
Z
F ( )
(B) Y
Z
X
(C) F
Y
X Z
(C) F
Y
Z 4. The SOP (sum of products) form of a
X
(D) Boolean function is (0,1,3,7,11), where
F
Y inputs are A,B,C,D (A is MSB, and D is
X Z LSB). The equivalent minimized
(D) F expression of the function is
Y (A) (̅ )( ̅ )( ̅ ̅)( ̅ )
X Z
(B) ( ̅ )( ̅ )( ̅ ̅ )( ̅ )
F (C) (̅ )( ̅ )( ̅ ̅ )( ̅ ̅ )
EE-2014Y (D) (̅ )( ̅)( ̅ ̅)( ̅ )
Z
3. Which of the following logic circuits is a
realization of the function F whose IN-2006
Karnaugh map is shown in figure 1. Min-term (Sum of Products) expression
for a Boolean function is given as follows.
f(A, B, C) = m (0, 1, 2, 3, 5, 6) where A is
the MSB and C is the LSB. The minimized
expression for the function is
(A) A + (B C) (C) (B C)
( ) (B) (A B) + C (D)
IN-2007
2. A logic circuit implements the Boolean
function F = ̅ . Y + X .̅ . ̅ . It is found that
the input combination X = Y = 1 can
never occur. Taking this into account, a
( )
simplified expression for F, is given by
(A) ̅ + ̅. ̅ (C) X + Y
(B) X + Z (D) Y + X. ̅
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 426
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN-2009
5. The minimal sum-of-products expression
for the logic function f represented by the
given Karnaugh map is
PQ
RS
00 01 11 10
00 0 1 0 0
0 1 1 1
01
11 1 1 1 0
10 0 0 1 0
(A) QS +
(B) +
(C) +
(D)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 427
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE 4. [Ans. B]
1. [Ans. D] X Y Z Comments
K-map corresponding to given Boolean 0 0 0 Transistor off
expression diode ON
CD 0 1 1 Transistor off
AB 00 01 11 10
diode rev biases
00 1
1 0 0 Transistor ON
01 1
diode rev biases
11 1
1 1 0 Transistor ON
10 1 diode rev biased
So, ̅Y=Z
̅̅ ̅ ̅ ̅̅
OR 5. [Ans. A]
̅̅ ̅ ̅ ̅ ̅̅ ̅̅ ( )( ̅) (̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
̅) ̅
( ̅ ̅) ̅̅̅̅ ̅
[ ] ̅̅ ̅̅̅̅
̅
6. [Ans. D]
2. [Ans. D] yz
wx ̅̅
* ( ( ̅))+ [ ( )] 1 1
By putting X = 1 1 1 xz
* ( ( ))+ [ ̅( )] 1 1 1 1
y
[ ] 1 1 1 1
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 428
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE 2. [Ans. D]
1. [Ans. B] ̅ ̅̅
YZ Truth table:
00 01 11 10
X X Y Z F
0 1 1 1 0
0 0 0 0
1 0 0 1 0
0 0 1 0
F = ̅ ̅ + YZ 0 1 0 1
0 1 1 1
2. [Ans. D] 1 0 0 1
From the figure it is clear that, two NAND 1 0 1 0
gates generate the ̅ ̅ and now two 1 1 0 x
AND gates with inputs ̅ ̅ and inputs 1 1 1 x
Y and Z is used to generate two terms of
SOP form and now OR gate is used to sum K – map
them and generate the F. YZ
X 00 01 11 10
3. [Ans. C] 0 0 0 1 1
̅̅
1 1 0 x x
̅̅ [by consensus theorem]
4. [Ans. A]
̅ ̅ ̅ ̅
X
(̅ )( ̅ ̅)( ̅)( ̅)
F=Y+X
3. [Ans. D]
F = 1 if X > Y, so following will be K – map
of function F.
00 01 11 10
00 0 0 0 0
01 1 0 0 0
11 1 1 0 1
10
IN 1 1 0 1
1. [Ans. C] F= ̅ + ̅ ̅̅̅ + ̅̅̅
From K – map
BC 4. [Ans. A]
A 00 01 11 10
0 1 1 1 0
By K – map
1 0 1 0 1
f = ̅ + B ̅ + ̅C
=̅+B C
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 429
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
PQ RS
00 01 11 10
00 1 0 0 1
01 0 0 0 0
11 0 0 0 0
10 1 1 1 1
5. [Ans. A]
PQ
RS 00 01 11 10
Q
S 00 0 1 0
0
01 0 1 1 1
11 1 1 1 0
10 0 0 1 0
6. [Ans. A]
̅ ̅̅ ̅ ̅ ̅̅ ̅
̅ ̅( ̅ ) ̅̅ ( ̅)
̅̅ ̅ ̅
̅̅ [ ̅ ̅]
̅̅ [( ̅ )( ̅)]
̅̅ ( ̅)
̅̅ ̅
̅( ̅)
̅
(̅ )(̅ )
( ̅)( ̅)
Alternative method:
00 01 11 10
0 1 0 0 1
0 1 0 1 1
( ̅)( ̅)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 430
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Logic Gates
ECE-2011
(A) P NOR Q (C) P OR Q
6. The output Y in the circuit below is
(B) P NAND Q (D) P AND Q
always “1” when
3. Which of the following Boolean P
ECE-2012
7. In the circuit shown
5 Volts
A
C
(A) ̅y y̅
B (B) ̅y̅ y̅̅
Y (C) ̅y̅ y
C (D) ̅y̅̅ y
(A) ̅̅ ̅ (C) (̅ ̅) ̅
(B) ( ) (D)
1024 A
E XOR
A0 A9 2 B
1024
E
A10
A11
1024
1 XOR Y
A12
A13 11
A14 input 10 E
01
A15
S1 S0 00
C
XOR
D
A. 0C00H 0FFFH, 1C00H 1FFFH,
(A) S is always either zero or odd
2C00H 2FFFH, 3C00H 3FFFH
(B) S is always either zero or even
B. 1800H 1FFFH, 2800H 2FFFH,
(C) S = 1 only if the sum of A, B, C and D
3800H 3FFFH, 4800H 4FFFH
is even
C. 0500H 08FFH, 1500H 18FFH,
(D) S = 1 only if the sum of A, B, C and D
3500H 38FFH, 5500H 58FFH
is odd
D. 0800H 0BFFH, 1800H 1BFFH,
2800H 2BFFH, 3800H 3BFFH EE-2009
2. The complete set of only those Logic
ECE-2014 Gates designated as Universal Gates is
9. The output F in the digital logic circuit (A) NOT, OR and AND Gates
shown in the figure is (B) XNOR, NOR and NAND Gate
(C) NOR and NAND Gates
(D) XOR, NOR and NAND Gates
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 432
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
5V
(A) 1 (C) X
(B) 0 (D) ̅
τ
T/2
IN-2006
1. All the logic gates in the circuit shown (B) Vav
below have finite propagation delay. The
circuit can be used as a clock generator, if 5V
Vav
Y τ
T/2
(C)
Vav Vav
X
(A) X = 0 (C) X = 0 or 1 5V
(B) X = 1 (D) X = Y
IN-2007 τ
T/2
2. Two square waves of equal period T, but (D)
with a time delay τ are applied to a digital Vav
circuit whose truth table is shown in the
following figure.
2.5V
X Y Output
0 0 1 τ
T/2
0 1 0
1 0 0 IN-2009
1 1 1 3. The diodes in the circuit shown are ideal.
X A voltage of 0V represents logic 0 and
+5V represents logic1.The function Z
1 realized by the circuit for inputs X and Y
is
+ 5V
t
T/2 T
Y
1 X Z
Y
τ τ T/2 t
The high and the low levels of the output (A) Z=X + Y (C) Z =̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
of the digital circuit are 5 V and 0 V, (B) Z=XY (D) Z=̅̅̅̅
respectively. Which one of the following
figures shows the correct variation of the
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 433
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN-2010 EC/EE/IN-2013
4. The logic gate circuit shown in the figure 5. A bulb in a staircase has two switches,
realizes the function one switch being at the ground floor and
A the other one at the first floor. The bulb
X can be turned ON and also can be turned
OFF by any one of the switch irrespective
Z of the state of the other switch. The logic
of switching of the bulb resembles
Y (A) An AND gate (C) A XOR gate
(B) An OR gate (D) A NAND gate
(A) XOR (C) Half adder
(B) XNOR (D) Full adder
ECE 5. [Ans. D]
1. [Ans. B] P = ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅ = ̅ ̅ = 4
A Q = ̅̅̅̅ = ̅ + ̅ = 2
B
AB + CD
R = A ⊕ B = A̅ + ̅B = 3
S = A B = AB + ̅ ̅ = 1
C
D
6. [Ans. B]
2. [Ans. D] The output Y expression in the ckt
When P = Q = 1, then OUT = 1 (Majority circuit)
P = Q = 0, then OUT = 0 So that two or more inputs are ‘1’, is
P = 0, Q = 1, then OUT = 0 always ‘1’.
P = 1, Q = 0, then OUT = 0
7. [Ans. A]
So, it is AND gate
In NMOS circuit
Since & are in parallel so those
3. [Ans. D]
represent ( ) & is in sense, so it
X= ;Y=P+Q represents ‘dot’ operation and the whole
Z = XY = . (P + Q) function should be inverted or it is
=( )( ) complementary logic.
⊕ So,
∴ ⊕ ⊕ ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
( ) ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅ ̅ ̅ ̅ ̅
4. [Ans. D] 8. [Ans. D]
For 3 input XNOR for output to be one, For RAM #1
two input must be one, and we know that
⏟0 0 0 0 ⏟1 0 0 0 ⏟ ⏟
0 0 ower add
2- input XOR & XNOR gate are 0 0 0
complementary & hence only 1(1’s) will ⏟
0000 ⏟ 1 0 1 1 ⏟ 1⏟1 ighest add
be generated & C=1 is required 0
i.e, When A = 0, B = 0 and C = 1, So range of add for RAM #1 0 00
then F = 1 0
which is present only in option D
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 434
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
9. [Ans. A] IN
( ⊕ )(( ⊕ ) ) 1. [Ans. B]
( ⊕ )(( ⊕ ) ( )̅) When X = 1, equivalent circuit is
( ⊕ )
(̅ ̅) Y
̅ ̅
This circuits act as clock generator.
10. [Ans. A]
2. [Ans. C]
C 0 1
A ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅ ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
When τ = 0 X and Y will be same and
B out-put will be equal to dc of 5V.
0
A ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅ When τ = , X and Y will be complement
B AB of each other and output will be equal to
y ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
̅̅̅̅̅̅̅ ( ) ̅̅̅̅ dc 0.
( ) (̅ ̅) When τ increases from 0 to , O/P will
̅ ̅
decrease from 5V to 0V linearly.
EE
3. [Ans. B]
1. [Ans. B]
When any of X or Y is zero, Z = 0. For
⊕ ⊕ ⊕ from the given
X = Y = 1, Z = 1
diagram. We know that sum of any
number of bits is XOR of all bits.
4. [Ans. A]
So S ⊕ ⊕ ⊕ ⊕
X y
S=Y⊕Y
S = either zero or even because LSB is
x Z
zero (always).
Y y y
2. [Ans. C] Z= y. y = y y =x⊕y
NOR and NAND are designated as
universal logic gates, because using any 5. [Ans. C]
one of them we can implement all the When both switches in on position, bulb
logic gates. is off
When both switches in off position, bulb
3. [Ans. A] is off
Y= .̅ ̅. ̅ ̅ 1 Bulb
X Y 0 0 0
1 0 1 0 1 1
0 1 1 1 0 1
1 1 0
It is a XOR gate
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 435
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1 4kΩ 100kΩ
R (A) 4 V, 3 V, 2 V (C) 4 V, 4 V, 4 V
2
4kΩ
Q4
(B) 5 V, 5 V, 5 V (D) 5 V, 4 V, 3 V
D
Q2 4. The output (Y) of the circuit shown in the
Q1
Q3
figure is
1kΩ
-
ECE - 2009
2. The full forms of the abbreviations TTL (A) ̅ ̅ (C) ̅ ̅
and CMOS in reference of logic families (B) ̅ ̅ ̅ (D) ̅
are
(A) Triple Transistor Logic and Chip EE - 2010
Metal Oxide Semiconductor 1. The TTL circuit shown in the figure is fed
(B) Tristate Transistor Logic and Chip with the waveform X (also shown). All
Metal Oxide Semiconductor gates have equal propagation delay of
(C) Transistor Transistor Logic and 10ns. The output Y of the circuit is
Complementary Metal Oxide x
Semiconductor 100 ns
(D) Tristate Transistor Logic and
Complementary Metal Oxide Silicon
1
ECE - 2014
3. In the following circuit employing pass 0 t
transistor logic, all NMOS transistors are
identical with a threshold voltage of 1V.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 436
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
X IN - 2007
Y
1. A CMOS implementation of a logic gate is
shown in the following figure:
5v
(A)
Y X
Y PMOS
1
0
t NMOS
(B)
Y
The Boolean logic function realized by the
circuit is.
1 (A) AND (C) NOR
(B) NAND (D) OR
0 t
(C) IN - 2014
Y
2. The figure is a logic circuit with inputs A
and B and output Y. = + 5 V. The
circuit is of type
1
t
0
(D)
Y
0 t
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 437
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE EE
1. [Ans. B] 1. [Ans. A]
reverse active, saturation X
Y
saturation, cut off
2. [Ans. C] A B
TTL – Transistor Transistor Logic
CMOS – Complementary Metal Oxide
1
Semiconductor X
0
3. [Ans. C] A
Suppose all NMOS at saturation
B
For
1 & Y=X B
4
For
IN
( 1)
1. [Ans. C]
(4 ) NOR Gate
4 (4 ) 2. [Ans. D]
4 Given circuit is of the standard 2 input
NAND gate.
1
(4 ) 4
4
4. [Ans. A]
The given circuit is CMOS implementation
If the NMOS is connected in series, then
the output expression is product of each
input with complement to the final
product.
̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
̅ ̅
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 438
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE - 2006 S
1 0 1 1 D Q A
1. The point P in the following figure is
MSB LSB
stuck-at-1. The output f will be CK FULL
A ADDER
f
0 0 1 1 D Q B
C0
B Shift Registers 0 Ci
P CK
0 Q D
0
C
CK
(A) ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅ (C) ̅
(B) ̅ (D) A
CLOCK
(A) S =0, C0= 0 (C) S = 1, C0= 0
2. Two D-flip-flops, as shown below, are to
be connected as a synchronous counter (B) S = 0, C0= 1 (D) S = 1, C0= 1
that goes through the following Q1Q0 ECE - 2007
sequence 4. For the circuit shown, the counter state
………… (Q1 Q0) follows the sequence
The inputs and respectively should
be connected as
̅̅̅̅ ̅̅̅̅
c c
(A) ̅̅̅̅ and
(A) ………
(B) ̅̅̅̅ and
(B) ………
(C) ̅̅̅̅ and ̅̅̅̅
(C) ………
(D) ̅̅̅̅ ̅̅̅̅and
(D) ………
3. For the circuit shown in figure below, two 5. The following binary values were applied
4-bit parallel-in serial-out shift registers to the X and Y inputs of the NAND latch
loaded with the data shown are used to shown in the figure in the sequence
feed the data to a full adder. Initially, all indicated below:
the flip-flops are in clear state. After X=0, Y=1; X=0, Y=0; X=1, Y=1
applying two clock pulses, the outputs of The corresponding stable P, Q outputs
the full adder should be will be
X P
Q
Y
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 439
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
P=0, Q=1
(C) P=1, Q=0; P=1, Q=1; P=1, Q=0 or 1
P=0, Q=1 CLK
(D) P=1, Q=0; P=1, Q=1; P=1, Q=1 0
T
6. In the following circuit, X is given by t
t
0 I0 0 I0
4-to-1 4-to-1
1 I1 1 I1
1 MUX MUX Which of the following waveforms
I2 1 I2 Y X
0 I3 Y 0 I3 correctly represents the output at ?
S1 S0 S1 S0
1
A B C
(A)
0
2T
t
(A) 1
(B) 0
(B)
4T
(C)
t
(D) (C) 1
ECE - 2008 0
7. For the circuit shown in the following 2T
t
figure, are inputs to the 4:1
(D) 1
multiplexer. R(MSB) and S are control
0
bits.
4T
t
z
9. For the circuit shown in the figure, D has a
transition from 0 to 1 after CLK changes
from 1 to 0. Assume gate delays to be
negligible
̅
Consider
P2 Q2 P 2 Q2
(i) Push Button pressed/not Pressed in a
(A) NAND : first (0, 1) then (0, 1) equivalent to logic 1/0 respectively.
NOR: first (1, 0) then (0, 0) (ii) A segment glowing / not glowing in the
(B) NAND : first (1, 0) then (1, 0) display is equivalent to logic 1/0
NOR: first (1, 0) then (1, 0) respectively.
(C) NAND : first (1, 0) then (1, 0)
NOR: first (1, 0) then (0, 0) 13. If segment a to g are considered as
(D) NAND : first (1, 0) then (1, 1) functions of and , then which are of
NOR: first (0, 1) then (0, 1) the following is correct?
(A) g ̅ d c e
12. What are the minimum number of (B) g d c e
(C) g ̅ e b c
2 to. 1 multiplexers required to
generate a (D) g e b c
2-input AND gate and a 2-input Ex-OR
gate? 14. What are the minimum numbers of NOT
(A) 1 and 2 (C) 1 and 1 gates and 2-input OR gates required to
(B) 1 and 3 (D) 2 and 2 design the logic of the driver for this
7-segment display?
(A) a d
(B) a d
(C) a d
(D) a d
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 441
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE - 2010
Data D Q Y
15. The Boolean function realized by the logic D Q
circuit shown is
Clock
(D) ∑ 5
ECE - 2014
̅ ̅ ̅
20. Five JK flip-flops are cascaded to form the
circuit shown in Figure. Clock pulses at a
frequency of 1 MHz are applied as shown.
c The frequency (in kHz) of the waveform
(A) … (C) … at Q3 is _____.
(B) … (D) …
ECE - 2011
17. Two D flip – flops are connected as a c c c c c
The connections to the inputs and 21. The digital logic shown in the figure
are satisfies the given state diagram when Q1
(A) is connected to input A of the XOR gate.
(B)
(C)
(D)
̅̅̅̅ ̅̅̅̅
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 442
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(C) ̅
(D) ̅ ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
(A) … (C) …
23. In the circuit shown, choose the correct (B) … (D) …
timing diagram of the output (y) from the
given waveforms a d . 25. The circuit shown in the figure is a
atch atch
E ̅ E ̅
̅
utput y
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 443
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(A) ̅ ̅ ̅̅
(B) ̅ ̅ ̅
(C) ̅̅ ̅ ̅
(D) ̅ ̅ ̅̅
(A) ̅ ̅
(B) ̅ ̅
(C) ̅ ̅
(D) ̅̅ ̅
28. If X and Y are inputs and the Difference
(D = X – Y) and the Borrow (B) are the
30. A 16-bit ripple carry adder is realized
outputs, which one of the following
using 16 identical full adders (FA) as
diagrams implements a half-subractor?
shown in the figure. The carry-
propagation delay of each FA is 12 ns and
the sum-propagation delay of each FA is
15 ns. The worst case delay (in ns) of this
16-bit adder will be __________
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 444
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE - 2011
3. A two-bit counter circuit is shown below.
J Q J Q
K ̅ K ̅
EE - 2006
1. A 4 1 MUX is used to implement a 3 –
CLK
input Boolean function as shown in figure.
The Boolean Function F(A,B,C) If the state of the counter at the
implemented is clock time t is “ ” the the state
of the counter at t (after three clock
A
cycles) will be
(A) 00 (C) 10
‘ ’ F (A, B, C) (B) 01 (D) 11
‘ ’
EE - 2013
4. The clock frequency applied to the digital
circuit show in the figure blow is 1 kHz. If
B C
(A) F (A,B,C) = (1,2,4,6) the initial state of the output Q of the flip
(B) F (A,B,C) = (1,2,6) – f p is ‘ ’ the the freque cy f the
(C) F (A,B,C) = (2,4,5,6) output wavefrom Q in kHz is
(D) F (A,B,C) = (1,5,6)
X Q
EE - 2008 T Q
2. A 3 line to 8 line decoder, with active low
outputs, is used to implement a CLK >
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 445
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
f ip f p
t
̅
f ip f p
f ip f p
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 446
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN - 2006 IN - 2007
1. Given that the initial state (Q1Q0) is 00, Statement for Linked Answer Questions 3 & 4
the counting sequence of the counter Consider the circuit shown in the following
shown in the following figure is, Q1Q0 = figure.
‘ ’
J0 Q J1 Q1
0
CLK ̅ ̅1
K0 K
0 1
(A) 00 11 01 10 00
(B) 00 01 11 10 00
(C) 00 11 10 01 00
(D) 00 10 01 11 00
3. The correct input-output relationship
2. A combinational circuit using a 8-to-1
between Y and ( , ) is
multiplexer is shown in the following
(A) Y= + (C) Y= ⨁
figure. The minimized expression for the
(B) Y= (D) Y= ⨁
output (Z) is
CLK
Identify the INCORRECT statement.
(A) (C)
(B) (D)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 447
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
6. A MUX circuit shown in the figure below 9. The output F of the multiplexer circuit
implements a logic function . The shown below expressed in terms of the
correct expression for is inputs P, Q and R is
Z 1 R I0
MUX out F1
̅ I1
4 1 MUX Y F
̅ 0
̅ I2
S
R I3 S1 S0
X 1
MUX out
0 F0 P Q
̅
(A) F=P⨁Q⨁R
S
Y (B) F = PQ + QR + RP
(C) F = (P ⨁ Q) R
(A) (̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅)⨁ (C) ⨁ ⨁̅
(D) F = (P ⨁ Q) ̅
(B) (̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅) ⨁ (D) ⨁ +Z
Q0 Q1 Q2
J Q J Q J Q J Q Q3 (A) 5 ns (C) 20 ns
Clock
KCLR KCLR KCLR K CLR
(B) 10 ns (D) 50 ns
IN - 2009
11. The figure below shows a 3-bit ripple
counter, with as the MSB. The flip-
̅̅̅̅̅̅̅ ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅ flops are rising-edge triggered. The
counting direction is
Q1
J Q 1 J Q 1 Q Q2
Y 1 J
Clock
7. In the above figure, Y can be expressed as CLK CLK CLK
(A) (C) 1 K ̅ 1 K ̅ 1 K ̅
(B) (D) (A) always down
(B) always up
8. The above circuit is a (C) up or down depending on the initial
(A) Mod – 8 Counter state of only
(B) Mod 9 Counter (D) up or down depending on the initial
(C) Mod – 10 Counter states of and
(D) Mod – 11 Counter
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 448
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
12. In the figure shown, the initial state of Q is 15. Consider the given circuit
0. The output is observed after the
application of each clock pulse. The
output sequence at Q is
1 J Q
CLOCK CLK
In this circuit, the race around
K ̅ (A) Does not occur
(B) Occurs when CLK = 0
(C) Occurs when CLK = 1 and A =B =1
(D) Occurs when clk = 1 and A = B = 0
(A) 0 0 0 0 . . . (C) 1 1 1 1 . . .
(B) 1 0 1 0 . . . (D) 1 0 0 0 . . . 16. The state transition diagram for the logic
circuit shown is
IN - 2011
13. The circuit below shows as up/down
counter working with a decoder and a x
flip-flop. Preset and clear of the flip-flop ̅ x
are asynchronous active-low inputs e ect
̅ ̅ ̅ ̅ ̅ ̅ ̅ ̅
3 to 8 Decoder
C B A(L.SB)
̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
reset Count
D Q Down
Flip-Flop Up/down Counter
Clock
c ear ̅
̅̅̅̅̅̅̅ Count Up
Clock
ECE/EE/IN - 2012
14. The output Y of a 2-bit comparator is logic
1 whenever the 2-bit input A is greater
than the 2-bit input B.
The number of combinations for which
the output is logic 1, is
(A) 4 (C) 8
(B) 6 (D) 10
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 449
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN - 2013 IN - 2014
17. The digital circuit shown below uses two 18. Frequency of an analog periodic signal in
negative edge- triggered D flip- flops. the range of 5 kHz - 10 kHz is to be
Assuming initial condition of and measured with a resolution of 100Hz by
as zero, the ouput of this circuit is measuring its period with a counter.
Assuming negligible signal and transition
delays the minimum clock frequency and
D1 D0 minimum number of bits in the counter
needed, respectively, are:
D-Flip-flop D-Flip-flop (A) 1 MHz, 10-bits
̅̅̅̅ ̅̅̅̅ (B) 10 MHz, 10-bits
(C) 1 MHz, 8-bits
(D) 10MHz, 8-bits
Clock
(A) 00, 01, 10, 11, ……
clock
(B) 00, 01, 11, 10, ……
(C) 00, 11, 10, 01, ……
(D) 00, 01, 11, 11, ……
ECE S = 1, ,C=1
1. [Ans. D]
When P is stuck at 1, f = A 4. [Ans. B]
B
f The i/p to first F/F = ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
The i/p to second F/F =
C 0 0 0 0 (initially
( ) [( )] at rest)
1st 0 0 1 1
2. [Ans. A] clk
Present State Next State 2nd 1 1 0 0
3rd 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 1 0 1 So sequence generated
0 1 1 1 1 1 00, 01, 10, 00
1 1 1 0 1 0
5. [Ans. C]
1 0 0 0 0 0
When X = 0, Y = 1 then P = 1 and Q = 0
So and X = 0, Y = 0 then P = 1 and Q = 1
X = 1, Y = 1 then P = 0 and Q = 1 or
3. [Ans. D] P = 1 and Q = 0
Before clock pulse S = C = 0
After first clock pulse A = B = 1 So 6. [Ans. A]
S = 0, C=1 Let the output of first MUX is Y
After second clock pulse A = B = 1 So Y = ̅B + A̅ = A ⨁ B
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 450
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 451
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
17. [Ans. D] ̅
Q(present) Q (next) y
0 0 1 1 1 1
1 1 0 1 0 1
0 1 1 0 1 0
1 0 0 0 0 0 ̅
⨀
̅̅̅̅ ̅̅̅̅
̅
18. [Ans. A]
Given Y=1, this implies
Both the output of D- flip flop
should be 1 i.e, input at first flip flop is 1 So wave form is correct
and for output of 2nd flip flop to be 1,
24. [Ans. D]
inverted output of first flip should be 1 in
This is a figure of Johnson counter
previous clock, for which input must be 0
So
so data is changing from 0 to 1.
19. [Ans. D] 0 0
From the CKT 1 0
0 is connected to & 1 1
d ‘ ’ is c ected t and 0 1
0 0
1 0
20. [Ans. *] Range 62.4 to 62.6 So =
.5 z
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 452
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
3. [Ans. C]
Clock Input Output
̅
Initial 1 0
state
1 1 0 1 1 1
utput f first ̅ ̅ 2 0 1 1 0 0
et 3 1 0 0 1 0
utput f sec d ̅ ̅
4. [Ans. B]
27. [Ans. C] X Q
T Q
̅ ̅̅ ̅̅̅ ̅ ̅ ̅̅
̅ ̅ ̅̅ CLK >
28. [Ans. A]
̅ From above Fig.
̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
̅ . ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
̅ ]
[
29. [Ans. C] ecause ̅ a ways
̅̅ ̅̅ ̅ ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
̅ a ways
̅ ̅ ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
̅ . ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
̅
̅̅̅̅
. ̅
30. [Ans. *] Range 194.9 to 195.1
i put a ways
Worst case propagation delay
r ‘ ’ f ip flop if input is =1 then output
= carry propagation delay of 15FA stages
will be complemented at the time of
+ max(carry Pd & sum Pd of last FA
triggering.
stage) CLK
5 5
5 s
T
EE
1. [Ans. A] 2T
F (A, B, C)= f .5 f
̅̅ ̅̅ ̅ ̅ .5
̅̅ ̅̅ ̅ ̅ ̅ .5 z
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 453
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
5. [Ans. D] IN
1. [Ans. A]
x Clock
( )
1 1 0 0
gate 1 1 1 1 1 1
1 1 0 0 0 1
6. [Ans. A]
1 1 1 1 1 0
Gray code output
1 1 0 0 0 0
0 0 0 2. [Ans. C]
o/p 0 0 1
0 0 0 1 1
0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 1 0
( )
1 1 1 1 1
1 0 1
1 0 1 ( )( )
When ̅
E utput
e ect i puts
utput 3. [Ans. B]
Y=
7. [Ans. A]
T-FF to JKFF is given by eq
4. [Ans. B]
̅
a d
This is implemented on options [A]
So initially it means
8. [Ans. C] so after one clock cycle
Let is initially high. Since is from will be 010.
will be high for time. The
waveform is shown below: 5. [Ans. D]
01 10, both = 1 so and
̅ both will toggle.
t
6. [Ans. B]
trigger
t
7. [Ans. A]
̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
Y = ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅ . ̅̅̅̅̅̅̅
t
= +
=
t
8. [Ans. C]
Whenever Y=1, then clear input of all the
s receives ‘ ’ a d utputs f the
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 454
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1 0 1
1 0 1
1
̅
13. [Ans. D]
Initially Q=0 and count up ( ̅ =1) is active next = . .
so it started counting up and when it = A.CLK + Q
reaches to 5 then decoder output at pin 5
next = A.CLK +
becomes 0 and preset will be active and it If CLK = 1 and A and B = 1
will set Q and it will make the counter
mode down and count becomes 4, then 3 then } No race around
then 2 then 1 then 0, as soon as it reaches If CLK = 1 and A = B = 0
0, decoder output at pin 0 is low and clear
is active and Q goes to 0 and ̅ = 1 so up is } No race around
active a d it c u ts ……
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 455
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
16. [Ans. D]
State table
A D
0 0 1 1
0 1 0 0
1 0 0 0
1 1 1 1
From State table
A=O
Q=O Q=1
A=O
A=1 A=1
17. [Ans. B]
State table
Present Next
state state
0 0 0 1 0 1
0 1 1 1 1 1
1 1 1 0 1 0
1 0 0 0 0 0
00, 01, 11, 10, 00
18. [Ans. C]
i c c freque cy
z z
5
i
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 456
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
AD /DA Convertor
= 6.2
Clock
(C)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 457
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Johnson
Clock
Counter
EE-2006
1. A student has made a 3 – bit binary down
(A) counter and connected to the R – 2R
ladder type DAC [Gain = ( 1 KΩ/2R)] as
shown in figure to generate a staircase
waveform. The output achieved is
different as shown in figure. What could
be the possible cause of this error?
R R R 1kΩ
(B) 2R +12V
2R 2R 2R
Vo
Counter 12V
1kHz
clock
10kΩ
7
6
(C) 5
4
3
2
1
0
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 ms
IN-2006
Common Data for Questions 1 and 2
ECE-2014 An R-2R ladder type DAC is shown below.
7. For a given sample-and-hold circuit, if the If a switch status is ‘0’ 0 is applied and if
value of the hold capacitor is increased, a switch status is ‘1’ 5 is applied to the
then corresponding terminal of the DAC.
(A) droop rate decreases and acquisition
time decreases
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 458
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN - 2010
+ 5. A 4-bit successive approximation type
5V
ADC has a full scale value of 15V. The
1. What is the output voltage (V0) for the sequence of the states, the SAR will
switch status S0=0,S1=1,S2=1? traverse, for the conversion of an input of
. 8.15V is
(A) V (C) V
(A) ( )
. tart tart
(B) V (D) V conversion conversion
1 0 0 0 1 0 0 0
2. What is the step size of the DAC?
(A) 0.125 V (C) 0.625 V 1 1 0 0 0 1 0 0
(B) 0.525 V (D) 0.75 V
1 0 1 0 0 0 1 0
IN-2007 1 0 0 1 0 0 0 1
3. The circuit shown in the figure below
1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
works as a 2-bit analog to digital
converter for 0 ≤ ≤3 . End End
3V conversion conversion
1.0kΩ Circuit 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 0
0 1 1 0 1 1 1 0
0.5kΩ
0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
1 0 0 0 1 1 1 1
End End
The MSB of the output , expressed as a conversion conversion
Boolean function of the inputs , , , is
given by
IN-2014
(A) (C)
6. A thermopile is constructed using 10
(B) (D) +
junctions of Chromel-Constantan
(sensitivity 60μ /°C for each junction)
IN-2009
connected in series. The output is fed to
4. An 8- it ADC with 2’s complement
an amplifier having an infinite input
output, has a nominal input range of 2V
impedance and a gain of 10. The output
to +2V. It generates a digital code of 00H
from the amplifier is acquired using a
for an analog input in the range
– 7.8125mV to +7.8125mV. An input of
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 459
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
10-bit ADC, with reference voltage of 5 V. DAC output and input to be positive, the
The resolution of this system in units of maximum error in conversion of the
°C is _________ analog sample value is:
Input tart of conversion
Comparator
ample ( C)
7. An N-bit ADC has an analog reference l
Control
voltage V. Assuming zero mean and l logic
uniform distribution of the quantization Reset l Clock
error, the quantization noise power will
l l
be: R 2R p
adder counter
(A) (C) DAC
( ) ( )
l
(B) (D) l utpt uffer
( ) √ Ena le
End of
l
l l Conversion
8. The circuit in the figure represents a (E C)
counter-based unipolar ADC. When SOC is (A) directly proportional to
asserted the counter is reset and clock is (B) inversely proportional to
l
enabled so that the counter counts up and (C) independent of
the DAC output grows. When the DAC (D) directly proportional to clock
output exceeds the input sample value, frequency
the comparator switches from logic 0 to
logic 1, disabling the clock and enabling
the output buffer by asserting EOC.
Assuming all components to be ideal,
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 460
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 461
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
i.e 2V → 128
.
2R 2R 2R
1.5V → 128 = 96
It is 96 for 1.5 analog input, while is
5 5
given an 96 = 2 complement of +96
= 2’s complement of 01100000
2R
=10100000
5 = A0H
≡ 2R
2
5
5. [Ans. A]
By characteristics of SAR ADC.
R
15 6. [Ans. * ] Range 0.800 to 0.833
≡
2
R For 10 junctions the thermopile voltage
will be 600 μ = 0.6 m
When it measured through amplifier of
∴ = gain 10, its voltage will be 6 mV. So, the
2. [Ans. C] thermopile sensitivity after amplification
Step size = = = 0.625 is 0.006 V/° C
Which will be input to ADC of resolution
3. [Ans. B] = /2 1
Truth table of ADC is ADC resolution = 5/1023=0.00488
In terms of temperature, the resolution is
0 0 0 0 0 0.00488/0.006=0.814
0 0 1 0 1
0 1 1 1 0 7. [Ans. A]
1 1 1 1 1
⇒ = 8. [Ans. A]
Maximum error is equal to step size
4. [Ans. D] which is directly proportional to .
8 – it ADC o/p is in 2’s complement form aximum Error =
i.e it represents 127 128 2 1
i/p voltage Range = 2 to 2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 462
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Semiconductor Memory
ECE-2014
1. If WL is the Word Line and BL is the Bit
Line, an SRAM cell is shown in ̅̅̅̅
̅̅̅̅
EE-2009
1. The increasing order of speed of data
access for the following devices is
i. Cache Memory
̅̅̅̅ ii. CDROM
iii. Dynamic RAM
iv. Processor Registers
v. Magnetic Tape
(A) (v), (ii), (iii), (iv), (i )
(B) (v), (ii), (iii), (i), (iv)
(C) (ii), (i), (iii), (iv), (v)
(D) (v), ( ii), (i) , (iii), (iv)
̅̅̅̅
IN-2011
1. An bit RAM is interfaced to an 8085
microprocessor. In a fully decoded Scheme
if the address of the last memory location
of this RAM is 4FFFH, the address of the
first memory location of the RAM will be,
(A) 1000 H (C) 3000 H
(B) 2000 H (D) 4000 H
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 463
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE
1. [Ans. B]
For an SRAM construction four MOSFETs
are required (2-PMOS and 2-NMOS) with
interchanged outputs connected to each
CMOS inverter. So option (B) is correct.
EE
1. [Ans. B]
Processor registers has highest speed.
Followed by cache memory then dynamic
ram (slower than static ram because of
refreshing required)
IN
1. [Ans. C]
Capacity of chip
= last memory address – First memory
address+1
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 464
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Microprocessors
ECE-2006 3. In the circuit shown, the device connected
1. An I/O peripheral device shown in to Y5 can have address in the range
Figure (b) below is to be interfaced to an
8085 microprocessor. To select the I/O
o de ice
device in the I/O address range D4 H - D7
hip e ec
H, its chip-select (̅̅̅) should be
o
connected to the output of the decoder
decode
shown in Figure (a) below.
0 ̅̅̅̅̅̅
A2 LSB 1
2 ̅̅̅̅̅̅
3 8
A3 3
Decoder 4 ̅
5
A4 MSB 6
7
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 465
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE-2008
̅̅̅̅̅
3. The contents (in Hexadecimal) of some of
the memory location in an 8085A based
system are given below
Address Contents
.. ..
(A) MVI A, F8H (C) OUT F8H 26FE 00
(B) IN F8H (D) LDA F8F8H 26FF 01
2700 02
6. n mic op oce o execu e “
2701 03
H” wi h a ing add e oca ion
2702 04
1FFEH (STA copies the contents of the
.. ..
accumulator to the 16-bit address
The contents of stack pointer (SP),
location). While the instruction is fetched
Program counter (PC) and (H, L) are
and executed, the sequence of values
2700H, 2100H and 0000H respectively,
written at the address pins is
when the following sequence of
(A) 1FH, 1FH, 20H, 12H
instruction are executed,
(B) 1FH, FEH, 1FH, FFH, 12H
2100 H: DAD SP
(C) 1FH, 1FH, 12H, 12H
2101 H: PCHL
(D) 1FH, 1FH, 12H, 20H, 12H
The contents of (SP) and (PC) at the end
of execution will be
EE-2006
(A) PC = 2102 H, SP = 2700 H
1. In an 8085 microprocessor based system,
(B) PC = 2700 H, SP = 2700 H
it is desired to increment the contents of
(C) PC = 2800 H, SP = 26 FE H
memory location whose address is
(D) PC = 2A02 H, SP= 2702 H
available in (D, E) register pair and store
the result in same location. The sequence
EE-2009
of instructions is
4. In an 8085 microprocessor, the contents
(A) XCH G (C) INXD
of the Accumulator, after the following
INRM XCH G
instructions are executed will become
(B) XCH G (D) INRM
XRA A
INXH XCH G
MVI B, F0H
SUB B
2. A software delay subroutine is written as
(A) 01 H (C) F0 H
given below:
(B) 0F H (D) 10 H
DELAY: MVI H, 255 D
MVI L, 255 D
EE-2010
LOOP: DCR L
5. hen a “ dd ” in uc ion i
JNZ LOOP
executed, the CPU carries out the
DCR H
following sequential operations
JNZ LOOP
internally:
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 466
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Note: EE-2014
(R) means content of register R 7. An output device is interfaced with 8-bit
((R)) means content of memory location microprocessor 8085A. The interfacing
pointed to by R circuit is shown in figure
PC means Program Counter
SP means Stack Pointer
(A) (SP) incremented ecode
(PC) Addr u pu o
((SP)) (PC)
(B) (PC) Addr
((SP)) (PC) ̅ u pu e ice
(SP) incremented ̅
̅̅̅̅̅
(C) (PC) Addr ̅
(SP) incremented The interfacing circuit makes use of 3
((SP)) (PC) Line to 8 Line decoder having 3 enable
(D) ((SP)) (PC) lines ̅ ̅ The address of the device
(SP) incremented is
(PC) Addr (A) (C)
(B) (D)
EE-2011
6. A portion of the main program to call a 8. In an 8085 microprocessor, the following
subroutine SUB in an 8085 environment program is executed
is given below. Address location - Instruction
: 2000H XRA A
: 2001H MVI B, 04H
LXI D, DISP 2003H MVI A, 03H
LP: CALL SUB 2005H RAR
: 2006H DCR B
: 2007H JNZ 2005
It is desired that control be returned to 200AH HLT
LP + DISP + 3 when the RET instruction At the end of program, register A contains
is executed in the subroutine. The set of (A) 60H (C) 06H
instructions that precede the RET (B) 30H (D) 03H
instruction in the subroutine are
(A) POP D (C) POP H 9. In 8085 microprocessor, the operation
DAD H DAD D performed by the instruction LHLD
PUSH D PUSH H is
(A) H
(B) POP H (D) XTHL
(B) H
DAD D INXD
(C) H
INX H INX D
(D) H
INX H INX D
INX H XTHL
IN-2006
PUSH H
1. An 8085 assembly language program is
given as follows. The execution time of
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 467
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
each instruction is given against the 4. A snapshot of the address, data and
instruction in terms of T-state. control buses of an 8085 microprocessor
Instruction T-states executing program is given below:
MVI B, 0AH 7T Address 2020H
LOOP: MVIC, 05H 7T Data 24H
DCR C 4T IO/ ̅ Logic high
DCR B 4T ̅̅̅̅ Logic high
JNZ LOOP 10T/7T ̅̅̅̅̅ Logic Low
The execution time of the program in The assembly language instruction being
terms of T-states is executed is
(A) 247 T (C) 254 T (A) IN 24H (C) OUT 24H
(B) 250 T (D) 257 T (B) IN 20H (D) OUT 20H
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 468
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
When this program halts, the accumulator (A) 3000H (C) AFFFH
contains (B) 4FFFH (D) C000H
(A) 00H (C) 70H
(B) 06H (D) 76H 11. The subroutine SBX given below is
executed by an 8085 processor. The value
8. Consider a system consisting of a in the accumulator immediately after the
microprocessor, memory, and peripheral execution of the subroutine will be:
devices connected by a common bus. SBX: MVI A, 99H
During DMA data transfer, the ADI 11H
microprocessor MOV C, A
(A) only reads from the bus RET
(B) only writes to the bus (A) 00H (C) 99H
(C) both reads from and writes to the (B) 11H (D) AAH
bus
(D) neither reads from nor writes to the IN-2014
bus 12. A microprocessor accepts external
interrupts (Ext INT) through a
IN-2010 Programmable Interrupt Controller as
9. In an 8085 processor, the main program shown in the figure.
calls the subroutine SUB1 given below.
When the program returns to the main dd e u x
program after executing SUB1, the value
x
in the accumulator is og ammab e
aa u n e up
Address Opcode Mnemonic con o e
2000 3E 00 SUB1: MVIA,00h x
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 469
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 470
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
4. [Ans. D] 8. [Ans. A]
XRA A ⇒ H XRA A → clear accumulator
MVI B, F0H ⇒ H MVI B, → B= H
SUB B ⇒ – B will go H
to accumulator H MVI A, → A= H
00 – F0 = 10 H
H RAR → Rotate accumulation
5. [Ans. D] to right A = 10000001
First of all content of PC is loaded into H DCR B → Decrement B, B=
stack. i.e. address of next instruction to be H INZ → ump o when
executed is loaded onto stack. i.e. SP is 2005 z
decremented then PC is loaded by 200 AH HLT
address given in call instruction. After 3 rotation
6. [Ans. C] H
Call take 3 address locations. RET always
returns to LP + 3 location, this stored in 9. [Ans. C]
SP. So to return to LP + DISP + 3 we have LHLD instruction loads the value at
to add DISP to SP. memory location specified by the
POP H immediate
DAD D Value in H and L pair register
PUSH H Value at will be stored in L register
Normal call operation shown. value of will be stored in H
register
CALL SUB IN
1. [Ans. C]
RET
2. [Ans. A]
7. [Ans. B] Since I/O device is memory mapped I/O
To enable decoder Memory related instructions will be
used for data transfer
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 471
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 472
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Electromagnetic Field
(
√
) (D) ∮ ∇ × ⃑ . ⃑⃑⃑ ∫ ∫ ⃑⃑⃑ . ⃑⃑⃑⃑
(B) ⃑ ŷ
√
( ) 6. Two infinitely long wires carrying current
(C) ⃑ ŷ
√
are as shown in the figure below. One
( )
(D) ⃑ ŷ wire is in the y-z plane and parallel to the
y-axis. The other wire is in the x-y plane
ECE - 2008 and parallel to the x-axis. Which
3. For static electric and magnetic fields in components of the resulting magnetic
an inhomogeneous source-free, medium field are non-zero at the origin?
z
which of the following represents the
corr ct form of two of Maxw ’s
equations? y
(A) ∇. (C) ∇×
∇×B ∇×B
(B) ∇. (D) ∇×
x
∇.B ∇.B
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 473
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE - 2010
7. If ⃑ x â ∮ ⃑ .
xyâ over the path
shown in the figure is,
y a
0 X
⁄ ⁄
ECE - 2013
√ √
11. Consider a vector field ⃑ r . The closed
(A) 0 (C) 1
loop line integral ∮ ⃑ can be expressed
(B) (D) √
√ as
(A) ∯ ∇ × ⃑ ⃑⃑⃑⃑s over the closed surface
ECE - 2011
bounded by the loop
8. Consider a closed surface S surrounding a
(B) ∰ ∇ ⃑ v over the closed volume
volume V. IF r is the position vector of a
bounded by the loop
point inside S, with ̂ the unit normal on
S, the value of the integral ∯ r. ̂ is (C) ∭ ∇ ⃑ v over the open volume
bounded by the loop
(A) 3V (C) 10V
(B) 5V (D) 15V (D) ∬(∇ × ⃑ ) ⃑⃑⃑⃑s over the open surface
bounded by the loop
ECE - 2012
ECE - 2014
Statement for Linked Answer Questions 9
12. In spherical co-ordinates, let â â denote
and 10
unit vectors along the , directions.
An infinitely long uniform solid wire of
radius a carries a uniform dc current of si cos t r â m
r
density .
And
.
9. The magnetic field at a distance r from the si cos t r â m
r
center of the wire is proportional to represent the electric and magnetic field
(A) r for r < a and 1/r2 for r > a components of the EM wave at large
(B) 0 for r < a and 1/r for r > a distances r from a dipole antenna, in free
(C) r for r < a and 1/r for r > a space. The average power (W) crossing
(D) 0 for r < a and 1/r2 for r > a the hemispherical shell located at
r m is _______.
10. A hole of radius b (b < a) is now drilled
along the length of the wire at a distance 13. If r xâ yâ zâ a |r| r
d from the center of the wire as shown th iv r ∇ r = ____________
below.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 474
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 475
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE - 2008 EE - 2013
7. A coil of 300 turns is wound on a non- 12. The curl of the gradient of the scalar field
magnetic core having a mean defined by x y y z 4z x is
circumference of 300 mm and a cross- (A) 4xya yza zxa
sectional area of 300 mm2. The (B) 4a a a
inductance of the coil corresponding to a (C) 4xy 4z a x yz a
magnetizing current of 3A will be y zx a
(Given that μ = 4 x 10-7 H/m) (D)
(A) 37.68 μH (C) 37. 68 μH
(B) 113.04 μH (D) 113. 04 μH
13. The flux density at a point in space given
8. A capacitor consists of two metal plates by B 4xa ya a m . The
each 500 × 500 mm2 and spaced 6 mm value of constant k must be equal to
apart. The space between the metal plates (A) 2 (C) +0.5
is filled with a glass plate of 4mm (B) 0.5 (D) +2
thickness and a layer of paper of 2 mm
thickness. The relative permittivities of 14. A dielectric slab with 500 mm x 500 mm
the glass and paper are 8 and 2 cross-section is 0.4 m long. The slab is
respectively. Neglecting the fringing subjected to a uniform electric field of
effect, the capacitance will be (Given that a a mm. The relative
= 8.85 x F/m) permittivity of the dielectric material is
(A) 983.33 pF (C) 637.5 pF equal to 2. The value of constant is
(B) 1475 pF (D) 9956.25 pF . × m . The energy stored in
the dielectric in Joules is
9. Two point charges = 10 μC and
(A) . × (C) .5
= 20μC are placed at coordinates (B) . × (D)
(1,1,0) and ( 1, 1,0) respectively, the
total electric flux passing through a plane EE - 2014
z = 20 will be 15. is the capacitance of a parallel plate
(A) 7.5 μC (C) 15.0 μC capacitor with air as dielectric (as in
(B) 13.5 μC (D) 22.5 μC figure (a)). If, half of the entire gap as
shown in figure (b) is filled with a
10. An extra high voltage transmission line of
dielectric of permittivity , the
the length 300 km can be approximated
expression for the modified capacitance is
by a lossless line having propagation
constant . radians per km. a
Then the percentage ratio of the length to
(A) ⁄ (C) ⁄
wavelength will given by (B) (D)
(A) 24.24% (C) 19.05%
(B) 12.12% (D) 6.06% 16. The following four vector fields are given
EE - 2012 in Cartesian co-ordinate system. The
11. The direction of vector A is radially vector field which does not satisfy the
outward from the origin, with | | r property of magnetic flux density is
where r x y z and k is a (A) y a z a x a
constant. The value of n for which ∇ A=0 (B) z a x a y a
is (C) x a y a z a
(A) 2 (C) 1 (D) y z a x z a x y a
(B) 2 (D) 0
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 476
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
17. A parallel plate capacitor consisting two 19. A hollow metallic sphere of radius r is
dielectric materials is shown in the figure. kept at potential of 1 Volt. The total
The middle dielectric slab is placed electric flux coming out of the concentric
symmetrically with respect to the plates. spherical surface of radius R r is
ot (A) 4 r (C) 4
(B) 4 r (D) 4
am s μ
B
4
z
Assuming right handed
coordinate
system, magnetic field intensity, ⃑⃑ at
coordinate (2,1,0) will be
̂w r m
4
B ̂ m
̂ m
m
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 477
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ECE B B
* +a
1. [Ans. D] μ x y
∇×
From stokes theorem
5. [Ans. B]
∮ . ∬( ). s rom sto ’s th or m
2. [Ans. A] ∮ ∮∇× s
z axis
iv ∇×
∮ ⃑ ⃑⃑⃑ ∬ ⃑ ⃑⃑⃑⃑s
x axis x axis
6. [Ans. D]
z
z axis
cos √ √
( )
y
cos
⃑ . . .
â x
√
⃑ . â â × â â
â × â â
3. [Ans. D] Non-zero field components x and z
rom Maxw ’s quatio
∇.B 7. [Ans. C]
∇× ⃑ xyâ x â
xâ yâ
For static magnetic field,
xâ yâ
∇×
⃑. xy x x y
y
4. [Ans. C]
∇×B μ S
3 R
∇×B
μ
a a a 1
P Q
|| ||
μ 0 X
B B ⁄ ⁄
√ √
B B P-Q: y=1 dy=0
* a a
μ z z ⁄ ⁄
√ x √
B B ∫ ⃑ . ⃑⃑⃑ ∫ x x |
( )a + ⁄
x y √ ⁄
√
Q-R:
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 478
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
x 11. [Ans. D]
√
By curl stroke theorem
4
∫ ⃑ . ⃑⃑⃑ ∫ ( ) y
√ ∮⃑ . c
R-S: ∬ ∇ × ⃑ . s ov r o surfac
Y=3 ,dy=0
⁄ ⁄√
√ 12. [Ans. *] Range 55.4 to 55.6
∫ ⃑ . ⃑⃑⃑ ∫ x x x |
⁄ ⁄√ In phasor notation
√
⃑ si â m
r
= ( ) .
⃑⃑ si â m
S-P: r
x= x So, average poynting vector is
√
⃑ (⃑ × ⃑⃑ )
∫ ⃑ . ⃑⃑⃑ ∫ ( ) y .
si si â
√ r r
.
si â
So, ∮ ⃑ . ∫ ⃑. ∫ ⃑ . ⃑⃑⃑ r
Average power crossing
∫ ⃑ . ⃑⃑⃑ ∫ ⃑ . ⃑⃑⃑
∫⃑ â r si
=1 ∫ . si
8. [Ans. D]
. ∫ si ∫
Apply the divergence theorem
.
∯ r. ⃑ x ∭ ∇. r
x x
r. ( ) ( ) ∫si cos
r r r
x x ∫si si
( )
r r
r
(r. ) ∫si cos
x x
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 480
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
3. [Ans. A] 9. [Ans. C]
Force = Net flux will be half of the total charge,
= = 15µC
Energy = = 0.835J
.
F= . 4 10. [Ans. D]
m . ra ia s m
4. [Ans. B]
wav gth 4 4 .
v .
√ ×
. i gth
f .4 u ( ) .
× wav gth 4 4 .
. u ×
× .
.
11. [Ans. A]
Length = 3× √ × × ⃑
× × . r ̂
=185 km ∇. ⃑ r . r
5. [Ans. A] . r
harg ’i radius r = × r .
r r
or ∇. ⃑
r
r r
r
12. [Ans. D]
6. [Ans. A] cur [∇ sca ar]
iv rg c ∇.
13. [Ans. A]
=
cos xy yx si xy ∇. B 4x y
x y z
cos xy y si xy cos z . z 4
zcos z
14. [Ans. B]
7. [Ans. B]
L= 15. [Ans. A]
× × × Case (i)
=
×
= 113.09µH
8. [Ans. B] h
C=
. × × × × ×
= 4.4nF
×
. × × × ×
×
.
C = 1.467nF
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 481
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
.h
gio
h
.
4
Case(ii)
h
( )
.h
18. [Ans. C]
h
[ ]
m t r
am s
16. [Ans. C]
̅ magnetic flux density [w sourc
If B m ] m t r
̅
∇. B
̅ B â
i. . if B B â B â
̅
∇. B
4 am s
B B B
Must qua to z ro sourc
x y z
̅
Option (A) : ∇. B ̅
B ̅
B ̅
B
̅
Option (B) : ∇. B
μ 4 m s 4μ
̅
Option (C) : ∇. B x y z ̅
B ̂ ̂w m
̅
Option (D) : ∇. B
μ am s μ
̅
B ( ̂) ̂w m
17. [Ans. C] μ
̅
B ̂w m
̅
B μ
⃑⃑ ̂ am m
̅ ̅ = cross product of
Note: Direction of B
current direction and radial drections
respectively [Biot – savart’s aw]
4 4
gio
4
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 482
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
19. [Ans. A] × √ √
⃑ â â
4 |r | |r |
|r̅ | |r̅ | √ 4 √
(√ √ )
â
√
√ √
√
(√ √ )
â
The net flux leaving any closed surface is √
equal to charge enclosed in it √ √
Total electric flux leaving the √
co c tric s h r of ra ius ‘ ’ charg √ √ √ √ √
⃑ * +
co tai y th m ta s h r of ra ius ‘r’ √ √
ot tia at a oi t o m ta ic s h r
̅ √ [ 4̂]
4 r
̅ ̂ wto ⁄ o um
4 r
iv ot
4 r
(flux ) leaving the sphere of radius
‘ ’ 4 r
20. [Ans. B]
Method of image:
A perfect conducting plate acts like a
mirror for the existing charge by the
introduction of virtual charge opposite to
the existing charge and equivalent distant
from it
z axis
√ X
r̅
ou om s
√ √
r̅
√
ou om s
X
⃑ ⃑ ⃑ imag
√ √
⃑ â â
4 |r | |r |
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 483
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(B) 5.5 % rdg (D) 7.0 % rdg Let be the difference between and
the measured voltage is function of
IN-2006
(A) only (C)
1. A certain quantity x is calculated from
(B) only (D)
measured values of a, b, and c using the
formula, IN-2009
x=k( ) Where k is a constant. 4. A quantity x is calculated by using the
The maximum limiting error in each of formula x = (p q)/r, the measured
the three measured quantities is Δ values are p = 9, q = 6, r = 0.5. Assume
The maximum limiting error in x will be that the measurement errors in p, q and r
are independent. The absolute maximum
(A) 2(| | | |) | |
error in the measurement of each of the
(B) (| | | |) | | three quantities is . The absolute
maximum error in the calculated value of
(C) ( ) | |
x is
(D) ( ) | | (A) (C)
(B) (D) 6
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 484
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 485
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE ( )
1. [Ans. A]
Considering only positive values of error
Nominal ratio
( )
Primary current 6 A
Actual ratio = n ( ) i =( )
= 7%
% Ratio error =
IN
1. [Ans. A]
Actual ratio
Given X = K ( )
n trun ratio
Let Y =
( ) ii
X=K.Y
when no. of secondary is reduced by 1 Applying log on both sides
log X = log K + log Y
n log K = 0 ( K is constant)
n ( ) = log Y
= 2 log
( ) iii = 2 *| | | |+
Dividing eq. (ii) and (iii)
2. [Ans. B]
For the case given, the smallest error is
( )
3. [Ans. C]
Measured voltage
atio rror
v v
2. [Ans. D] v
learly f( )
Given, w = . v
Taking log on both sides,
log w = log x + log y – log z
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 486
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
s d D
lim d √( ) ρ L ( ) D
dρ D
s s
s s d ρ L D
s √( ) ( ) ( )
lim ρ L D
s s
√
6. [Ans. A]
Volume = r h
h = 0.2, 2r=0.1
= 1%
= 1%
7. [Ans. B]
dy i o
y t y t
dt p p
Applying Laplace transform
3s Y(s) + 5Y(s) = 8X(s)
Y(s) [3s+5] = 8X(s)
s
s s s
s 6
s ( s) s
8. [Ans. B]
By Gaussian distribution, the expected
Measurement are 115.
9. [Ans. A]
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 487
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1.6V
8. An LPF wattmeter of power factor 0.2 is
having three voltage settings 300 V, 150 V
and 75 V, and two current settings 5 A
and 10 A. The full scale reading is 150. If 100Ω
Eu
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 489
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
5. A voltmeter has a range of [4 V, 20 V] and 9. The op-amp based circuit of a half wave
a resolution of 1 mV. The dynamic range is rectifier electronic voltmeter shown
(A) 24 dB (C) 72 dB below uses a PMMC ammeter with a full
(B) 60 dB (D) 84 dB scale deflection (FSD) current of 1 mA
n oil re i n e of 1k . The v lue of
IN-2007 R that gives FSD for a sinusoidal input
6. The figure shows a potentiometer of total voltage of 100 mV (RMS) is
resistance with a sliding contact.
Sinusoidal
input 1k
PMMC
Ammeter
P
+
RL
R
Q
The resistance between the points P and (A) (C) 1
Q of the potentiometer at the position of (B) 7. (D) 1 .
the contact shown is and the voltage
ratio at this point is 0.5. If the ratio Statement for Linked Answer Question for
10 and 11
=1, the ratio is
In the wheatstone bridge shown below
(A)
√ (C) 1+√ the galvanometer G has a current
sensitivity of 1 mm a resistance of
(B)
√ (D) 1+√
2.5 k and a scale resolution of 1 mm. let
be the minimum increase in R from its
IN-2008 nominal value of 2 that can be
7. If a current of [ √ in(1 ) detected by this bridge.
√ o ( ⁄ ) √ ]A is
k k
passed through a true RMS ammeter, the
meter reading will be 1
(A) 6√ (C) 12A k
(B) √1 (D) √ 1
10. When R is 2 k is
8. A 2A full-scale PMMC type dc ammeter
(A) 6 V (C) 6.0038 V
has a voltage drop of 100 mV at 2A. The (B) 6.0024 V (D) 6.005 V
meter can be converted into a 10A full-
scale dc ammeter by connecting a 11. The value of is approximately
(A) 1 . m re i or in p r llel wi h he (A) . (C) .
meter (B) . (D) 1
(B) 1 . m re i or in erie wi h he
meter
(C) . m re i or in p r llel wi h he
meter
(D) . m re i or in erie wi h he
meter
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 490
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN-2011 EE/IN-2012
18. In the Wheatstone bridge shown below, 20. An analog voltmeter uses external
when the resistance in re e by 1 multiplier settings. With a multiplier
the current through the galvanometer is setting of 20 k it reads 440 V and with a
multiplier setting of 80 k, it reads 352 V.
1k 1k For a multiplier setting of 40 k the
voltmeter reads
10V G
(A) 371V (C) 394V
S1 1k (B) 383V (D) 406V
1k 1k
IN-2013
(Consider the Thevenin equivalent
21. The circuit below incorporates a
resistance of the bridge in the
permanent magnet coil milli-ammeter of
calculations)
range 1 mA having a series resistance of
(A) 1.25 µA (C) 12.5 µA
10 k . Assuming constant diode forward
(B) 2.5 µA (D) 25 µA
re i n e of forw r io e rop
of 0.7 V and infinite reverse diode drop of
IN-2012
1.7 V and infinite reverse diode resistance
19. A periodic voltage waveform observed on
for each diode, the reading of the meter in
an oscilloscope across a load is shown. A
mA is
permanent magnet moving coil (PMMC)
meter connected across the same load mA
reads +
v(t) 1 k
10V
5V 1 k
z
0 10 12 20 time (ms)
5
(A)v 4V (C) 8V (A) 0.45 (C) 0.7
(B) 0.5 (D) 0.9
(B) 5V (D) 10V
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 492
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
25A
1 1 1
.
. 1
3. [Ans. A] 1 1 1
( . 1) ( )
Area enclosed
(1 )(1 ) ( )( ) ( )( ) = 80 . 1
Time period = 20
Average reading = 7. [Ans. *] Range 9.9 to 10.3
Ammeter X
4. [Ans. D] 1 1 1. (1 .1 )
. 1
Because voltage drop across inductor 1 1 m
Because voltage drop across capacitor
j – 1
Net voltage j j 1.
j
Voltmeter reads magnitude of the voltage
only Ammeter Y
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 493
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(1 . ) 1. . IN
. 1. [Ans. B]
1 0.2 = 1
250 mA
I=
√
1. and I =
√
.71 k
.71 k
1 (x)
2. [Ans. D]
1. h1 1.
h
1.6 V
I
250 150 oop 1
1
mA mA
(1 )
(x) 1
1.
. oop
1. 1
. 1 Ig
1 .
(x) 1 .1 1 1
. 7
Applying KVL in Loop 1, we get
8. [Ans. 2] 1.6 – 100I 500I – 1000 (I + Ig)=0
In LPF wattmeter, T on the moving 1.6 – 1000Ig=1600I
system is small owing to low power factor 1.6 – 1 1 1
even when the current and potential coils 1. . 1
9.9 7 1
are fully excited. Also the errors 1
introduced due to inductance of pressure Now in loop 2,
coil tend to be large at low power factors. 1 1 ( )
So for calculating multiplying factor for a 1 1 1 1 1
low p.f. wattmeter, p.f. mentioned on the 9.9 7 1
wattmeter should be taken into account. 11 1 .99 7
Therefore, Multiplying Factor . 11 .99 7
= (Current range used*Voltage range 1. 7
used*p.f)/Power at FSD 1.
Given, Power at Full scale reading = 150
Current Range used = 10 A 3. [Ans. B]
Voltage Range used = 150 V Total resistance of voltmeter is
Power Factor = 0.2 =( )(1 ) k
1 1 . So equivalent circuit is
Therefore m
1 + I
+
9. [Ans. A] 80 V 100
100 k
M.I instrument reads RMS value +
V 20 V k
1 1
√1 ( ) √1 √
20 V
√
th
.. th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 494
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
I= = 0.8 mA ( )( )
1
And = 0.4 mA
bu (Given)
∴ ( ) = (0.8 – 0.4) = 0.4 mA ∴( )( )
∴ k ∴
.
Divide above equation on both sides with
4. [Ans. C]
. .9 .
1 1 ( ) ( ) 1
.
.
∴ . .9 1 .9 1 √1 1 √
∴
( . )( )
( .9 )(1 ) 1 Here resistances cannot has negative
[ , since diodes are ideal] value.
9.9 1 √
Therefore
5. [Ans. D]
r nge
e olu ilon 7. [Ans. C]
(level )
( ) √ ( ) ( )
1 √ √
1m
n 1 .9 1 bits (as number of bit can √( √ ) (
√
) (
√
)
√ √
never be fraction) dynamic range = 6
= 12 A
n = 84 dB
8. [Ans. A]
6. [Ans. A]
Meter
10A
( ) 2A
P
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 495
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1 1 1 12. [Ans. A]
1 1
∴
1 1 1m
So in order to measure 1 V (maximum)
10. [Ans. B] we have to connect a series resistance R1
such that
k k 1
1 9
Now to increase voltage range to 10V, we
( ) have to add another external resistance
k
R2 such that
1 1 ( ) 1
1 9 1
Bridge can detect a change in R if
9 9k
galvanometer deflections.
If change in R is minimum, then
13. [Ans. B]
minimum deflection in galvanometer
With switch open redrawing the circuit
should be 1 mm for detection as 1 mm is
i ’ re olu ion. o for this 1𝜇 current 10 mA
must flow through it.
i. e. 1 1 .
Now in outer loop,
1 1 1 ( )
+ +
1 1 1
1 1 1 1 5m
1 . 1
ol ge rop ro i
1 .99 1
250 ×10mA = 2.5V
So, 1 ( )
So the voltage drop across 5m long
1 (1 1. 99 1 )
resistance is (3 – 2.5) = 0.5V
= 0.004 + 5.9984 = 6.0024 V
∴ Resistance of 5 m long wire is
.
=
11. [Ans. B]
Writing KVL in inner loop we get, ∴ m orre pon o n he
1 . 1 voltage drop across it is 20 × 10 m = 0.2V
1 . .997 Redrawing the circuit with switch (s)
.99 m closed
Writing KVL in another inner loop we get 3V
10 mA
( ) ( ) . .
. 9
( )
( .99 . ) 1
2m 3m
.
0.2V 0.3V 2.5V +
.
+
A
( )
G
B 1
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 496
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
15. [Ans. C]
Here, the waveform seen by the ammeter is Thevenin equivalent circuit across AB.
( . )
vg . 9 m
(1 1 ) (1 1. 1 )
V(t) = 1 sin 314 t 1.
. 9 m
= 0.1m
r (1. 1)1
i(t) = (0.1m) sin (314 t)
1.
∴
Here, = 0.1m I
( . ) A
∴ 63.7µA
r
16. [Ans. D]
G
Assuming spring control
∝ for d.c
∝ for a.c
∴ 19. [Ans. A]
.
As PMMC meter reads only DC value or
= 2.1213 A average value and average value is equal
√ √
( . ) to
∴
re un er he urve
⟹ 9
To l ime
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 497
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1
( 1 1 ) ( ) ( )
ol
21. [Ans. A]
Current in the inverting arm
20. [Ans. D]
or ul iplier e ing k √
.7 7 m
Meter resistance = x 1
PMMC measures the average value
Total resistance = k x
.7 7
Voltmeter reading ( )
∝ x
. m
k
V x
1
∝
or ul iplier e ing
Meter resistance = x
Total resistance ( ) k x
Voltmeter reading ( )= 352 V
k
V x
∝ x
1
∝
x
x
( x) ( x)( )
x x
x 1
x k
or mul iplier e ing k
Total Resistance
( ) k
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 498
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 499
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
+ IN-2007
+
2. A dynamometer type wattmeter with a
single scale marked for the smallest
power range, has two current ranges,
(A) 56.02 (C) 29.85 namely, 0-5 A and 0-10 A as well as two
(B) 40.83 (D) 10.02 voltage ranges, namely, 0-150 V and
0-300 V. To carry out a load test on a
EE-2014 230V/115V, 1kVA, single phase
8. Power consumed by a balanced 3-phase, transformer, the wattmeter is used on the
3-wire load is measured by the two high voltage side. The voltage and current
wattmeter method. The first wattmeter ranges are chosen for maximum
reads twice that of the second. Then the utilization of the scale. The multiplying
load impedance angle in radians is factor to be used in this case is.
(A) 12 (C) 6 (A) 0.5 (C) 2.0
(B) 8 (D) 3 (B) 1.0 (D) 4.0
35 Ω
IN-2011
( ) 4. Power in a there phase star connected
balanced inductive load is measured by
105 Ω 01
two wattmeter method. The phase
voltage and phase current are 230 V and
5 A, respectively. The power factor of the
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 500
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE/IN-2012
5. For the circuit shown in the figure, the
voltage and current expressions are
v(t) = ( )+ (3 ) a d ( )
= sin ( )+ (3 - +) +
(5 )
i(t)
+
Load
V(t) wattmeter
(A) cos
(B) [ + + ]
(C) [ + ]
(D) [ + ]
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 501
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
= 4 120
= = 400 120
= 4 +120 400 120 240 14
= 800 w
14 14 100
= = 14
3. [Ans. B] 101
It is difficult to have purely resistive 14
= = 4 46
pressure coil. The pressure coil has a
small value of inductance, due to which ( PMMC reads average voltage)
error occurs in wattmeter readings.
7. [Ans. C]
4. [Ans. D] During the normal condition
Considering the wattmeter to be an ideal
300
wattmeter and as PC is connected 300
+
across . So option D.
300 300
5. [Ans. B]
I+
Current coil Compensating coil = 600 20
= 12
= = 6 02985
Supply
Load
= 6 = 0 02985
= 29 85
The current coil carries a current of l +
and produces a filed corresponding to this
8. [Ans. C]
current. The compensating coil is
= √3 (30 )
connected in series with the pressure coil
= √3 (30 + )
circuit and is made as nearly as possible
( )
identical and coincident with the current a = √3
( )
coil. It is so connected that it opposes the =2
field of the current coil. The compensating 1
coil carries a current and produces a a = =
√3 6
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 502
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 503
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
j
EE-2010
~ 6. he Maxwell’s bridge shown in the figure
(A) First adjust R4 and then adjust R1 is at balance. The parameters of the
(B) First adjust R2 and then adjust R3 inductive coil are
(C) First adjust R2 and then adjust R4 jω
(D) First adjust R4 and then adjust R2
EE-2008
j ω
3. The ac Bridge shown in the figure is used
to measure the impedance Z. If the bridge
is balanced for oscillator frequency
~
(A)
f = 2 kHz, then the impedance Z will be
(B)
B
. 98μF (C)
Oscillator 5 ~ (D)
A D C
15.91 mH
Z j
D
(A) (260+j0) (C) j
(B) j (D) j
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 504
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE-2011 IN-2006
7. A 4 digit DMM has the error 1. Consider the AC bridge shown below. If
| |
specification as: 0.2% of reading +10 ω and ⁄ . then ration | |
counts. If a dc voltage of 100 V is read on is approximately equal to
its 200 V full scale, the maximum error
that can be expected in the reading is
(A) ± 0.1% (C) ± 0.3%
(B) ± 0.2% (D) ± 0.4%
~ IN-2007
2. Consider the AC bridge shown in the
figure below, with A, L and C having
(A) low resistance (C) low Q inductor positive finite values.
(B) high resistance (D) lossy capacitor
EE-2014 ~
sinωt
9. The reading of the voltmeter (rms) in
volts, for the circuit shown in the figure is
____________ (A) if ω ω
.5 (B) if
(C) if
√
j 1/j (D) cannot be made zero
sin ωt
IN-2008
j j
3. If the ac bridge circuit shown below is
balanced the elements Z can be a
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 505
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE/IN-2012
5. The bridge method commonly used for For obtaining balance z should consist of
finding mutual inductance is element(s):
(A) Heaviside Campbell bridge (A) R and C (C) L and C
(B) Schering bridge (B) R and L (D) Only C
(C) De Sauty bridge
(D) Wien bridge
EE 2. [Ans. C]
1. [Ans. B]
x ω and x
ω
R1 R3 z jx jω
i1 i3
z
D
i2 i4 z
j
R2 R4 z jx
ω
Under balanced condition
z z z z
Battery jω jx
Adjustments are made in various arms of ( ) j [ω ]
the bridge so that the voltage across the ω
detector is zero and hence no current Equating real and imaginary terms, we
flows through it, when no current flows obtain
through detector the bridge is said to be
balanced.
At balance condition ω
ω
Solving above equations, we get
and
ω
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 506
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ω 4. [Ans. B]
ω Single slope integrating type ADC utilizes
Q factor of the coil Q = digital counter techniques to measure
time required for a voltage ramp to rise
Therefore . from zero to the input voltage.
( )
If conversion time for input voltage
and 5V = TA
( )
So, conversion time for input voltage
For a value of a greater than 10, the term 2.5 V = TA /2
(1/Q)2 will be smaller than 1/1000 and Conversion time in successive type ADC
can be neglected does not depend on input voltage. So,
Therefore eq. (1) and (2) reduces to conversion time for input voltage 2.5 V is
also TB.
ω .
R4 appears only in eq. (4) and R2 appears 5. [Ans. A]
in both eq. (3) &(4) For triangular wave
So first R2 is adjusted and then R4 is Avg value =
adjusted.
RMS value =
√
3. [Ans. A] ∴
B C= . 98 μF
RMS value =
5 √ √
RBC=300
Oscillator
6. [Ans. A]
~ A D
L=15.1 mH
C
R+jω
RAD Z
300
D
j ω
5
~
jω jω
.
j
jω ‖( )
j 5.9 ‖( )
At balance
j
At balance
jω ( )
jω jω
jω jω
Equating real and imaginary terms,
ω ω
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 507
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 508
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
ω ω 3. [Ans. A]
ω ω At balance,
ω ω ω ( )
[ ] ( )( )
ω ω ω
ω
j
ω () j
ω
ω
et j
ω
ω Comparing the real and imaginary parts
we get
ω
X=0
ω ( ) j
and ( ) j
ω
ω ω
∴ is purely capacitive.
.
∴ It can be neglected in comparison to 2 4. [Ans. B]
Error on reading 100 mV
.
m .5 m
Also, error due to 5 counts
2. [Ans. D] 5m .5 m
For bridge must be balanced 999
Hence, total error = 0.5 + 0.5 = 1.0 mV
( ) jω ∴ Meter will read between (100 – 1) mV
jω
j and (100+1) mV.
( ) jω ie. Between (99.0 mV and 101 mV)
ω
j ω j
ω 5. [Ans. A]
Comparing the imaginary parts as real Heaviside campbell bridge method is
parts are already equal commonly used for finding mutual
inductance.
ω
ω
√ 6. [Ans. B]
ω
√ At balanced condition,
∴ frequency is coming to be imaginary
which is impossible, hence, cannot be jω
made zero.
jω
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 509
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE-2006 EE-2008
1. The time/div and voltage/div axes of an 3. Two sinusoidal signals ( t) = A sin t
oscilloscope have been erased. A student and q( t) are applied to X and Y inputs
connects a 1 kHz, 5V p-p square wave of a dual channel CRO. The Lissajous
calibration pulse to channel 1 of the scope figure displayed on the screen is shown
and observes the screen to be as shown in below:
the upper trace of the figure. An The signal q( t)will be represented as
unknown signal is connected to channel 2 Y
(lower trace) of the scope. If the time/div
and V/div on both channels are the same,
the amplitude (p-p) and period of the
unknown signal are respectively
X
(B) 5 V, 2 ms (D) 10 V, 1 ms
EE-2009
EE-2007 4. The two inputs of a CRO are fed with two
2. The probes of a nonisolated, two channel stationary periodic signals. In the X-Y
oscilloscope are clipped to points A, B and mode, the screen shows a figure which
C in the circuit of the adjacent figure. changes from ellipse to circle and back to
is a square wave of a suitable low ellipse with its major axis changing
frequency. The display on h and h are orientation slowly and repeatedly. The
as shown on the right. Then the “Signal” following inference can be made from
and “Ground” probes S G and S G this.
of h and h respectively are connected (A) The signals are not sinusoidal
to points: (B) The amplitudes of the signals are
very close but not equal
A B h
(C) The signals are sinusoidal with their
R
L G frequencies very close but not equal
(D) There is a constant but small phase
C h
difference between the signals
(A) A, B, C, A (C) C, B, A, B
(B) A, B, C, B (D) B, A, B, C
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 510
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE-2011 (C)
5. A dual trace oscilloscope is set to operate
in the alternate mode. The control input
of the multiplexer used in the y-circuit is
fed with a signal having a frequency equal
to
(A) the highest frequency that the
multiplexer can operate properly
(B) twice the frequency of the time base
(sweep) oscillator
(C) the frequency of the time base
(sweep) oscillator
(D) half the frequency of the time base
(sweep) oscillator
EE-2014
6. In an oscilloscope screen, linear sweep is
applied at the IN-2007
(A) vertical axis 1. The linear sweep for the time base in an
(B) horizontal axis oscilloscope has deviation from its
(C) origin nominal waveform. The nominal
(D) both horizontal and vertical axis (dashed line) and actual (solid line)
sweep waveforms are shown in the
7. The two signals S and S , shown in following figure.
Normal Retrace
figure, are applied to Y and X deflection
plates of an oscilloscope. Sweep
S start
time Actual
T T
t 1.1T
1.3T
time 1.15T
T
S
A 5V p-p sine wave with a frequency of
1 kHz will be measured on the
T T oscilloscope as a sine wave with
t
(A) 4.45 V p-p and 1 kHz frequency
(B) 5 V p-p and 1kHz frequency
The waveform displayed on the screen is
(C) 5 V p-p and 1.1 kHz frequency
(D) 5 V p-p and 1.15 kHz frequency
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 511
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
IN-2008
3. The x and y sensitivities of an analog
oscilloscope are set as 2 ms/cm and
1V/cm respectively. The trigger is set at
0V with negative slope. An input of
cos 00π t 300) V is fed to the y input of
the oscilloscope. The waveform seen on
Which of the following figures correctly
the oscilloscope will be
depicts the trace seen in channel 2?
(A)
(B)
(P)
(C)
(D)
(Q)
IN-2009
4. The figure shows a periodic waveform to
be displayed on a CRO. A trigger setting
which ensures a stationary display is
2.5
2
(R) 1.5
1
0.5
0
-0.5
-1
-1.5
-2
-2.5
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 512
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(C)
(D)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 513
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE
1. [Ans. C]
Peak-peak (p – p) division of upper trace
voltage = 2 value of (p – p) voltage = 5 V
. division 0 t
Now it will be same for unknown voltage
So, S is connected to point A and G is
(p – p) division of unknown voltage = 3
connected to point B.
p – p voltage = 3 2.5 = 7.5 V
Frequency of upper trace = 1 kHz Voltage across inductor =
Time period = = 1 ms d
[ ( e )]
dt
Division of x – axis (upper) = 4
Division of x – axis (lower) = 8 e
Period of unknown signal = 2 ms.
2. [Ans. B]
t
Square wave is of low frequency. So, it can
be assumed that time during which the
t
wave form are displayed on the screen,
the voltage across R and L is .
A B So, S is connected to point C.
and G is connected to point B.
L
i(t)
3. [Ans. D]
C Here p( t) = A sin t
s y line cuts 4 times the Lissagous patter
s
s x line cuts 2 times the Lissagous patter
s y
s (s )
x
( ) x
s s
s ( )
s s
I(t) ( e )
Voltage across resistance
i t e
4. [Ans. C] S
Because of phase difference only figure
change from ellipse to circle and back to
ellipse
t
0
5. [Ans. D]
Alternate mode is used to display two
wave forms simultaneously by single CRT. xy node
As fluorescent material stores light for y
some time and eye sensing time is 20 ms.
By using multiplexer alternatively two
waves are connected to y plates. In this
mode the frequency of control signal to
x
multiplexer is equal to half off X – time
base generator. In one sweep displays 1st
waveform and in the half record sweep
displays 2nd waveform connected to
Y – plates. For low frequency signals
multiplexer is switches at high frequency Vector sum (in x y)
signals multiplexer is switches at high Points y y √x y Φ tan ( )
frequency that the multiplexer can A 0 1 1 0
operate. This is called chopping mode. B 1 1 2 45°
C 0 0 0 0
~ X0
Y
time D 2 225°
X1 base
S IN
1. [Ans. C]
S It is clear from the figure that there is no
change in amplitude,
6. [Ans. B] So it will show 5 V peak.
⇒ Also amplitude is function of Y – plates
7. [Ans. A] so no change.
S ⇒ But here slope during sweep will
change and that will responsible for
change frequency.
⇒ Slope is degraded by a factor 1.1, so
t frequency will be multiplied by 1.1
T
(as f ∝ 1/T).
So f = 1 . . kHz.
2. [Ans. B]
As the two channel signals have same
frequency, phase and the trigger level is
set to 1.25 V which is below the
peak – peak voltage of input signals
(5V and 2V). So an identical trace appears
on channel 2 also
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 515
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
3. [Ans. A] 6. [Ans. A]
X- sensitivity = 2 msec/ cm = Sx Vy(t) = 4 cos 00πt
Y-sensitivity = 1 V/cm = Sy is set as is set as .
For input peak voltage, =4V
Internal triggering is chosen trigger
So length on Y-axis from peak to peak. voltage level is 0V & Slope is positive
l c screen dimensions are 10div 8div
S
Number of cycles of signal displayed
⇒T f T
0 sec 00 z 0div s div
T/2 = 0 sec cycle
Now half cycle on X- axis correspond to The test signal is used as triggering
length, signal since internal triggering is chosen.
T 0 sec As the trigger voltage level is 0V, the
l c
S sec c signal will be displayed from 0V onwards
This is shown in figure (A) only. and from rising side since trigger slope, is
[Hint:- Negative slope is given] positive.
Therefore option is ‘A’
4. [Ans. C]
Hint: The signal is given with rising edge 7. [Ans. D]
so the slope will be +ve and only option When is +ve
(C) satisfies this criteria.
[2 Division × 2V/division = 4 V]
5. [Ans. A] 0
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 516
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
7. Two regional systems, each having 9. The total reactance and total susceptance
several synchronous generators and loads of a lossless overhead EHV line, operating
are interconnected by an ac line and a at 50 Hz, are given by 0.045 pu and 1.2 pu
HVDC link as shown in the figure. Which respectively. If the velocity of wave
of the following statements is true in the propagation is km/s, then the
steady state: approximate length of the line is
(A) 122 km (C) 222 km
(B) 172 km (D) 272 km
EE-2008
HVDC link
Region 1 Region 2 10. An extra high voltage transmission line of
length 300 km can be approximated by a
AC line lossless line having propagation constant
=0.00127 radians per km. Then the
percentage ratio of line length to
(A) Both regions need not have the same wavelength will be given by
frequency (A) 24.24% (C) 19.05%
(B) The total power flow between the (B) 12.12% (D) 6.06%
regions ( + ) can be changed by
controlling the HVDC converters 11. A lossless transmission line having Surge
alone Impedance Loading (SIL) of 2280 MW is
(C) The power sharing between the ac provided with a uniformly distributed
line and the HVDC link can be series capacitive compensation of 30%.
changed by controlling the HVDC Then, SIL of the compensated
converters alone. transmission line will be
(D) The direction of power flow in the (A) 1835 MW (C) 2725 MW
HVDC link ( ) cannot be reversed. (B) 2280 MW (D) 3257 MW
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 518
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Line
~
end
Conductor
(A) The magnitude of terminal voltage (A) e = 3.74 kV, e = 2.61 kV
decreases, and the field current does (B) e = 3.46 kV, e = 2.89 kV
not change. (C) e = 6.0 kV, e = 4.23 kV
(B) The magnitude of terminal voltage (D) e = 5.5 kV, e = 5.5 kV
increases, and the field current does
not change. EE-2011
(C) The magnitude of terminal voltage 18. A nuclear power station of 500 MW
increases, and the field current capacity is located at 300 km away from a
increases. load center. Select the most suitable
(D) The magnitude of terminal voltage power evacuation transmission
does not change, and the field configuration among the following
current decreases. options.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 519
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 520
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
The contributions of S and S in 100 A 28. A 183-bus power system has 150 PQ
current supplied at location P buses and 32 PV buses. In the general
respectively, are case, to obtain the load flow solution
(A) 75 A and 25 A (C) 25 A and 75 A using Newton-Raphson method in polar
(B) 50 A and 50 A (D) 0 A and 100 A coordinates, the minimum number of
simultaneous equations to be solved
25. Shunt reactors are sometimes used in is______________
high voltage transmission systems to
(A) Limit the short circuit current 29. The complex power consumed by a
through the line. constant-voltage load is given by
(B) Compensate for the series reactance ( j ),
of the line under heavily loaded where, k k and
condition. k k
(C) Limit over-voltages at the load side A compensating shunt capacitor is chosen
under lightly loaded condition. such that | | 0.25 kVAR, where Q is the
(D) Compensate for the voltage drop in net reactive power consumed by the
the line under heavily loaded capacitor-load combination. The reactive
condition. power (in kVAR) supplied by the
capacitor is___________
26. In a long transmission line with r,l,g and c
are the resistance, inductance, shunt 30. For a 400 km long transmission line, the
conductance and capacitance per unit series impedance is (0.0 + J0.5) /km
length, respectively, the condition for and the shunt admittance is
distortionless transmission is (0.0 + J5.0) mho/km. The magnitude of
(A) rc = lg (C) rg = lc the series impedance (in ) of the
(B) r = √l⁄c (D) g = √c l equivalent circuit of the transmission
line is____________
27. For a fully transposed transmission line
(A) positive, negative and zero sequence
impedances are equal
(B) positive and negative sequence
impedances are equal
(C) zero and positive sequence
impedances are equal
(D) negative and zero sequence
impedances are equal
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 521
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1. [Ans. C] 5. [Ans. A]
It is generally based wavelength of the a
line
~ line load
2. [Ans. B]
Rectifiers act as an inductor (for α < 900) k k
Inverters act as a capacitor (for α < 900) Base value on load circuit
( ) = and (k ) = k
3. [Ans. C] ase impedance = =
% voltage regulation of the line alues of load in ohm =
( ) ( ) = alue of load in p u ase impedance
=
( ) = =
At the time of N.L, =0 Base values in generator circuit
∴ ( )= ( ) = (k ) = k
( )
ase impedance = =( =
∴ (%) = )
=
= 16%
= = = pu
4. [Ans. C] [Note: The Question in IIT Gate was wrong
+1 1 and later it is modified]
P1 P2
6. [Ans. A]
D1=2.5 m
D2=3 m
~ Y
15kV
A
T1 T2 B
Where, P1and P2 form power line and T1 Y θ
7. [Ans. C]
θ=
Both regions are connected by HVDC link
√
as well as AC line. So AC line is possible l l
when both regions have same frequency. l
=
By changing fringe angle (α) of converter,
we can change the power sharing, l = length of line = km
between the AC line and HVDC link.
10. [Ans. D]
8. [Ans. B] Wave length = λ, propagation constant =
Electric field intensity at various points λ= = = 4947.39 km
are shown as follows.
Ratio =
=
X 1 1
= 0.0606
% Ratio = 6.06 %
11. [Ans. C]
Surge impedance loading
2 Point X 3 2 Point Y 3
= SIL = 2280 MW
1 1
= Surge impedance
Surge Impedance loading = SIL =
as voltage is constant
S
2 Point Z 3 2 Point W 3 Suppose Csc is the series capacitance per
It is clear from the above diagrams that unit length for series compensation.
minimum cancellation of vector occurs at Therefore, series reactance will be,
the point Y. Hence maximum electric field
j =j ( )
intensity. j
=j ( )
9. [Ans. C]
Velocity of wave propagation =j ( )
here is known as degree of series
(θ) =
compensation
√( )( )
km km ( )
Therefore, =√
Let l is the length of the line
Total reaction of line =0.045 pu = f S =S =
√
Total inductance of line =
S = =
√
Inductance/km =
Total susceptance of line = 1.2 pu = fc 12. [Ans. C]
Total capacitance of line = S = Complex power
S is defined as , S = VI
apacitance km = S
=
If R is the resistance of transmission line
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 523
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
S 0.4 F
=
0.6 F Virtually
Since, S and R are fixed connected to
Real power loss 0.6 F sheath
0.6 F
0.4 F 0.4 F
13. [Ans. C]
Because, power flow takes from AB to CD
so , , and Per charging current
Since current flows from high voltage to =j
low voltage. | | =
=
14. [Ans.A] √
= and =
as , current will flow from
bus 1 to bus 2 17. [Ans. B]
= j
=
5C e
= I1 I2
=
C I
omplex power = S = j =
5C e
j = ( )
= j
= and = r Line to line voltage = = k
= Phase to ground voltage
15. [Ans. A]
=
As field voltage is held constant, so √
field current does not change. = k
√
When the generator is connected
with open – circuit transmission line, e e = k = k (i)
√
line draws charging current
=
(j ) e = (j ) e (j ) e (ii)
e = e
Solving equation (i) and (ii), we get
e = k
and e = k
Therefore is higher than Eg
i.e. Vt > Eg 18. [Ans. D]
But when the generator is For transmission of bulk power of
disconnected from the line, no very long distance high voltage
charging current is delivered by the (400 kV) is used.
generator i.e. IC = 0. In this Vt = Eg To increase reliability, double circuit
So, terminal voltage decreases. is used.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 524
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
x =
[x = ]
x =
Here all the bus voltage are assumed at 1
P.u so, it is a DC load flow problem
θ
Current lags voltage so, it absorbs the real So, [ ] = [ ] [ ]
θ
and reactive power.
and are power injection at bus 2
(or)
and 3
Alternative Method:
= = [load is ve]
Current from source to load
= =
x x x
S= =
=( )( )
[ x x x ]
= j
= j =* +=* +
∴ , θ
So, [ ] = * + * +=* +
Hence load absorbs real power and θ
reactive power
22. [Ans. C]
20. [Ans. D] From previous solution we got.
Equivalent circuits θ
[ ]=* + [ ]=* +
θ
Now. So,
j =
j =
=
( )
Now, Base VA= =
Base MVA=100
= = So, MW delivered by slack generator
j
(bus – )
= =
23. [Ans. C]
(t) = cos t
internal impedance = ( j )
For maximum power transfer, the load
impedance magnitude should be same
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 525
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 526
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 527
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
G1
13. The horizontally placed conductors of a
single phase line operating at 50 Hz are
~ j having outside diameter of 1.6 cm, and
j
j the spacing between centers of the
conductors is 6 m. The permittivity of free
space is /m.
The values of in p.u. and
The capacitance to ground per kilometer
respectively are
of each line is
(A) 0.95 and 6.00 (C) 1.1 and 6.00
(B) 1.05 and 5.44 (D) 1.1 and 27.12 (A) (C)
(B) (D)
11. A three phase star-connected load is
drawing power at a voltage of 0.9 pu and 14. A three phase, 100 MVA, 25 kV generator
0.8 power factor lagging. The three phase has solidly grounded neutral. The
base power and base current are positive, negative, and the zero sequence
100. MVA and 437.38 A respectively. The reactances of the generator are 0.2 pu
line-to-line load voltage in kV is____________ and 0.05 pu, respectively, at the machine
base quantities. If a bolted single phase to
12. A synchronous generator is connected to ground fault occurs at the terminal of the
an infinite bus with excitation voltage unloaded generator, the fault current in
= 1.3 pu. The generator has a amperes immediately after the fault
synchronous reactance of 1.1 pu and is is______________
delivering real power (P) of 0.6 pu to the
bus. Assume the infinite bus voltage to be
1.0pu. Neglect stator resistance. The
reactive power (Q) in pu supplied by the
generator to the bus under this condition
is ___________
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 529
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
= 3 + 0.06 * +
For k% series capacitor compensation
For maximum cost of generation,
=
k
( )
1 + 0.11 = 3 + 0.06 → ii)
Solving equation (i) and (ii),
= 100 MW 7. [Ans. A]
= 150 MW From coordination equation
4. [Ans. C]
Let x1, x2 and x3 are reactances of
Given
generator -1, generator -2 and
generator -3 respectively. an
Neglecting armature resistance of all the
three generators.
VR1=0.02p.u.
VR2 =0.04 p.u and
VR3=0.03 p.u.
VR1 < VR3 <VR2
Since, voltage regulation
R ∝ reactance of generator X1<X3<X2 p
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 530
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
( ) p j ( )
j
A j
j co j in
co
A co
in
8. [Ans. C] in
For fault at
Equivalent circuit tan
A
in
p
X |X | √
lea
or fa lt at f
olt
j ( )
j
j
co j in
co j in
co
ol ing thi
| |
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 531
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
13. [Ans. B]
ln ( )
R
ln ( )
km
p
j j j
j
p
a e
√ √
p a e
√
A
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 532
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 533
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE-2008
8. Suppose we define a sequence
10. A two machine power system is shown
transformation between “a-b-c” and
below. Transmission line XY has positive
“p-n-o” variables as follows:
sequence impedance of Z1 Ω and zero
f f
sequence impedance of Z0 Ω
[f ] k [ ] [f ] where e
f X Y
f
and k is a constant. F
Now, if it is given that :
i An 'a' phase to ground fault with zero
[ ]=[ ] [i ] and fault impedance occurs at the centre of
i
the transmission line. Bus voltage at X and
i
line current from X to F for the phase 'a',
[ ] [i ] then,
i are given by Va Volts and Ia Amperes,
respectively. Then, the impedance
(A) Z = [ ] measured by the ground distance relay
located at the terminal X of line XY will be
given by
(B) Z = [ ]
(A) Ω (C) Ω
(B) Ω (D) Ω
(C) Z = 3k2 [ ]
(D) * +[ ]
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 534
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
11. A 3 - phase transmission line is shown in Common Data Question for 13, 14 and 15
the figure Consider a power system
X Y
I ~ F ~
I I
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 535
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE-2009 (A)
16. For the Y-bus matrix of a 4-bus system R r
given in per unit, the buses having shunt
elements are. G
(B)
j[ ] R r
Y G ~ ~ G
B y
j 0.18
j 0.18
G ~ ~ G
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 536
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
j 0.21 j 0.21 ~ ~
G ~ ~ G
21. In the above system, the three-phase fault
MVA at the bus 3 is
EE-2011
(A) 82.55 MVA (C) 170.91 MVA
Statement for Linked Answer Question
(B) 85.11 MVA (D) 181.82 MVA
20 & 21
Two generator units G1 and G2 are 22. A three-bus network is shown in the
connected by 15 kV line with a bus at the figure below indicating the p.u.
mid-point as shown below, impedance of each element.
1 3 2 1 2 3
~ 10 km 10 km ~ j0.2 j0.08
G115 kV G2 j0.1 j0.1
15 kV
G1 = 250 MVA , 15 kV , positive sequence
reactance
The bus admittance matrix, Y-bus, of the
X = 25% on its own base
network is
G2 = 100 MVA , 15 kV , positive sequence
reactance (A) j[ ]
X = 10% on its own base
and = 10 km , positive sequence
reactance (B) j[ ]
X = 0.225 /km
(C) j[ ]
20. For the above system, the positive
sequence diagram with the p.u values on
(D) j[ ]
the 100 MVA common base is
(A)
j1.0 j1.0
1 3 2 23. A negative sequence relay is commonly
j0.10 j0.10
~ ~ used to protect
(A) an alternator
(B) a transformer
(B) (C) a transmission line
1
j1.0
3
j1.0
2 (D) a bus bar
j0.25 j0.10
~ ~
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 537
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE-2012 EE-2014
24. The bus admittance matrix of a three-bus 27. A 2-bus system and corresponding zero
three-line system is sequence network are shown in the
figure.
j[ ] us T T us
~ j pu
pu pu
(A) 0.2 pu (C) 0.312 pu
(B) 0.268 pu (D) 0.4 pu
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 538
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
√ P = sin pu
4. [Ans. D]
2. [Ans. C]
Before fault
Pre fault [ ] [ ]
Electrical power delivered by the
generator P pu
Mechanical input to the generator = P Fault current =I
At steady state, Solid 3-∅ fault occurs at bus r and
P P pu
During fault j
Initial rotor angle =
Internal voltage of the generator =|E |
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 539
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
6. [Ans. A]
I
j 1. The time taken to perform one
j pu iteration of the computation is
Post fault voltage at bus I is given by relatively smaller in case of G-S
I method but the number of iterations
Post fault voltage at bus I=1 required by G-S method for a
I particular system and they increase
j j with the increase in the size of the
pu system. Which results in slow
Post fault voltage at bus I = 3 convergence.
I 2. The convergence characteristic of
j j G-S method is sometimes very
pu seriously affected by the selection of
a slack bus and the selection of a
5. [Ans. C] particular bus may result in poor
Yii = sum of the admittance directly convergence.
connected to ith bus
y y y y excluded 7. [Ans. A]
y √ √ I
o y y y R=[ ] [I ]
√ √
y I
y [ √ √ ]
y y R =* I I I I I I +
√ √ √
j j j
Magnitude of R is determined of matrix R
y j pu
R = 3VI
Similarly,
y
8. [Ans. B]
y j j j
I
y j pu Here, [ ] [ ] [I ]
j I
y j I
j Where, [ ] = [Z] [I ]
y j I
E I I
I
[I ] = K [ ] [I ]
[Current fed by generator i during fault] I I
E E I
[The system was unloaded] [I ]
Current fed by generator 1 I
Similarly,
I = K[A]
pu
Current fed by generator 2, = K[A] [ ] [I ]
I
[ ]
= K[A] [ ] I
pu
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 540
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
=[ ] 11. [Ans. B]
Let & be the self and mutual
inductance of a line
9. [Ans. B] Positive sequence impedance
= Ω i
I Zero sequence impedance
= + Ω ii
Solving eq (i) and eq (ii)
I ∴ Ω Ω
I
12. [Ans. D]
Let impedance of each branch be R on
Taking as the reference removing (e )
Losses =
Similarly on removing e ,
Losses =
P
I on removing e ,
cos
Losses =
on removing e ,
If an pure inductor is present in phase Losses =
B, then I lags by o on removing bus ‘e ’ losses are
If a pure capacitor is present in phase minimum, so correct option is (d)
C, then I leads by
If current through neutral is to be zero 13. [Ans. A]
I sin I sin Voltage, V = cos ωt
I I I Current after fault
I I cos I cos √
i t e cos ωt
I cos √ I | |
|I | at t = t ; i = 0
|I | |I | |I|
√ ⁄ √
e cos ωt
| |
√ j
| | | |
|I |
ω The maximum value will be at
ωt
mH t ω
|I | | | ωC f
C m sec
C F
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 541
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
14. [Ans. A] j
.003 + j 0.03 .003 + j 0.03 j
j
.001 + j 0.01
.001 + j j
eq
0.01 From eq (i)
~ ~ =
=
j
j
j j j
I = From eq (ii)
eq = j || j = j j j j
eq = 0.002 + j 0.02 p.u = j
E = = 1.0 p.u From eq (iii)
[ pre fault voltage not specified] = j j j j
=
∴I = = 49.75 pu
From eq (iv)
I = = 144.34 = j j j
√
=
I =I I
= 7.18KA
I = = 3.59
15. [Ans. C]
I =
Given that = and =
I = =
I = 29.85 p.u
17. [Ans. B]
I = = 14.93
Shut capacitor are used to provide part
of the reactive ’s required by the load
16. [Ans. C]
to keep the voltage within desirable limits
If directly we can add all the elements of
and to improve factor.
each row. If the sum is not zero, then that
Series reactor reduces current ripple.
bus contains shunt elements
Shunt reactors are used across
For ith bus add all the element of ith row.
capacitive loads or lightly loaded lines to
If sum = 0 ith bus contain shunt elements
absorb some of the leading ’s to
control the voltage across the load to
[ ] within certain desirable limit.
Series capacitor campensation reduces
here the series impedance of the line. Power
j . . . .(i) flow inline power flow in line
j ii
increases, as decreases.
j . . (iii)
j iv
j
j
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 542
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
j[ ]
but,
for Bus admittance matrix,
So, = j0.62 pu.
-10
3 +j 2
N N
25. [Ans. C]
I = +j 1.5 P.u
= 0.25 × ( ) = 0.1
I = j 0.5 P.u
= 0.1 × ( ) = 0.1 I = j 1.0 P.u
Since, two sequence current is present,
= 0.225 × 10 ( ) = j1.0
the type, of fault is not L-L fault
= 0.225 × 10 ( ) = j1.0 In L-G fault: all sequence networks will be
connected in series. So, the current is
21. [Ans. D] same for all I I &I
In for the case of LLLG fault, as it is
C balanced fault, only two sequence current
will be present in the system.
So, from the above, the type of fault is LLG
22. [Ans. B]
1 j 2 j 3 26. [Ans. B]
V1 = V2= 1-0
j0.2 j0.08 I12
j j0.1 j0.1 j ~ z=
j0.5p.u.
j j j5 0 = 1p.u. = 1p.u.
y = j5 j j j
0 j j j
Line is lossless =
= 1+1 +
= 2p.u.
Power transfer from bus-1 to bus-2 is
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 543
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
l p.u.
| || |
∴ sin ( sin
; sin
sin ;
};
∴ 2 = ; V2 = 1
I12 = = 1-j0.288
Current =l ; Current in
=l [1 j0.268]=
0.268
VAR rating of capacitor
= |V2||lQ|sin(|V2||I2|)
= 1 0.268 sin(+90)
= 0.268
27. [Ans. B]
For
For
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 544
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE-2009
5. A 500 MW, 21kV, 50 Hz, 3-phase, 2- pole
synchronous generator having a rated
p.f = 0.9, has a moment of inertia of (a)
27.5 10 kg-m2. The inertia constant (H)
will be peed M
EE-2012
6. A cylindrical rotor generator delivers
0.5 pu power in the steady state to an
orque
infinite bus through a transmission line of
reactance 0.5 pu. The generator no-load (b)
voltage is 1.5 pu and the infinite bus The stable operating points are
voltage is 1pu. The inertia constant of the (A) P and R (C) Q and R
generator is 5MW-S/MVA generator (B) P and S (D) Q and S
reactance is 1 pu, the critical clearing
angle, in degrees, for a three –phase dead 9. The figure shows the single line diagram
short circuit fault at the generator of a single machine infinite bus system.
terminal is
(A) 53.5 (C) 70.8
(B) 60.2 (D) 79.6 Infinte
bus
EE-2014 The inertia constant of the synchronous
7. The undesirable property of an electrical generator = 5M -s/MVA. Frequency is
insulating material is 50 Hz.
(A) high dielectric strength Mechanical power is 1 pu. The system is
(B) high relative permittivity operating at the stable equilibrium point
(C) high thermal conductivity with rotor angle δ equal to 30 . A three
(D) high insulation resistivity phase short circuit fault occurs at a
certain location on one of the circuits of
8. The torque-speed characteristics of motor the double circuit transmission line.
( ) and load ( ) for two cases are During fault, electrical power in pu
shown in the figures (a) and (b). The load is sin δ If the values of δ and dδ⁄dt at
torque is equal to motor torque at points the instant of fault clearing are 45 and
P, Q, R and S 3.762 radian/s respectively,
then (in pu) is____________
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 546
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1. [Ans. D] = 10 0
= 12 √3 0 8 = 16.627 kW
= 12 √3 0 6 =12.47 kW E = 1.0
cos = 0 8 PS = 1.0 P.u
sin = 0 6 Xeq: equivalent reactance when online is
For unity pf, the total reactive power is removed due to normal operation of relay
zero Xeq = 0.1 + x
Assuming kVAR rating of capacitor bank ∴ sin 130 = 1 0
( )
=
= 0 67 u [∵ S = 1.0 P.u]
=0
= = 12 47 k
4. [Ans. D]
So, capacitor banks supplies 12.47 kVAR
To increase the capacitor d.c. voltage
reactive power to the load.
slowly to a new slowly to a new steady
state value, make ‘δ’ negative and return
2. [Ans. A]
it to its original value.
As = = 0 and = =0
There is no energy transfer, so both bus
5. [Ans. A]
bar voltage and its phase angle should be
same, so we can consider both bus bar G= = MW = 555.56 MVA
phase angle as zero. KE Stored
Phase angle of y y = 20
= M ( )
hase angle of x = x = 30
(∴ hase angle difference = 27 5 10 ( )
= x y = 1357.07 MJ
= 30 20 = 10
H= = = 2.44 MJ/MVA
3. [Ans. C]
Here the alternator is undergoing under 6. [Ans. D]
damped oscillations with δ max = 1300, at
this any fault occurs even then also to
maintain stability ‘ ’ value must not go
beyond 1300 for a given mechanical input δ ~ Infinite bus
~ 0
| || |
= sin δ
( )
15 1
05 = sin δ
(1 0 5)
δ = sin (0 5) = 30 =
6
= 130 δ Critical clearing angle
δ = cos [( 2δ ) sin δ cos δ ]
∴ = , sin δ = S
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 547
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1 √3 d δ (δ 30)
= cos *( ) + =
3 3 2 f dt 180
= cos (0 18) = 79 56 (cos δ cos 30)
dδ
at δ = 45 , = 3 762
7. [Ans. B] dt
5
3 762
3 14 50
8. [Ans. B]
(δ 30) √3
At P point, speed change by s, will = (cos δ )
180 2
increase - increase
5
Hence speed will increases by s, hence 3 762
3 14 50
move back to previous point.
(45 30) √3
Hence stable point = (cos 45 )
180 2
At s point, speed change by s, -
increases, speed will decrease by s. 1 √3
0 12 = 0 88 ( )
Hence move back to pervious point. √2 2
Hence stable point = 0 23
d d
d d
For stability
sin δ
sin δ
0 30 45
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 548
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 549
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE-2010
7. Consider a step voltage wave of
magnitude 1pu travelling along a lossless
transmission line that terminates in a Operating coil
reactor. The voltage magnitude across the (A) 0.17875 (C) 0.375A
reactor at the instant the travelling wave (B) 0.2A (D) 60kA
reaches the reactor is
A EE-2014
10. The overcurrent relays for the line
Reactor
protection and loads connected at the
buses are shown in the figure.
100A
8. A three-phase, 33kV oil circuit breaker is
The relays are IDMT in nature having the
rated 1200A, 2000MVA, 3s. The
characteristic
symmetrical breaking current is
. ime ultiplier etting
(A) 1200 A (C) 35 kA t
( lug setting ultiplier) .
(B) 3600 A (D) 104.8 kA
The maximum and minimum fault
currents at bus B are 2000 A and 500 A
respectively. Assuming the time
multiplier setting and plug setting for
relay to be 0.1 and 5A respectively, the
operating time of (in seconds)
is_________
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 550
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1. [Ans. A] 4. [Ans. D]
Vacuum circuit breakers are specially 0.5 P.u
.
used for low cost switch having low fault ~ .
interrupting capacity, but capable of large
number of load switching operations
without maintenance. ~
0.5 P.u
Where n & n are the number of turns on where ritical clearing angle
operating relay coil and restrained coil t ritical clearing time
respectively ( )
t √
3. [Ans. C]
If the relays are co – ordinated correctly,
Initially when one machine is delivering
due to fault in a particular section, relay
1.0 P.u electrical output
in that section must operate first, then
. .u
relays in near by section if first fails, it is
When two identical generators are
back up protection. Thus, the sequence is
delivering a total electrical power output
[5, 6, 7, 3, 1, 2].
of 1.0 p.u.,
. p. u.
( )
t . √
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 551
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
5. [Ans. A]
9. [Ans. C]
Distance protection using mho relays CT ratio CT ratio
with zone-1 set to 80% of the line 400/5 400/5
250 A 250 A
impedance will not provide protection.
6. [Ans. A]
For a short line of transmission, reactance I1 I2
relay is used I0C
For a medium line of transmission
impedance relay is used Operating coil
For a long line of transmission, MHO relay
I ( ) .
is used.
I ( ) .
7. [Ans. B]
Let surge impedance of the line = Zc Current through operating coil = I
E=Step voltage wave of magnitude 1 p.u. I I . .
.
(s)
s
ZC 10. [Ans. *] Range 0.21 to 0.23
~
I(s) Ls V(s)
E(s)
. . . or elay
t .
[ . . . ]
( )
. .
(s) I ( )
I(s) I
s ( )
(s) oltage across the reactor aximum load current at
(s) or a setting current of plug setting is
(s) I(s). s s
s ax fault current
ratio current setting
s
(s) s
( s)
⁄
. . . . .
(t)| .e t
( . . ) . ( ) .
at t=0
. . sec
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 552
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Generating Stations
From ,
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 553
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
50Ω
50Ω
C
+
100V
200V
Th1 Th2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 554
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
R C R C (B)
1.5
current
X Q 1
T 0.7R T 0.7R
̅
Q 0.5
+5V ̅
Q
0
The frequency and the duty cycle of the 0 10 20 30
time (ms)
40 50
signal at Q will respectively be
(C)
(A) f 1.5
5
current
(B) f
1
(C) f 0.5
(D) f 0
0 10 20 30 40 50
time(ms)
EE-2009 (D)
6. An SCR is considered to be a 1.5
semi-controlled device because
current 1
(A) it can be turned OFF but not ON with
a gate pulse 0.5
(B) it conducts only during one half-cycle
of an alternating current wave 0
0 10 20 30 40 50
(C) it can be turned ON but not OFF with times(ms)
a gate pulse
(D) it can be turned ON only during one 8. Match the switch arrangements on the
half-cycle of an alternating voltage top row to the steady-state V-I
wave characteristics on the lower row. The
steady state operating points are shown
7. The circuit shows an ideal diode by large black dots.
connected to a pure inductor and is
(a) (b)
connected to a purely sinusoidal 50Hz
voltage source. Under ideal conditions the
current waveform through the inductor
will look like + +
0.1 is is
V 10 sin100 T (I) (II)
(A)
1.5 Vs Vs
current
0.5
0
0 10 20 30 40 50
time(ms)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 555
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(c) (d)
T L
15V C
+
+ (A) 10 s (C) 100 s
i (B) 50 s (D) 200 s
is
(III) (IV) EE-2014
12. Figure shows four electronic switches
Vs Vs (i), (ii), (iii) and (iv). Which of the
switches can block voltages of either
Codes: polarity applied between terminals ‘a’
a b c d and ‘b’ when the active device is in the
(A) I II III IV OFF state?
(B) II IV I III a a a a
(C) IV III I II
(D) IV III II I
EE-2011
9. Circuit turn-off time of an SCR is defined
as the time
(A) taken by the SCR to turn off
(B) required for the SCR current to b b b b
become zero i ii iii iv
(C) for which the SCR is reverse biased
(A)
~
(i), (ii) and (iii)
~ ~ ~
by the commutation circuit
(B) (ii), (iii) and (iv)
(D) for which the SCR is reverse biased
(C) (ii) and (iii)
to reduced its current below the
(D) (i) and (iv)
holding current
13. A diode circuit feeds an ideal inductor as
EE-2012 shown in the figure.
10. The typical ratio of Latching current to Given V 100 sin t V, where
holding current in a 20 A thyristor is 100 rad/s, and L = 31.83 mH. The
(A) 5.0 (C) 1.0 initial value of inductor current is zero.
(B) 2.0 (D) 0.5 Switch S is closed at t = 2.5ms. The peak
value of inductor current i (in A) in the
EE-2013 first cycle is________
11. Thyristor T in the figure below is initially t 2.5 ms
off and is triggered with a single pulse of i
width 10 s. It is given that L =( ) S
and C =( ) . Assuming latching and
holding current of the thyristor are both V ~
zero and the initial charge on C is zero, T
conducts for
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 556
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
t R ln 2 VCE
as R R 50
t t R cln 2 When the pulses are applied to the base
Safety margin = 2 of the transistor. Transistor operates in
So, R ln2 2t ON state. So, the forward voltage drop in
2 50 10 transistor V 1 V.
c 2.88
50 ln2 V 10 V 10 1 9V
1
2. [Ans. B] V V ( ) V 9V [turn ratio 1 1]
1
iA
is forward biased and voltage drop in
iL iR diode V =1 V
R 20 is reversed biased and acts as open
R2=5K
V=100
circuit.
0.5H Capacitor behaves as open circuit for dc
voltage. Forward voltage drop of gate
Current through 5 k resistor cathode junction
V 100
i V 1V
R 5 10
Voltage drop across resistor R.
20m 0.02
V V V V
Current through inductor
V 9 1 1 7V
⁄
i (1 e ) To ensure turn – ON of SCR,
R
V 7
100 . R 47
(1 e ) 150m
20
5 1 e
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 557
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
4. [Ans. A] 7. [Ans. C]
RL = 1 Frequency of the voltage source,
f = 50 Hz
L
+ iL Time period, T = 20 ms.
VT
During positive half cycle of the source
E=200V
voltage, 0 < t< , energy is stored in the
Forward voltage drop of SCR during inductor and current increases.
ON – state VT=1 V During negative half cycle of the source
I voltage, t T, current decreases and
C I
energy stored in the inductor is delivered
+ V V
to source.
di
Ri V 0 8. [Ans. C]
dt
di I I ⇒ V
⇒ 200 0.15 i 1 0
dt V V
⇒i 199(1 e ⁄ . )
Gate pulse width required = time taken I
I ⇒
by i to rise upto T
V
⇒ 250 10 199(1 e . ) V
T 188.56 s
Width of the pulse = T = 188.56 s I
Magnitude of voltage = V = 10 V
In V
Voltage second rating of PT V
Parallel
VT = 10 188.56 s V
1885.6 v-s ∴ Switch is ON if either T or impressed
2000 v-s are ON and Switch is OFF, if both T or
impressed D are OFF.
5. [Ans. A] I
1 T
f
T T T T
V
6. [Ans. C]
SCR can only be turn on by applying gate
pulses but it cannot be turnoff by the
same. Once the thyristor is on, and its 9. [Ans. C]
anode current is above the latching The turn – off time provided to the
current level the gate loses control. It can thyristor by a circuit is called circuit turn
be turned off only by reducing the anode off time. It is defined as the time between
current below holding current. Only the instant anodes current becomes zero
triggering can be done through gate but and the instant reverse voltage due to the
commutation can’t be done through gate circuit reaches zero.
gate loses control after the SCR turns on.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 558
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
10. [Ans. B] V
i (cos ( ) cos t)
For medium power thyristors of rating 4
6 A to 60A the ratio of the latching at t 10ms is maximum
current to holding current is 1.5 to 2. V 1 100 10
i ( cos ( ))
√2 1000
11. [Ans. C] 100
1 0.707
1 1 1 100 31.83 10
f 17.08
√ 100
1
T 100 s
f
12. [Ans. C]
In (i) and (iii), when switch are reverse
biased, diode in parallel will start
conducting so not able to block the
reverse voltage
2ms 10ms
Start at which current is maximum at
t = 10 ms
di
V sin t
dt
V sin t
di ∫ dt
V
i cos t k
at t 2.5 ms i=0
V 100 2.5
0 cos ( ) k
1000
V
k cos ( )
4
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 559
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE-2006 i
1. A 3-phase fully controlled bridge
converter with freewheeling diode is fed
from 400 V, 50 Hz AC source and is V V
operating at a firing angle of 600. The load
current is assumed constant at 10 A due
to high load inductance. The input
displacement factor (IDF) and the input
power factor (IPF) of the converter will
0 2
be
(A) IDF = 0.867; IPF = 0.828
(B) IDF= 0.867; IPF = 0.552
(C) IDF = 0.5; IPF = 0.478 0 2
(D) IDF = 0.5; IPF = 0.318
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 560
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Pure L
0
AC ~ 3 4 3 2 t
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 561
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(%THD) and the rms value of The energy is collected in a bank of 400 V
fundamental component of the input battery and is connected to converter
current will respectively be through a large filter choke of resistance
(A) 31% and 6.8 A (C) 66% and 6.8 A 10 Ω.
(B) 31% and 7.8 A (D) 66% and 7.8 A
13. The maximum current through the
11. A single phase fully controlled bridge battery will be
converter supplies a load drawing (A) 14 A (C) 80 A
constant and ripple free load current. If (B) 40 A (D) 94 A
the triggering angle is 30 , the input
power factor will be 14. The kVA rating of the input transformer is
(A) 0.65 (C) 0.85 (A) 53.2 kVA (C) 22.6 kVA
(B) 0.78 (D) 0.866 (B) 46.0 kVA (D) 19.6 kVA
EE-2011 EE-2012
Statement for Linked Answer Questions 17. A half-controlled single-phase bridge
13 and 14 rectifier is supplying an R-L load. It is
A solar energy installation utilizes a operated at a firing angle and the load
three-phase bridge converter to feed current is continuous. The fraction of
energy into power system through a cycle that the freewheeling diode
transformer of 400 V/400 V, as shown conducts is
below. (A) 1 2 (C) ⁄2
Filter Choke (B) 1 ⁄ (D) ⁄
~ Battery
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 562
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
~
230V 50 z
10
22. The SCR in the circuit shown has a
latching current of 40 mA. A gate pulse of
50 µs is applied to the SCR. The maximum
value of R in to ensure successful firing
19. The figure shows the circuit diagram of a of the SCR is___
rectifier. The load consists of a resistance S R
10Ω and an inductance 0.05 connected
in series. Assuming ideal thyristor and
500
ideal diode, the thyristor firing angle
(in degree) needed to obtain an average 100V R
load voltage of 70 V is __________
200m
~
325 sin 314t V oad
20. A fully controlled converter bridge feeds a 23. A three-phase fully controlled bridge
highly inductive load with ripple free load converter is fed through star-delta
current. The input supply (v ) to the transformer as shown in the figure.
bridge is a sinusoidal source. Triggering R
angle of the bridge converter is 30 .
The input power factor of the bridge is
_________
1
V ~ Load
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 563
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
2k 3
k 3
0 2
1. [Ans. C]
Load current is constant 2. [Ans. C]
10 Vi
In 3-ϕ full converter with free-wheeling E
diode, input displacement factor (IDF)
cos cos 60 0.5 v
R S value source current
2 1 2
√ √
3 3 i0
RMS value of nth
harmonic
4 n
sin
√2n 3
RMS value of fundamental current average current
2√2 √6
sin 60 1
∫ V sin wt d
Current distortion factor (CDF) 2 R
√6 1 3 1
( √ ) ∴ avg [2V cos 2 ]
2 2 R
1
3 2 2
0.955
[2 (230 √2) cos 200 2 ]
Input power factor (IPF)
where sin ( )
V
0.955 0.5 200
0.478 sin ( )
230 √2
38 0.66 rad
1
∴ avg [2√2 230 cos 38
2 2
200 2 0.66 ]
11.9
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 564
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
V 5. [Ans. A]
Firing angle= 25
t Overlap angle = 10
DC output current
i
V
[cos cos ]
l
t 230 √2
i ∴ 20
2 50
l [cos 25 cos 25 10 ]
t
∴ 0.0045
i Average output voltage
i 2V cos
v
t
2 230√2 cos 25
or 0 t Diode is forward biased 3.14
and conduct. 2 3.14 50 4.5 10 20
For t 2 Diode becomes 3.14
reverse biased and Diode gets forward 187.73 9
biased and starts conducting. 178.74 V
As load current is constant current through Displacement factor=
Diode i can be drawn as shown in 178.25 20
the figure. 230 20
0.78
4. [Ans. D]
Solar cell emf E = 350 V 6. [Ans. C]
DC current 20
Solar cell resistance T1 T2 I0
R 0.5
V Voltage across inverter
R Vs ~ V0
350 20 0.5
340 V
The bridge acts as inverter, D2 D1
Output voltage of 3 ϕ fully controlled
bridge
1-ϕ full wave half controlled bridge
3V
V cos converter without free-wheeling diode is
3V shown in the figure.
cos 340
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 565
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Vs 9. [Ans. A]
t
2 T1 T2
V0 Vs ~ V0
t
T2 D T1D1 T1D T2D2 D2 D1
1 2
2 +
3
T1 and D2 and output voltage become zeros.
At t load T2 is triggered and load V0
current is transferred from T1 to T2.
So, during t 2 T t
T1D1 T2D2 T1D1 T1D2 T1D1
conducts. At t It may be possible T2D1 T1D2 T2D1
that load current is not transferred no firing
T1 is T2 is T1 is
completely from T1 to T2, and T1 and T2
triggered
triggered
triggered
pulses
may be conducting simultaneously which
results in short circuit of the supply for
short direction. During,
0 t freewheeling
7. [Ans. D] by T V 0
Inductor current is positive for 360 , hence t T1 D1 conducts
the diode conducts for whole of the period, V V
i.e, 360 . t
Freewheeling by T1D2, V0=0
8. [Ans. C]
t 2
Let DC link current =
T2D2 conduct , V0 = Vs
DC voltage applied to the inverse
T1 is again triggered at 2
V 420
So during 2 t 3
Power fed to the inverter
T , conducts.
P V 50 k
Now, if firing pulses are removed after T1 is
⇒ 420 50 10
triggered at 2 .
119.05
At t 3 no firing pulse will be
Current through each thyristor flow for
available to trigger T2. So, load current will
period of 2 3
flow through T1D2 as load current is
So, rms current of thyristor.
continuous. So during 3 t 4
√ ∫ d t TD2 will continue to conduct and V0 =0.
119.05 At t 4 D1 will become forward biased
68.73 and D2 will become reverse biased. So, D1
√3 √3
will conduct and T1 is already conducting.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 566
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
10. [Ans. B] t
Load current = 10 V
RMS value of total source current
2 2
√ 10√ 8.165
3 3 t
2
Supply current i can be expressed by i
fourier series
4 n
i t ∑ sin sin n t n t
n 3
i
RMS value of fundamental current,
4
sin
√2 3
t
4 √3 10
⇒ 7.8
√2 2 Average output voltage
Total Harmonic distortion 1
V ∫ V sin t. d t
√( ) 1 100 2V
⇒V cos
8.165 for 30
√( ) 1 100
7.8 √3
V V
31
Average output current = l (constant)
RMS value of supply current = l l
11. [Ans. B]
+ RMS value of supply voltage V
√
Input power factor
i T T
Power delivered to load
+ L
O nput V
V ~ V A
V (√3 )V
D
V V ⁄√2.
T T
√6
0.78
12. [Ans. A]
cos V
V = = 300
V V . cos60 300. 150 V
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 567
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
13. [Ans. B] 10
p. f cos 60 0.44
Filter Choke 11.35
~ Battery(E)
16. [Ans. B]
Active power will be drawn by converter
Average output voltage of the converter only due to fundamental component.
3V
V cos Therefore, Active power = V cos ϕ
100 10 cos 60
The converter acts as line commutated
Active power = 500 watts
inverter and for such mode
90 and V is negative. Therefore
17. [Ans. D]
battery supplies energy to AC system.
V
So, current through battery
400 V
R
for V 0 or 90
Maximum current flow through battery
400 0
40 2
10
Freewheeling diode conducts for 2 over
14. [Ans. C]
complete cycle
RMS value of supply current in case of
3 – ϕ bridge converter ∴ raction
2 2
√ 40√ 32.66 18. [Ans. *] Range 23 to 23
3 3 RMS value of current supplied by source
KVA rating of the input transformer 10
√3V 10
√3 400 32.66 10 V
22.62 V T 2 T
t
15. [Ans. B]
10
Voltage applied (v) = 100√2 sin 100 t
Current resulted RMS value of current supplied when
resistor is there
10√2 sin (10 t ) 5√2 (300 t )
3 4
V R
2√2 sin (500 t )
The current flown into converter consists t
of fundamental, 3rd harmonic and 5th
harmonic components.
In the case of converter drawing non
sinusoidal component of current then p.f V
10
will be written as √2R
Input power factor = cos ϕ V 230√2
230√2
10 ⇒ 10
√2R
√10 5 2 11.35 R 23
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 568
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
cos
nput power factor
√
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 569
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
23. [Ans. B]
V V V V V
i 1
3
i
k
3
k
input waveform 3
i
i i 2k⁄3
⁄
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 570
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Choppers
EE-2006 EE-2008
Statement for Linked Answer Questions 1 4. In the circuit shown in the figure, the
and 2 switch is operated at a duty cycle of 0.5.
A voltage commutated chopper operating A large capacitor is connected across the
at 1 kHz is used to control the speed of dc load. The inductor current is assumed to
motor as shown in figure. The load be continuous. The average voltage across
current is assumed to be constant at 10 A. the load and the average current through
the diode will respectively be
+ M IL = 4A L ID D
1 F
V = 250V
A
Load
2mH ‘S’ V0
20V
Th EE-2010
6. The power electronic converter shown in
Load the figure has a single-pole double-throw
230V 25.28µH
10
switch. The pole P of the switch is
connected alternately to throws A and B.
The converter shown is a _______
(A) 0 µs t 25 µs A L
P
(B) 25 µs t 50 µs
V B
(C) 50µs t 75 µs V
(D) 75 µs t 100 µs
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 571
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE-2011
7. A voltage commutated chopper circuit, 9. The average source current in Amps in
operated at 500 Hz, is shown below. steady – state is
M i 10 (A) 3/2 (C) 5/2
i
(B) 5/3 (D) 15/4
A
0.1µF i
10. The PEAK-TO-PEAK source current ripple
200V LOAD in amps is
1mH
(A) 0.96 (C) 0.192
(B) 0.144 (D) 0.288
If the maximum value of load current is
EE-2014
10 A, then the maximum current through
11. Figure (i) show the circuit diagram of a
the main (M) and auxiliary (A) thyristors
chopper. The switch S in the circuit in
will be
figure (i) is switched such that the voltage
(A) i 12 and i 10
V across the diode has the wave shape as
(B) i 12 and i 2
shown in figure (ii). The capacitance C is
(C) i 10 and i 12
large so that the voltage across it is
(D) i 10 and i 8
constant. If switch S and the diode are
EE-2012 ideal, the peak to peak ripple (in A) in the
8. In the circuit shown, an ideal switch S is inductor current is___________
S 1m
operated at 100 kHz with a duty ratio of
50 . Given that ∆ic is 1.6 A peak-to-peak 100V V oad
and I0 is 5 A dc, the peak current in S is
S igure i
V
i
100V
V
24 V
R
0 0.05 0.1 0.15 0.2 t ms
(A) 6.6 A (C) 5.8 A
igure ii
(B) 5.0 A (D) 4.2 A
12. A step-up chopper is used to feed a load at
EE-2013
400 V dc from a 250 V dc source. The
Common Data Questions 9 and 10
inductor current is continuous. f the ‘off’
In the figure shown below, the chopper
time of the switch is 20 µs, the switching
feeds a resistive load from a battery
frequency of the chopper in kHz
source. MOSFET Q is switched at 250 kHz,
is_____________
with a duty ratio of 0.4. All elements of
the circuit are assumed to be ideal.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 572
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1. [Ans. B] t t t ∆t
Minimum time for which SCRm should be t √
ON is same as time for which C charges
from + 250 V to 250V. √10 25.28 sec
T= √ √20 10 140 sec. 50 sec
Option (C) is correct.
2. [Ans. C] Since commutation of Thm starts from
t1=50 sec
V V 250
= 35V 4. [Ans. C]
When S is ON, V = 0V and = 0A
3. [Ans. C] When S is off, V 20 V and = 4A
Th im I0 v 20
∴ V 40V
D 1 d 1 0.5
Th 0.5 × 4 = 2A
LOAD
+ c L
230 V 5. [Ans. A]
+
vc 0.8
dv
V 100 V and 50V sec
dt
At t =0 v V i 0 and i . V V
At t =0, Th is triggered, a resonant 0.8 100 ⇒ 80 V
current i designs to flows from C V 80
i 10
throughTh , L and back to C.
R 8
During commutation of main SCR T
This resonant current is given by
load current will be flown through
capacitor.
i V √ sin t
dv
∴ i
sin t dt
10 10
After half a cycle of i ,t - i 0 ⇒ ⇒ 0.2 f
50
V V and i . As i tends to
reverse. Th is turned off. 6. [Ans. A]
When V V , right hand plate has B and D are not possible options as the
positive polarity , resonant current i now input is dc.
builds up through C, L, D and Th . As this
P→ V V (1 e )
current of Th , net forward current
i i begins to decrease. Finally P → V = V .e where T= L/R
when i in the reversed direction attains If L is large enough,
the value I0 , im is reduced to zero and Thm V V when P →
is turned off. 0 when P →
i i sin ∆t 0 ∴ step down chopper
1
∆t sin ( )
i t V √ sin t
We have to find out peak to peak source
Peak value of current through capacitor ripple current here ource current and
inductor current are same peak to peak
V√ source ripple = peak to peak inductor
current
0.1 10 V
200 √ T → uty ratio
1 10
Given f = 250 k
2 1
Current through main thyristor So T
250 10
i t
sin t i
So, maximum value of
i Vin
10 2
12
When auxiliary thyristor (A) is turned on T T
t
capacitor voltage applies a reverse
i. e. Peak – peak inductor current
voltage across main thyristor and main
. .
thyristor is turned off. The load current is T
now carried by c and auxiliary thyristor. 0.192
Current through auxiliary thyristor
i 11. [Ans. *] Range 2.49 to 2.51
Maximum value of iA = maximum value of For 0 t 0.05 ms
I0 = 10A V 100 V
or 0.05 t 0.1 ms
8. [Ans. C] V V
∆ .
Peak Current = I0 + 5 5.8 Using volt-sec, across inductor
100 V 0.05 V 0.05 0
9. [Ans. B] V 50
v 50
V Slope
1 50
Slope
12
20 V
1 0.4
20
1
20
Given that all are ideal
0.05 0.1
P P
⇒ V 20 1 di
∴ 5 3 V
dt
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 574
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
di V v V
⇒i ∫ dt t
dt
Peak to peak current i t
50
0.05 10
50 0.05 10
2.5
10
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 575
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Inverters
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 576
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE-2014
10. The figure shows one period of the output
voltage of an inverter. should be chosen
such that 60 90 . If rms value of
B B
the fundamental component is 50 V, then
(C) A in degree is _____________
(D) A
100V 100V 100V
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 577
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
S S
O i
V oad
S S
S S
S S
2
If the load current is sinusoidal and is
zero at 0 2 . . , the node voltage V
has the waveform
V 2
V
2
V 2
V 2
V
2
V 2
V
2
V 2
V
2
V 2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 578
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1. [Ans. B] 4V n
The output of inverter = v v ∑ sin sin nd sin n t
n 2
4V
∴ v ∑ sin nd sin n t sin n 2 RMS value of fundamental component of
n output voltage.
Here pulse width = 2d =144 1 4V
V [ sin 75 ] 0.87 V
⇒ d 72 √2
4V Total Harmonic Distortion
v sin 72 sin t for n 1
4V V V
v sin 3 72 sin 3 t for n 3 T √ 100
3 V
V sin 3 72
20.6 0.913 V 0.87V
V max √ 100
sin 72 0.87V
Option (B) is correct as it is nearer to 31.83
20.6%.
4. [Ans. D]
2. [Ans. B] Line voltage and pole voltage of 3 – ϕ VSI
As MOSFET have internally antiparallel operated in 180 conduction mode can be
diodes, MOSFET cannot withstand expressed by the fourier series as follows.
reverse voltage, due to which MOSFET 4V n n
cannot be as current source inverter V ∑ cos sin t .. i
n 6 6
(CSI).
or n 3 cos cos 0
3. [Ans. C] 2V
V0 V ∑ sin n t ii
n
It is clear from eq. (i) as (ii) both check
d voltage and line voltage will be from 3rd
2
3 harmonic components.
Vs
2d 2
t
2d 2
5. [Ans. B]
V0
( d) 2 vs
2 Vs
Pulse width = 2d = 150 2
t
⇒ d 75 -vs
1 i0
V √ ∫ V d t iP
2
t
iP
2d 5
V√ V√ 0.913 V
6
Output voltage in fourier series.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 579
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Load current increases linearly from cannot be used in a CSI. So, a diode is
IP to IP during 0 < t . Where Ip = added in series with the devices for
Peak value of i0 reverse blocking.
1
⇒ t sec
2 50 100 8. [Ans. D]
t t 0i and t t i V
di
V
dt
During 0< t i
V V 200 V
⇒ 200 0.1 . /
t 0
200
⇒ 2 t
0.1
2000 1
10
2 100
Voltage and current waveform of a full
6. [Ans. B]
bridge inverter
The circuit shown in the figure is a single
Shaded portion shows the condition
phase bridge auto sequential commutated
where V 0 i 0
inverter (1-phase ASCI)
Conducts the load current
Thyristor pairs T T and T T are
alternatively switches to obtain a nearly
9. [Ans. D]
square wave load current. Two
Turn on points for thyristors
commutating capacitors, one in the
Q Q Q Q are given
upper half and the other in the lower
∴ A, B, C represents points where current
half are connected as shown
cross over zero. Zero current switch
Diodes to are connected in series
(ZCS) during turn on.
with each SCR to prevent the
commutation capacitors from discharging
10. [Ans. *] Range 76.5 to 78.0
into the load. The inverter output
Fourier series
frequency is controlled by adjusting the
period T through the triggering circuits of a
f t ∑ a cos n t
thyristors. 2
The theoretical maximum output
frequency obtainable ∑ b sin n t
1
f Fundamental component n = 1
4R
1 ⇒ a cos t b sin t
4 10 0.1 10 1
a ∫ f t cos t d t
250k z
7. [Ans. A]
Device used in current source inverter
(CSI) must have reverse voltage blocking
capacity. Therefore, device such as GTOs,
power transistors and power MOSFETs
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 580
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
100
0∫ cos t d t ∫ cos t d t
∫ cos t d t
∫ cos t d t
∫ cos t d t
∫ cos t d t 1
⇒a 0
1
b ∫ f t sin t d t
100
[8 cos 4]
400
b [1 2 cos ]
400
R S value [1 2 cos ] 50
√2
⇒ cos 0.225
76.99
11. [Ans. D]
During to s s ON
V
So V
2
During to anti parallel diode of
s and s will conduct to maintain the
flow of load current in positive direction
V
V
2
uring to
Antiparallel diode of s and s conducts to
maintain flow of load current in negative
direction
V
V
2
During to 2
s s conducts
V
so V
2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 581
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE-2008 EE-2012
1. In the single-phase voltage controller Common Data for Questions 2 and 3
circuit shown in the figure, for what range In the 3-phase inverter circuit shown, the
of triggering angle ( ), the output voltage load is balanced and the gating scheme is
(Vo) is not controllable? 180o conduction mode. All the switching
T1 devices are ideal.
S S S
50 V R 20
+
Vs ~ T2 V0
j50
V
S S S
R
R
3-phase inverter
3-phase balanced load
(A) 00 < < 450
2. The rms value of load phase voltage is
(B) 450 < < 1350
(A) 106.1 V (C) 212.2 V
(C) 900 < < 1800 (B) 141.4 V (D) 282.8 V
(D) 1350 < <1800
3. If the dc bus voltage Vd = 300V, the power
consumed by 3-phase load is
(A) 1.5 kW (C) 2.5 kW
(B) 2.0 kW (D) 3.0 kW
1. [Ans. A]
For 0 < < ϕ, V is not controllable
where ϕ= tan ( ⁄R)
50
ϕ tan ( )
50
ϕ tan 1
ϕ 45
2. [Ans. B]
3. [Ans. D]
.
P=3. =3x = 3000W
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 582
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
f
50 EE-2008
(B) 4. A 220 V, 20 A, 1000 rpm, separately
V
excited dc motor has an armature
resistance of 2.5 Ω. The motor is
controlled by a step down chopper with a
frequency of 1 kHz. The input dc voltage
f
50 to the chopper is 250 V The duty cycle of
(C) the chopper for the motor to operate at a
V
speed of 600 rpm delivering the rated
torque will be _____________
(A) 0.518 (C) 0.852
(B) 0.608 (D) 0.902
f
50
(D) V 5. A 220 V, 1400 rpm, 40A separately
excited dc motor has an armature
resistance of 0.4 Ω. The motor is fed from
a single phase circulating current dual
f converter with an input ac line voltage of
50 220 V (rms). The approximate firing
angles of the dual converter for motoring
EE-2007 operation at 50% of rated torque and
2. A Three-phase, 440V, 50Hz ac mains fed 1000 rpm will be _______________
thyristor bridge is feeding a 440 V dc, (A) 430, 1370 (C) 390, 1410
15kW, 1500rpm separately excited dc (B) 43 , 47
0 (D) 390,510
motor with a ripple free continuous
current in the dc link under all operating 6. A single phase fully controlled converter
conditions. Neglecting the losses, the bridge is used for electrical braking of a
separately excited dc motor. The dc motor
load is represented by an equivalent
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 583
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1. [Ans. A] .
= 0.354
√ .
In induction motor ϕ V/f
If ϕ is constant then V f
3. [Ans. D]
(Linear relation)
2. [Ans. A] 19.04
230 V 57.5 V
V 440 V f 50 z → 3 phase Supply 50 Hz
12 V
specification.
V 440 V P 15kw N 1500 r. p. m
→ Rating of motor N
V V ( )
If losses are neglected, then R=0 and N
1
V = E = 440 V 230 ( )
If speed in the separately excited motor 4
57.5 V
become half, then V = E =220 V
Power P = 15 kw sin ( )
V
P= I0 E
12
15 10 sin ( ) 12.04
⇒ 34.09 57.5
440 180 12.04 169.76
Rms Source current = I0√
1
∫ V sin t d t
34.09 √2 2 R
√3 1
27.83 *V cos t +
2 R
Supply power factor at half rated speed
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 584
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1 7. [Ans. D]
[V [cos cos ]
2 R 20
] V Ra
1 150 20 1
2 19.04 130 V
*57.5√2 cos 169.76 cos 12.04
10
12 (169.76 12.04 2
N N
)+ V Ra
180
130 10 1
1
=140
V 140
4. [Ans. B] 0.7
V 200
At rated conditions, rad/sec
V 220 2.5 20
At required conditions,
V 2.5 20
× 250 = 50
= = 0.608
5. [Ans. C]
At rated conditions, Vt = Eb + Iara = Km m
+ Iara Km 204 x 60 2800 Nm
At required conditions, armature
current 20 and N = 1000
rpm
V cos r
√
cos
20 0.4
∴ 39 and 141
6. [Ans. C]
10 ; V 230√2 V
E = 150 V; r 2Ω
cos r
√
cos 150 20
cos =
√ √
= 129°
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, KeshavaKrupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 585
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Transformer
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 586
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
(A)
a2 a1 ers
a1 a1
a1 a1
24V 2 2.5
t(s)
a1 b2 b1
a1 a1 48V
(B)
c2 c1
a1 a1 e
Primary a1Secondary a1
The transformer connection will be 48 V
represented by 1
t(s)
(A) Y d0 (C) Y d6 24 V 2 2.5
ф( b)
0.12
(A) double
(B) remain same
(C) be halved
t(s) (D) become one quarter
0 1 2 2.5
1
The induced
2 emf (ers) in the secondary
winding
2. as a function of time will be of
5
the form
t(
s)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 587
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
N 10A
25 ms
15. With S2 closed and S1 open, the current Statement for Linked Answer Questions:
waveform in the delta winding will be 18 & 19
(A) a sinusoid at fundamental frequency A C
(B) flat-topped with third harmonic
(C) only third-harmonic Coil 1 Coil 2
(D) none of these B D
Common Data Questions: 16 and 17 The figure above shows coils 1 and 2,
The circuit diagram shows a two with dot markings as shown, having 4000
winding, lossless transformer with no and 6000 turns respectively. Both coils
leakage flux, excited from a current have a rated current of 25A. Coil 1 is
source, i(t), whose waveform is also excited with single phase, 400V, 50Hz
shown. The transformer has a supply
m gnetizing induct nce of 4 /π mH.
1:1 A
18. The coils are to be connected to obtain
a single phase, 400/1000V, auto
S
transformer to drive a load of 10kVA.
i(t) Which of the options given should be
Ω
exercised to realize the required auto
B transformer?
(A) Connect A and D; Common B
(B) Connect B and D; Common C
(C) Connect A and C; Common B
(D) Connect A and C; Common D
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 588
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
~ i
(B)
v
B
R
EE-2012
Z
23. A single phase 10 kVA, 50 Hz transformer
Z Z with 1 kV primary winding draws 0.5 A
Y
and 55 W, at rated voltage and frequency,
on no load. A second transformer has a
B
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 589
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
core with all its linear dimensions 26. A single phase, 50 kVA, 1000V/100 V two
√ times the corresponding dimensions winding transformer is connected as an
of the first transformer. The core material autotransformer as shown in the figure.
and lamination thickness are the same in
both transformers. The primary windings
of both the transformers have the same
number of turns. If a rated voltage of 2 kV
at 50 Hz is applied to the primary of the
second transformer, then the no load
current and power, respectively, are
(A) 0.7 A, 77.8 W (C) 1A, 110 W
(B) 0.7 A, 155.6 W (D) 1A, 220 W The kVA rating of the autotransformer is
_____________
EE-2014
24. The core loss of a single phase, 230/115V, 27. For a single phase, two winding
50 Hz power transformer is measured transformer, the supply frequency and
from 230 V side by feeding the primary voltage are both increased by 10%. The
(230 V side) from a variable voltage, percentage changes in the hysteresis loss
variable frequency source while keeping and eddy current loss, respectively, are
the secondary open circuited. The core (A) 10 and 21 (C) 21 and 10
loss is measured to be 1050 W for 230 V, (B) 10 and 21 (D) 21 and 10
50 Hz input. The core loss is again
28. An open circuit test is performed on
measured to be 500 W for 138 V, 30 Hz
50 Hz transformer, using variable
input. The hysteresis and eddy current
frequency source and keeping V/f ratio
losses of the transformer for 230 V, 50 Hz
constant, to separate its eddy current and
input are respectively,
hysteresis losses. The variation of core
(A) 508 W and 542 W.
loss/frequency as function of frequency is
(B) 468 W and 582 W.
shown in the figure
(C) 498 W and 552 W.
(D) 488 W and 562 W.
( /Hz)
25. Assuming an ideal transformer, the f
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 590
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
29. The load shown in the figure absorbs (A) 5mH, 20mH and 40mH
4 kW at a power factor of 0.89 lagging. (B) 5mH, 80mH and 40mH
Ω (C) 25mH, 10mH and 20mH
(D) 45mH, 30mH and 20mH
c source
Hz
~ Z
31. For a specified input voltage and
frequency, if the equivalent radius of the
Assuming the transformer to be ideal, the
core of a transformer is reduced by half,
value of the reactance X to improve the
the factor by which the number of turns
input power factor to unity is _____
in the primary should change to maintain
the same no load current is
30. The parameters measured for a
(A) 1/4 (C) 2
220V/110V, 50 Hz, single-phase (B) 1/2 (D) 4
transformer are:
Self-inductance of primary winding
= 45mH
Self-inductance of secondary winding
= 30 mH
Mutual inductance between primary and
secondary windings = 20 mH
Using the above parameters, the leakage
( , ) and magnetizing ( )
inductances as referred to primary side in
the equivalent circuit respectively, are
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 591
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
For generator
500 V 250 V
p.u le k ge imped nce ∝
500 kVA × 0.05 = 250 kVA × x
200 A
∴x . .
3. [Ans. C]
300 A
Efficiency 750 V
( ) .
η % ( ) .
… (i) 500 V
. ( )
96% = … (ii)
. ( ) .
From, equation (i) ,
p + p = 12.63 KVA rating of transformer
From equation (ii)
0.25 p + p = 6.25 For auto transformer,
From above two equations η = 98.276%
.
p 8. , p 4.
7. [Ans. C]
4. [Ans. B]
. %
x=√ .6 6
.
. . / x
η = 96.2%
. .
. ( ) x .
x = 78.25%
5. [Ans. C]
Voltage regulation = I( cos + sin )
8. [Ans. B]
(For lagging power factor)
Voltage regulation = I ( cos sin ) . /
(For leading power factor)
( ) . = 0.816
Voltage regulation = I( cos sin )
=0
9. [Ans. C]
t n
. / f
So zero voltage regulation is possible for
. ( ) .
leading power factor
When ∴ p.u st rting current . 6
t n 10. [Ans. B]
A2
6. [Ans. C] A
η .
= 0.95 =
∴w + w = 2.631
C B
C2 B2
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 592
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
d
a2 e
dt
d* . 4( . t)+
c a
dt
c 48
c2 a N
b e
b 48
b2
t(s)
∴ The possible connections is Yd 2 2.5
4
11. [Ans. D]
For open circuit test [on LV side ]
The current is of 4 to 8% of full load 13. [Ans. A]
current ≅ .4
nd is of ow power f ctor ≅ .
∴ W2 is required
oil oil
For short circuit test [on HV side]
The current is full lo d current ≅ 8.
The power f ctor is high ≅ . to .6
Reluctance of the magnetic circuit
∴ 3 is required
remains same in both the cases other
windings are wound on horizontal arms
12. [Ans. B]
or vertical arms. Self-inductance of a coil
Induced emf (e ) in the secondary
winding is given by
d elut nce
e where ∝
dt
During O t When the coils are wound on vertical
The flux ( ) increases linearly with time arms.
. t ( ) ∝( ) nd ( ) ∝ ( )
d ross-section l re
e cm
dt
d( . t) Assuming square cross-sectional area.
dt Side of square
4 √
During t Let length of the coil = L
is const nt No. of turns
.
d ∝
e 4 √
dt
d( . ) ( ) ∝( ) ∝
dt
uring t . Similarly,
decre ses line rly with time ( ) ∝
. 4( . t)
utu l induc t nce
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 593
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
m ∝ / 18. [Ans. A]
Similarly, when the coils are placed on Hint: Polarity should be such that the
horizontal arms voltages of two coils are additive.
10 C
m
m
m 25 D
A 1000V
m m 15
There, mutual inductance gets double 400V
when windings are placed on horizontal B
arms.
19. [Ans. D]
14. [Ans. B]
For sinusoidal excitation, the flux is a flat To supply 10kVA Load I2 =
topped wave with 3rd harmonic. As S1 & S2
both are opened there is no closed path 4
for the circulation of 3rd harmonic By applying KCL I1=25-10= 15A
currents. So no compensating flux is
produced for 3rd harmonic flux. Hence 20. [Ans. C]
flux remains as flat topped wave. Secondary current
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 594
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 595
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
30. [Ans. B]
eddy current 6 .
Given data:
(or) Alternative method - transformer 220/110V, 50Hz
v Self-inductance of primary 4 mH
f. /
f Self-inductance of Secondary mH
v
f . / Mutual inductance between primary and
f
v secondary M = 20 mH
is const nt be the leakage & be the mutual
f
f& f inductance referred to primary side
f+ f Equivalent diagram of inductance
referred to primary
+ f
f
From graph, at 0 Hz
c
f
t Hz
+ f +
f
. where
t Hz 4 m ( m)
f w mH
f . ( ) 6 . w tt
( m) ( m) 8 mH
29. [Ans. *] Range 23 to 24 m 4 mH
n econd ry side
x 31. [Ans. C]
x ( ) x For same no load current
4
4k f l Hl
cos 4 Number of turns of coil
.8 4 H Magnetic flux density
4 l average length
sin .4 6
.8 H∝
4 . 6 ∝
Energy supplied by reactance to make ∝
unity power factor ∝
4 . 6 d
dt
4 . 6 So same voltage supply
. /
d d
( )
dt dt
4 . 6 4
4 πr
.66 (πr ) ( )
4 . 6 4
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 596
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Induction Motors
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 597
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
8. A 400 V, 50 Hz, 4 pole, 1400 rpm, star 9. The speed of rotation of stator magnetic
connected squirrel cage induction motor field with respect to rotor structure will be
has the Following parameters referred to (A) 90 rpm in the direction of rotation,
the stator (B) 90 rpm in the opposite direction of
. Ω, = . Ω rotation.
Neglect stator resistance and core and (C) 1500 rpm in the direction of rotation
rotational losses of the motor (D) 1500 rpm in the opposite direction
The motor is controlled from a 3-phase of rotation
voltage source inverter with constant V/f
control. The stator line to line voltage 10. Neglecting all losses of both the machines,
(rms) and frequency to obtain the the dc generator power output and the
maximum torque at starting will be current through resistance (Rex) will
(A) 20.6 V, 2.7 Hz respectively be
(B) 133.3 V, 16.7 Hz (A) 96 W, 3.10 A
(C) 266.6 V, 33.3 Hz (B) 120 W, 3.46 A
(D) 323.3V, 40.3 Hz (C) 1504 W, 12.26 A
(D) 1880 W, 13.71 A
Common Data for Questions 9 and 10
A 3-phase, 440 V 50Hz. 4-pole, slip ring EE-2009
induction motor is fed from the rotor side 11. A 3-phase squirrel cage induction motor
through an auto transformer and the supplied from a balanced 3-phase source
stator is connected to variable resistance drives a mechanical load.
as shown in the figure. The torque-speed characteristics of the
motor
(solid curve) and of the load
(dotted curve) are shown. Of the two
equilibrium points A and B, which of the
following options correctly describes the
Induction stability of A and B?
Motor es
B
3 – phase,
50 Hz, + 220V Torque
Supply A
Auto Transformer
The motor is coupled to a 220 V,
separately excited, dc generator feeding 0 1.0 sync
power to fixed power to fixed resistance (A) A is stable B is unstable
of 10 Ω. Two-wattmeter method is used to (B) A is unstable B is stable
measure the input power to induction (C) Both are stable
motor. The variable resistance is adjusted (D) Both are unstable
such that the motor runs at 1410 rpm and
the following readings were recorded 12. A 220V, 50Hz, single-phase induction
W1 = 1800 W, W2 = motor has the following connection
diagram and winding orientations shown.
is the axis of the main stator winding
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 598
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 599
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 600
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
( )
Torque
. x
peed
( )
Torque
.
peed
( )
Torque
.
peed
( )
Torque
.
peed
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 601
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1. [Ans. B] 4. [Ans. B]
Switch The value of power loss (Cu loss) at full
Rotor
Auxiliary load
winding
=. / 6 4.6 4
Start capacitor ∴ Total losses = 1354.67 + 1002
Ia Im = 2356.67
main
I ∴ Efficiency = = 81%
winding .
V
Start capacitor is used to provide 5. [Ans. D]
phase difference between nd . T . T
If supply terminals are interchanged, Ia T T
and Im will flow in the opposite direction, ( )
so torque will act in the same direction. ∴4 ( ) +
Therefore, the direction of rotation will ( ) 4 +
remain same. ∴ Correct answer is, = 26.79%.
2. [Ans. C] 6. [Ans. A]
= constant (given) Rotor resistance at stand still R = 7.8
⟹ ∝f Synchronous speed
f
4 4 V
rpm
4
Now, T ∝ . / s The slip (s) of rotor with respect to
⟹ . / × forward field
Now, T T (given) s
. 4 . / 4
.
. 66
The slip of rotor with respect to backward
( )
field
( . 66) = 840.6 rpm s . .
Effective rotor resistance
3. [Ans. A]
= 1500 rpm ( s)
.8
T .
( )
( /√ ) .
( . ) ( . ) 7. [Ans. C]
= 63.58 Nm Input power in stator
=√ 4 .8 . kW
Air gap power = 27.71 – 1.5 – 1.2
= 25.01 kW
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 602
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
. +j π
π
Z +j
∴ f
. / . / Current through main winding
=
= 16.7 Hz . +j Z
8 .4
In const V/f control method 8
Current through auxiliary winding
∴ /f 8
∴ f 8 +j Z
= 16.7 × 8 . 8 . 4
= 133.3 volts Taking Vs as the reference
V
9. [Ans. A]
= 1500 rpm
In the direction of rotation of rotor,
therefore, speed of the stator field with
respect to rotor 1500 1410 = 90 rpm Ia
Im
10. [Ans. C]
Im leads Ia the fields created by the two
Slip = = 0.06 current also have same difference thereby
Total power input to induction motor constituting an unbalanced field system.
within = 1800 – 200 = 1600 W The result is the production of the
Power output of induction motor starting torque.
( s) Space – orientation of the fied
6 ( . 6) = 1504 W Field due to Ia
Field due to Im
4
∴ ex 4 √ . 6
11. [Ans. A]
t point if speed ↑ lo d torque lso ↑
The motor rotates in the direction of
nd if speed ↓ lo d torque ↓ hence is
leading phase to lagging phase.
st ble but t if speed ↑ lo d torque ↓ s
In this case, the motor rotates
vice versa an were b is unstable.
anti – clockwise.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 603
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
rpm. x
s
s . 8
15. [Ans. D] full lo d slip .
( . ) .
Slip , S = T +. /
. .
o . 8
Where, = synchronous speed T
– rotor speed
As the shaft torque depends upon rotor 21. [Ans. C]
speed therefore the slip also depends on Given data:
shaft torque. , 4 pole self excited induction
And core-losses are independent of slip generator, feeding power at frequency f
Condition 1:-
16. [Ans. B] In induction generator speed of
At standstill , the rotor current is generator 1500rpm
∴ rpm i. e. , rpm
√ +
f if rpm , f Hz
As losses are zero
ut rpm f Hz
∴ Condition 2:-
If load is partially removed and frequency
4 f speed of generator is constant
therefore rpm, but load
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 604
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
23. [Ans. B]
. uxili ry
peed
24. [Ans. A]
Due to malfunctioning centrifugal
, slip ring induction motor, provided
switch not opened, so that auxiliary
with commutator winding motor rotates
winding also present even motor
in clockwise direction when the rotor
reaches greater than 70% so that
windings are closed. i.e., in motor
torque slip characteristics will change
operation
as shown in figure below
Now rotor winding is open circuited and
the system is made to run at rotational
speed f in anticlockwise direction. In this Torque
condition operates as induction generator
so rotor rotates a head of stator R.M.F and
therefore frequency across slip rings is
f+f f frequency of voltages across
. s
commutator brushes is f f peed
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 605
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
D.C. Machine
EE-2008
Statement for Linked Answer Questions
t
4 and 5 . π .4π .6π .8π π
A 240 V, dc shunt motor draws 15 A while
supplying the rated load at a speed of
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 606
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
1500
t 1400
. π .4π .6π .8π π
(D)
V ’ ’
t torque
0 5
. π .4π .6π .8π π (Nm)
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 607
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
current of 2.2 A. The change in field flux 15. A separately excited 300 V DC shunt
required to obtain a speed of 1600 rpm motor under no load runs at 900 rpm
while drawing a line current of 52.8 A and drawing an armature current of 2 A. The
a field current of 1.8 A is armature resistance is 0.5Ω. and leakage
(A) 18.18 % increase inductance is 0.01 H. When loaded, the
(B) 18.18 % decrease armature current is 15 A. Then the speed
(C) 36.36 % increase in rpm is_________
(D) 36.36 % decrease
16. A 15 kW, 230 V dc shunt motor has
EE-2014 armature circuit resistance of 0.4 Ω and
13. A 250 V dc shunt machine has armature field circuit resistance of 230 Ω. At no
circuit resistance of 0.6 Ω and field circuit load and rated voltage, the motor runs at
resistance of 125 Ω. The machine is 1400 rpm and the line current drawn by
connected to 250 V supply mains. The the motor is 5 A. At full load, the motor
motor is operated as a generator and then draws a line current of 70 A. Neglect
as a motor separately. The line current of armature reaction. The full load speed of
the machine in both the cases is 50 A. The the motor in rpm is____________
ratio of the speed as a generator to the
speed as a motor is ___
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 608
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE 4. [Ans. D]
1. [Ans. B] 240 V, shunt motor 15A, N = 80 rad/sec
Compensating winding is placed in slots = 0.5 8 Ω
cut out in pole faces such that the axis of 4 . = 234
this winding coincides with the brush plugging + 4 + 4 4 4
axis. The compensating winding
neutralizes the armature mmf directly 5. [Ans. A]
under the pole while in the interpolar Here, .
region, there is incomplete neutralization.
+ .6
To speed up the commutation process,
∴ = 31.1
the reactance voltage must be neutralized
by injecting a suitable polarity dynamical
6. [Ans. A]
(speed) voltage into the commutating
When brushes are shifted in the direction
coil. In order that this injection is
of motor rotation then rise time less than
restricted to commutating coils, narrow
fall time.
interpolar are provided in the interpolar
region.
e ding tip Tr iling tip
2. [Ans. A]
For generator
E=V+ + . = 204
For motor V=E+
E = 200 – 20 × 0.2 = 196 Tr iling tip e ding tip
∴ = 0.87
.
3. [Ans. D]
Speed – current characteristics of DC
motors
Speed orce
Differential compound DC machines is acting as DC motor
n0 When the brush is shifted in the direction
of rotation in the DC motor, field gets
magnetized.
Shunt Due to armature reaction, leading tip of
Cumulative comp. N-pole and S-pole demagnetized.
Series But increase in flux density.
Ia
(Ia)full load Due to magnetized effect of armature
It can seen from the characteristics, speed reaction waveform of will be as
regulation can be zero at full load in the given option (a)
case of differential component dc motor.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 609
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
7. [Ans. C] N∝ ⟹ ( )
Synchronous speed .
=1500 rpm
.
So, slip S < 0 [ ]⟹ +
. ( + )
Hence, dc machine acts as a motor and
. ⟹ . Ω
Induction machine acts as a generator.
11. [Ans. B]
8. [Ans. B]
4-point starter is used to control the
At no load , rpm,
speed of shunt motor in field weakening
= 200 V
region.
Assuming ∝ ,
i.e.; above rated speeds.
at N = 14010 rpm
4 In field weakening region field current
will reduce in 3 – point starter holding
86.6 V coil unable to hold the plugges in ON
position.
T 4
86.6
12. [Ans. D]
.
86.6 . 6 . 6 .8
. .8 .8
. . .
. Ω 0 .
1
.
.6 64
9. [Ans. B]
For N = 1400 rpm, 86.6 %decrease= x
equired ‘ ’ +
86.6 + ( . ) * +
Where is function of torque,
6. 6%decre se
To Develop 5 N-m it requires 3.925 A
.
. ( ) 13. [Ans. *] Range 1.22 to 1.32
. Given data:
Dc shunt machine operated as generator
. 6 and motor separately
86.6 + ( . 6 )( . ) .6Ω
= 193.3 V Ω
10. [Ans. A]
Find: ratio of speed as a generator to
Now flux is decreased by 10%, so speed as motor
. n gener tor
Torque is constant so
+ +
⟹ . +
.
+ .6
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 610
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
8 . . +
In motor operation: .
k .
48 k
.
88 .4 rpm
48 .6 .
speed s gener tor
∴ 16. [Ans. *] Range 1239 to 1242
peed s motor
[ n shunt ⁄c] +
8 .
. f
.
iled
+
14. [Ans. *] Range 12.45 to 12.65 winding
b
o lo d
k 4
k At no load
4 .4 +
Field current is kept constant at rated
value so k will be same at I = 8A ( t r ted volt ge)
T ki (8) 4
4 4 .4 +
(8 6 / π) in m 8.4
4
At rated load
. m
r +
( ) .4 +
15. [Ans. *] Range 879 to 881
No load .4
k .4
r + , k -
. + k 4 8.4
4 .6 rpm
k
under loaded condition
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 611
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Synchronous Machine
EE-2006 EE-2007
1. A synchronous generator is feeding a zero 6. A three-phase synchronous motor
power factor (lagging) load at rated connected to ac main is running at full
current. The armature reaction is load and unity power factor. If its shaft
(A) magnetizing load is reduced by half, with field current
(B) demagnetizing held constant, its new power factor will be
(C) cross – magnetizing (A) unity
(D) ineffective (B) leading
(C) lagging
2. A 3 phase, 400 V, 5 kW, star connected (D) dependent on machine parameters
synchronous motor having an internal
reactance of 10Ω is operating at 7. A 100kVA. 415 V (line), Star-connected
50% load, unity pf. Now, the excitation is synchronous machine generates rated
increased by 1%. What will be the new open circuit voltage of 415 V at field
load in percent, if the power factor is to current of 15A. The short circuit armature
be kept same? Neglect all losses and current at a field current of 10 A is equal
consider linear magnetic circuit. to the rated armature current. The per
(A) 67.9% (C) 51% unit saturated synchronous reactance is
(B) 56.9% (D) 50% (A) 1.731 (C) 0.666
(B) 1.5 (D) 0.577
Common Data Question for 3, 4 and 5
EE-2008
A 4 pole, 50 Hz, synchronous generator
8. Distributed winding and short chording
has 48 slots in which a double layer
employed in AC machines will result in
winding is used. Each coil has 10 turns
(A) Increase in emf and reduction in
and is short pitched by an angle to 6
harmonics.
electrical. The fundamental flux per pole
(B) Increase in emf and increase in
is 0.025 Wb.
harmonics.
(C) Increase in both emf and harmonics.
3. The line-to-line induced emf (in volts), for
(D) Reduction in both emf and
a three phase star connection is
harmonics.
approximately
(A) 808 (C) 1400 Statement for Linked Answer Questions 9
(B) 888 (D) 1538
and 10
A synchronous motor is connected to an
4. The line-to-line induced emf (in volts), for
infinite bus at 1.0pu voltage and draws
a three phase connection is
0.6 pu current at unity power factor. Its
approximately
synchronous reactance is 1.0pu and
(A) 1143 (C) 1617
(B) 1332 (D) 1791 resistance is negligible.
9. The excitation voltage (E) and load angle
5. The fifth harmonic component of phase ( ) will respectively be
emf (in volts), for a three phase star (A) 0.8 pu and 36.86 lag
connection is (B) 0.8pu and 36.86o lead
(A) 0 (C) 281 (C) 1.17 pu and 30.96° lead
(B) 269 (D) 808 (D) 1.17 pu and 30.96° lag
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 612
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
10. Keeping the excitation voltage same, the performed on it with 90% of the rated
load on the motor is increased such that current flowing in its both LV and HV
the motor current increase by 20%. The windings, the measured loss is 81 W. The
operating power will become transformer has maximum efficiency
(A) 0.995 lagging (C) 0.791 lagging when operated at
(B) 0.995 leading (D) 0.848 leading (A) 50.0% of the rated current.
(B) 64.0% of the rated current.
EE-2009 (C) 80.0% of the rated current.
11. A field excitation of 20 A in a certain (D) 88.8% of the rated current.
alternator results in an armature current
of 400A in short circuit and a terminal 15. The angle in the swing equation of a
voltage of 2000V on open circuit. The synchronous generator is the
magnitude of the internal voltage drop (A) Angle between stator voltage and
within the machine at a load current current
of 200A is (B) Angular displacement of the rotor
(A) 1V (C) 100V with respect to the stator
(B) 10V (D) 1000V
(C) Angular displacement of the stator
mmf with respect to a synchronously
EE-2011
rotating axis.
12. The direct axis and quadrature axis
(D) Angular displacement of an axis fixed
reactances of a salient pole alternator are
to the rotor with respect to a
1.2 p.u and 1.0 p.u respectively. The
synchronously rotating axis.
armature resistance is negligible. If this
alternator is delivering rated kVA at upf
EE-2014
and at rated voltage then its power angle
16. A star connected 400 V, 50 Hz, 4 pole
is
synchronous machine gave the following
(A) 30° (C) 60°
(B) 45° (D) 90° open circuit and short circuit test results:
Open circuit test: = 400 V
13. A three-phase, salient pole synchronous (rms, line-to-line) at field current, = 2.3 A
motor is connected to an infinite bus. It is Short circuit test: = 10 A (rms, phase)
operated at no load at normal excitation. at field current, = 1.5 A
The field excitation of the motor is first The value of per phase synchronous
reduced to zero and then increased in the impedance in Ω at rated voltage
reverse direction gradually. Then the is____________
armature current
(A) Increase continuously 17. A three phase synchronous generator is
(B) First increases and then decreases to be connected to the infinite bus. The
steeply lamps are connected as shown in the
(C) First decreases and then increases figure for the synchronization. The phase
steeply sequence of bus voltage is R-Y-B and that
(D) Remains constant of incoming generator voltage is R'-Y'-B'.
EE-2013
14. A single-phase transformer has no-load
loss of 64 W, as obtained from an open-
circuit test. When a short-circuit test is
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 613
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 614
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
∴ 4.8
.
∴ % load = = 67.86%
.
4 v
3. [Ans. C]
√ √ 4
4 pole, 50 Hz, no. of slot = S = 48
double layer winding, 1 coil contains 10 = 1616.45 V
turns, α(short pitched) 6 , /pole =
0.025 mwb. 5. [Ans. A]
4.44 f T Pitch factor due to 5th harmonic
component
slot /pole/ph = =4 6
( ) cos ( ) cos
slot/pole = = 12
[as pitch factor is zero, induced emf due
slot angle = =
to 5th harmonic component is zero]
( / )
= 0.957
( / )
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 615
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
6. [Ans. B] 8. [Ans. D]
Ia Xs Induced emf 4.44k k fT
As KP & kd v lues re less th n ‘ ’ for
distributed & short pitched winding, the
Vt ~ Ef
induced emf reduces.
To eliminate higher order harmonics we
use distributed winding and to eliminate
Neglecting armature resistance Ra
the dominant harmonics i.e., 5th & 7th we
Vt=Ef +jIa Xs
use pitched winding.
Ia2
Ia1 Vt 9. [Ans. D]
jIa2Xs V = 1 ∠0 pu
.6∠
Reduced load
jIa1Xs Ef at shaft
z +j +j ∠ pu
Ef load at shaft ∠ ∠ .6∠ ∠
It can be seen from the phasor diagram E∠ . 66 ∠ . 6 pu (It is lagging)
that, when load is reduced at shaft ∴ excitation voltage = 1.17 pu
keeping field current constant the new ∴ lo d ngle ( ) . 6
power factor becomes leading.
10. [Ans. A]
7. [Ans. C] Let power factor = cos l gging
Saturation of field poles occur for a field .6 . pu
current equal to for which rated open ∠ j ∠
circuited voltage is obtained. (cos + j sin )
∴ for is ( ∠ j (cos j sin )
)
j . (cos j sin )
for ( ) ( . sin ) j . cos
( . sin ) + ( . cos )
∴ ( ) . + . sin .44 sin +
√ 4
for 8.68 . cos
4 . + . .44 sin
∴Z ( ) . 88 ohm sin . 8
8.68
( ) Z . . 88 . 6
6.66 cos . l gging
.
p.u Z ( ) .666
11. [Ans. D]
2nd Method
Internal resistance = Ω
(4 ⁄√ )
Z ( ) ⁄ph . 4 Internal voltage drop = 5×200 = 1000V
8.68
( ) (Z ⁄ph) .6 8 .
.6 8 12. [Ans. B]
Z ( . ) .666 ( )
(4 ⁄√ ) T n
( )
p. u p. u Power factor
angle = 0°
x . p. u x p. u r
T n ⟹ 4
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 616
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 617
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 618
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
EE-2007
1. The electromagnetic torque Te of a drive,
and its connected load torque TL are as
shown below. Out of the operating points
A, B, C and D, the stable ones are
(A)
Te
T TL
Speed
(B) Te
T
TL
B
Speed
(C)
Te
T C
TL
Speed
(D)
Te
T
D
TL
Speed
(A) A, C, D (C) A, D
(B) B, C (D) B, C, D
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 619
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
T Speed
At point B,
Speed T T
T Te T T T
If speed decreases, due to some
disturbance
D
T T
T T T T
So rotor decelerates, and rotor speed
Speed keeps on decreasing.
AT points A, C, D If speed increases.
T T T T
T T T T T T
It due to some disturbance speed Rotor accelerates, and rotor speed keeps
decreases on increasing.
T T So, point is unstable
T T T
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 620
SURYAS TECHNO WORLD
Special Machines
EE-2007
1. A three-phase, three-stack, variable
reluctance step motor has 20 poles on
each rotor and stator stack , The step
angle of this step motor is
(A) (C)
(B) 6 (D) 8
EE-2008
2. In a stepper motor, the detent torque
means
(A) minimum of the static torque with
the phase winding excited.
(B) maximum of the static torque with
the phase winding excited.
(C) minimum of the static torque with
the phase winding unexcited.
(D) maximum of the static torque with
the phase winding unexcited
1. [Ans. B]
Step angle = 6
2. [Ans. D]
Detent Torque (or) Restraining Torque is
the maximum Load Torque that can be
kept on motor shaft in an unexcited
motor without causing continuous
rotation.
th th th
THE GATE ACADEMY PVT.LTD. H.O.: #74, Keshava Krupa (third Floor), 30 Cross, 10 Main, Jayanagar 4 Block, Bangalore-11
: 080-65700750, info@thegateacademy.com © Copyright reserved. Web: www.thegateacademy.com Page 621